af57d9b8566f516dd782e00c0ab72853618a556c
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.86"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2015
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1989 Exim used to
1990 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1991 withdrawn.
1992
1993
1994
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001 on demand.
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004 dependencies.
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017 on demand:
2018 .code
2019 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022 .endd
2023
2024
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2036 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2037 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2038 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2039 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2040 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2041 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2042 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2043
2044 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2045 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2046 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2047
2048
2049
2050 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2051 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2052 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2053 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2054 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2055 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2056 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2057 .code
2058 FULLECHO='' make -e
2059 .endd
2060 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2061 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2062 given in addition to the short output.
2063
2064
2065
2066 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2067 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2068 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2069 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2070 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2071 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2072 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2073 order:
2074 .display
2075 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2076 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2077 &_Local/Makefile_&
2078 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2079 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2081 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2082 .endd
2083 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2084 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2085 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2086 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2087 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2088 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2089 and are often not needed.
2090
2091 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2092 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2093 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2094 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2095 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2096 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2097 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2098 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2099 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2100
2101
2102 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2103 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2104 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2105 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2106 default values are.
2107
2108
2109 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2110 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2111 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2112 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2113 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2114 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2115 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2116 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2117 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2118 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2119 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2120 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2121 containing the lines
2122 .code
2123 CC=cc
2124 CFLAGS=-std1
2125 .endd
2126 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2127 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2128
2129 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2130 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2131 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2132
2133
2134 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2135 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2136 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2137 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2138 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2139 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2140 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2141 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2142 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2143 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2144 .code
2145 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2146 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2147 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2148 .endd
2149 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2150 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2151 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2152 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2153 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2154 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2155 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2156 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2157 errors.
2158
2159 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2160 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2161 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2162 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2163 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2164 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2165 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2166 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2167 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2168 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2169 syntax. For instance:
2170 .code
2171 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2172 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2173 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2174 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2175 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2176 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2177 .endd
2178
2179 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2180 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2181 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2182 .code
2183 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2184 .endd
2185 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2186 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2187
2188 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2189 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2190 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2191 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2192 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2193 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2194 .code
2195 X11=/usr/X11R6
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2198 .endd
2199 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2200 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2201 .code
2202 X11=/usr/openwin
2203 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2204 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2205 .endd
2206 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2207 definition of all three of these variables into your
2208 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2209
2210 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2211 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2212 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2213 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2214 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2215
2216 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2217 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2218 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2219 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2220 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2221 libraries.
2222
2223 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2224 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2225 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2226 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2227 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2228
2229
2230 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2231 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2232 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2233 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2234 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2235 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2236 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2237 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2238
2239
2240
2241 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2242 .cindex "building Eximon"
2243 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2244 where the files that are involved are
2245 .display
2246 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2247 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2248 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2249 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2252 .endd
2253 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2254 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2256 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2257 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2258 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2259 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2260 .ecindex IIDbuex
2261
2262
2263 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2264 .cindex "installing Exim"
2265 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2266 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2267 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2268 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2269 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2270 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2271 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2272 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2273 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2274 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2275 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2276 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2277
2278 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2279 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2280 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2281 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2282 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2283 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2284 alternative files, no default is installed.
2285
2286 .cindex "system aliases file"
2287 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2288 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2289 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2290 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2291 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2292 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2293 and outputs a comment to the user.
2294
2295 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2296 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2297 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2298 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2299 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2300
2301 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2302 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2303 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2304 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2305 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2306 over SMTP.
2307
2308 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2309 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2310 command such as
2311 .code
2312 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2313 .endd
2314 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2315 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2316 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2317 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2318 but this usage is deprecated.
2319
2320 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2321 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2322 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2323 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2324 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2325 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2326
2327 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2328 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2329 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2330 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2331 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2332 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2333 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2334
2335 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2336 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2337 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2338 command:
2339 .code
2340 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2341 .endd
2342 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2343 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2344 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2345 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2346 command:
2347 .code
2348 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2349 .endd
2350 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2351 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2352
2353 .ilist
2354 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2355 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2356 .next
2357 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2358 installed binary.
2359 .endlist
2360
2361 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2362 .code
2363 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2364 .endd
2365 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2366 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2367 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2368 .code
2369 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2370 .endd
2371
2372
2373
2374 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2375 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2376 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2377 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2378 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2379 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2380
2381 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2382 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2383 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2384
2385
2386
2387 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2388 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2389 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2390 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2391 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2392 necessary.
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2398 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2399 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2400 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2401 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2402 .code
2403 exim -bV
2404 .endd
2405 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2406 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2407 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2408 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2409 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2410 example,
2411 .display
2412 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2413 .endd
2414 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2415 .display
2416 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2417 .endd
2418 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2419 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2420 user agent. For example:
2421 .code
2422 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2423 From: user@your.domain.example
2424 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2425 Subject: Testing Exim
2426
2427 This is a test message.
2428 ^D
2429 .endd
2430 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2431 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2432 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2433
2434 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2435 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2436 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2437 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2438 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2439 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2440 .display
2441 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2442 .endd
2443 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2444 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2445 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2446 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2447 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2448
2449 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2450 .cindex "lock files"
2451 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2452 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2453 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2454 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2455 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2456 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2457 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2458 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2459 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2460 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2461 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2462 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2463
2464 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2465 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2466 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2467 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2468 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2469 incoming SMTP mail.
2470
2471 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2472 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2473 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2474 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2475 production version.
2476
2477
2478 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2479 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2480 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2481 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2482 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2483 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2484 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2485 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2486 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2487 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2488 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2489 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2490 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2491
2492 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2493 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2494 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2495 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2496 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2497 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2498 as follows:
2499 .code
2500 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2501 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2502 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2503 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2504 .endd
2505 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2506 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2507 favourite user agent.
2508
2509 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2510 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2511 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2512 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2513 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2514 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2515
2516
2517
2518 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2519 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2520 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2521 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2522 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2523 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2524 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2525 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2526 configuration file.
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2532 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2533 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2534 .code
2535 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2536 .endd
2537 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2538 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2539 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2540 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2541 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2542 .code
2543 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2544 .endd
2545 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2546
2547 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2548 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2549 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2556
2557 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2558 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2559 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2560 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2561 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2562 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2563 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2564 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2565 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2566
2567
2568 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2569 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2570 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2571 were present before any other options.
2572 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2573 standard output.
2574 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2575 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2576 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2577
2578 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2579 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2580 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2581 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2582 format.
2583
2584 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2585 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2586 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2587 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2588
2589 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2590 .cindex "queue runner"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2592 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2593 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2594
2595 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2596 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2597 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2598 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2599 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2600 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2601 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2602 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2603
2604
2605 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2606 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2607 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2608 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2609 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2610 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2611
2612 .ilist
2613 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2614 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2615 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2616 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2617 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2618 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2619
2620 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2621 .cindex "envelope sender"
2622 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2623 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2624 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2625 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2626 users to set envelope senders.
2627
2628 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2629 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2630 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2631 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2632 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2633
2634 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2635 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2636 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2637 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2638 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2639 that are available to trusted users.
2640 .next
2641 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2642 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2643 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2644 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2645 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2646
2647 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2648 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2649 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2650 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2651
2652 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2653 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2654 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2655 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2656
2657 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2658 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2659 false.
2660 .endlist
2661
2662
2663 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2664 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2665 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2666 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2672 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2673 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2674 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2675 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2676 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2677 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2678 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2679
2680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2681 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2682 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2683 . creates a man page for the options.
2684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2685
2686 .literal xml
2687 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2688 .literal off
2689
2690
2691 .vlist
2692 .vitem &%--%&
2693 .oindex "--"
2694 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2695 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2696 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2697 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2698
2699 .vitem &%--help%&
2700 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2701 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2702 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2703 no arguments.
2704
2705 .vitem &%--version%&
2706 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2707 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2708 displayed.
2709
2710 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2711 &%-Am%&
2712 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2713 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2714 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2715 ignored by Exim.
2716
2717 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2718 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2719 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2720 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2721 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2722 clean; it ignores this option.
2723
2724 .vitem &%-bd%&
2725 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2726 .cindex "daemon"
2727 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2728 .cindex "queue runner"
2729 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2730 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2731 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2732
2733 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2734 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2735 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2736 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2737
2738 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2739 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2740 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2741 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2742
2743 When a listening daemon
2744 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2745 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2746 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2747 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2748 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2749 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2750 running as root.
2751
2752 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2753 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2754 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2755
2756 The SIGHUP signal
2757 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2758 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2759 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2760 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2761 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2762 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2763 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2764 because these are reread each time they are used.
2765
2766 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2767 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2768 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2769 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2770
2771 .vitem &%-be%&
2772 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2773 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2774 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2775 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2776 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2777 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2778 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2779
2780 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2781 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2782 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2783 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2784 test data. A line history is supported.
2785
2786 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2787 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2788 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2789 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2790 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2791 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2792 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2793
2794 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2795 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2796 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2797 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2798
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2805 .code
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2807 .endd
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2815 &%-be%&).
2816
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2824
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2826 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2835 supplied.
2836
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2840 .code
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2842 .endd
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2845
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2847 .code
2848 # Exim filter
2849 # Sieve filter
2850 .endd
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2854 redirection lists.
2855
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2860
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2869 options).
2870
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2872 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2876 &$qualify_domain$&.
2877
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2879 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2885
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2887 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2890 prefix.
2891
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2893 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896 suffix.
2897
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2899 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2909 .code
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2912 .endd
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2917
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2923
2924 &*Warning 1*&:
2925 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2929 connection.
2930
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2934
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2941
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2945
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2950
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2952 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2956
2957 .vitem &%-bi%&
2958 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2966 recognized.
2967
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2974 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2975
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2977 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2985
2986 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2991
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3001
3002 .vitem &%-bm%&
3003 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3011
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3016
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3019
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3023
3024 The format
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3032 .code
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3035 .endd
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3041
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3047
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3053 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3054 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3055 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3056 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3057 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3058
3059 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3060 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3061 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3062 This option requires admin privileges.
3063
3064 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3065 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3066 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3067
3068 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3069 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3070 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3071 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3072 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3073 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3074 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3075 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3076 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3077
3078 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3079 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3080 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3081 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3082 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3083
3084 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3085 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3086 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3087 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3088
3089
3090 .vitem &%-bP%&
3091 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3092 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3093 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3094 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3095 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3096 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3097 arguments, for example:
3098 .code
3099 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3100 .endd
3101 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3102 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3103 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3104 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3105 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3106 users, the output is as in this example:
3107 .code
3108 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3109 .endd
3110 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3111 configuration file is output.
3112 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3113 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3114
3115 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3116 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3117 name will not be output.
3118
3119 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3120 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3121 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3122 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3123 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3124 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3125 written directly into the spool directory.
3126
3127 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3128 .code
3129 exim -bP +local_domains
3130 .endd
3131 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3132 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3133
3134 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3135 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3136 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3137 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3138 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3139 that driver are output. For example:
3140 .code
3141 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3142 .endd
3143 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3144 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3145 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3146 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3147 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3148 &%authenticators%&.
3149
3150 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3151 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3152 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3153 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3154 The output format is one item per line.
3155
3156 .vitem &%-bp%&
3157 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3158 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3159 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3160 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3161 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3162 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3163 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3164 to allow any user to see the queue.
3165
3166 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3167 .code
3168 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3169 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3170 <other addresses>
3171 .endd
3172 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3173 .cindex "size" "of message"
3174 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3175 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3176 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3177 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3178 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3179 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3180 before the sender address.
3181
3182 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3183 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3184 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3185
3186 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3187 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3188 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3189 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3190 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3191 complete.
3192
3193
3194 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3195 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3196 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3197 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3198 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3199 of just &"D"&.
3200
3201
3202 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3203 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3204 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3205 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3206 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3207 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3208
3209
3210 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3211 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3212 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3213 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3214 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3215 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3216
3217 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3218 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3219 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3220
3221 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3222 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3223 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3224
3225
3226 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3227 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3228 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3229 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3230 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3231 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3232
3233
3234 .vitem &%-brt%&
3235 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3236 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3237 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3238 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3239 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3240 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3241 .code
3242 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3243 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3244 .endd
3245 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3246 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3247 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3248 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3249 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3250 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3251 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3252 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3253 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3254 .code
3255 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3256 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3257 .endd
3258
3259 .vitem &%-brw%&
3260 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3261 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3262 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3263 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3264 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3265 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3266 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3267 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3268
3269 .vitem &%-bS%&
3270 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3271 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3272 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3273 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3274 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3275 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3276 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3277 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3278 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3279 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3280
3281 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3282 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3283 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3284
3285 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3286 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3287 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3288 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3289
3290 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3291 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3292 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3293
3294 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3295 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3296 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3297 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3298 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3299
3300 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3301 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3302
3303 .vitem &%-bs%&
3304 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3305 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3306 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3307 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3308 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3309 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3310 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3311 messages to the MTA.
3312
3313 In
3314 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3315 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3316 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3317 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3318 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3319 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3320 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3321
3322 .cindex "inetd"
3323 The
3324 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3325 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3326 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3327 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3328 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3329 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3330 the listening daemon.
3331
3332 .vitem &%-bt%&
3333 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3334 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3335 .cindex "address" "testing"
3336 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3337 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3338 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3339 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3340 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3341
3342 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3343 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3344
3345 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3346 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3347 security issues.
3348
3349 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3350 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3351 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3352 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3353 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3354 program.
3355
3356 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3357 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3358 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3359 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3360
3361 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3362 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3363 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3364 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3365 always shown.
3366
3367 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3368 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3369 message,
3370 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3371 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3372 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3373 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3374 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3375 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3376 doing such tests.
3377
3378 .vitem &%-bV%&
3379 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3380 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3381 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3382 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3383 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3384 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3385 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3386
3387 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3388 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3389 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3390 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3391 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3392 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3393 dynamic testing facilities.
3394
3395 .vitem &%-bv%&
3396 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3397 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3398 .cindex "address" "verification"
3399 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3400 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3401 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3402 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3403 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3404 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3405
3406 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3407 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3408 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3409
3410 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3411 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3412
3413 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3414 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3415 security issues.
3416
3417 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3418 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3419 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3420 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3421 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3422
3423 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3424 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3425 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3426 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3427 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3428 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3429 to succeed.
3430
3431 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3432 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3433 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3434
3435 The
3436 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3437 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3438 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3439 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3440
3441 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3442 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3443 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3444 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3445
3446 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3447 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3448 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3449 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3450 might happen.
3451
3452 .vitem &%-bw%&
3453 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3454 .cindex "daemon"
3455 .cindex "inetd"
3456 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3457 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3458 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3459 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3460
3461 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3462 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3463 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3464 each port only when the first connection is received.
3465
3466 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3467 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3468
3469 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3470 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3471 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3472 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3473 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3474 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3475 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3476 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3477 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3478 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3479 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3480
3481 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3482 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3483 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3484 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3485 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3486 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3487 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3488 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3489 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3490
3491 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3492 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3493 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3494 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3495 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3496 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3497 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3498
3499 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3500 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3501 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3502 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3503 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3504 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3505 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3506
3507 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3508 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3509 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3510 configuration file.
3511
3512 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3513 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3514 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3515 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3516 specified by this option.
3517
3518
3519 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3520 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3521 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3522 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3523 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3524 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3525 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3526 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3527
3528 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3529 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3530 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3531 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3532 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3533 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3534 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3535
3536 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3537 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3538 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3539 synonymous:
3540 .code
3541 exim -DABC ...
3542 exim -DABC= ...
3543 .endd
3544 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3545 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3546 example:
3547 .code
3548 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3549 .endd
3550 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3551
3552
3553 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3554 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3555 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3556 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3557 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3558 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3559 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3560 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3561 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3562 return code.
3563
3564 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3565 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3566 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3567 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3568 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3569 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3570 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3571 are:
3572 .display
3573 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3574 &`auth `& authenticators
3575 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3576 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3577 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3578 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3579 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3580 &`filter `& filter handling
3581 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3582 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3583 &`ident `& ident lookup
3584 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3585 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3586 &`load `& system load checks
3587 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3588 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3589 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3590 &`memory `& memory handling
3591 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3592 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3593 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3594 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3595 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3596 &`retry `& retry handling
3597 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3598 &`route `& address routing
3599 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3600 &`tls `& TLS logic
3601 &`transport `& transports
3602 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3603 &`verify `& address verification logic
3604 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3605 .endd
3606 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3607 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3608 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3609 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3610 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3611 turn everything off.
3612
3613 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3614 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3615 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3616 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3617 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3618 rather than stderr.
3619
3620 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3621 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3622 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3623 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3624 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3625 run in parallel.
3626
3627 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3628 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3629 in processing.
3630
3631 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3632 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3633
3634 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3635 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3636 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3637 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3638 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3639 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3640
3641 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3642 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3643 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3644 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3645 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3646
3647 .vitem &%-E%&
3648 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3649 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3650 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3651 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3652 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3653 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3654 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3655 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3656 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3657
3658 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3659 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3660 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3661 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3662 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3663 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3664
3665 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3666 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3667 .cindex "sender" "name"
3668 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3669 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3670 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3671 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3672 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3673 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3674
3675 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3676 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3677 .cindex "sender" "address"
3678 .cindex "address" "sender"
3679 .cindex "trusted users"
3680 .cindex "envelope sender"
3681 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3682 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3683 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3684 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3685 users to use it.
3686
3687 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3688 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3689 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3690 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3691 domain.
3692
3693 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3694 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3695 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3696 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3697 examples of shell commands:
3698 .code
3699 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3700 exim -f "" user@domain
3701 .endd
3702 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3703 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3704 &%-bv%& options.
3705
3706 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3707 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3708 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3709 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3710
3711 White
3712 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3713 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3714 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3715 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3716 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3717 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3718
3719 .vitem &%-G%&
3720 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3721 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3722 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3723 .code
3724 control = suppress_local_fixups
3725 .endd
3726 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3727 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3728 in future.
3729
3730 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3731 this option.
3732
3733 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3734 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3735 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3736 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3737 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3738 headers.)
3739
3740 .vitem &%-i%&
3741 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3742 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3743 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3744 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3745 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3746 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3747 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3748
3749 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3750 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3751 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3752 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3753 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3754 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3755 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3756 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3757
3758 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3759
3760 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3761 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3762 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3763 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3764 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3765 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3766 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3767 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3768 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3769
3770 Retry
3771 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3772 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3773 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3774 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3775 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3776 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3777
3778 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3779 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3780 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3781 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3782
3783 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3784 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3785 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3786 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3787 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3788 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3789 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3790 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3791 can be used only by an admin user.
3792
3793 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3794 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3795 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3796 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3797 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3798 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3799 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3800 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3801 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3802 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3803 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3804
3805 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3806 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3807 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3808 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3809 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3810
3811 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3812 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3813 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3814 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3815 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3816
3817 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3818 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3819 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3820 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3821 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3822
3823 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3824 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3825 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3826 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3827 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3828 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3829 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3830 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3831
3832 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3833 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3834 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3835 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3836 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3837 connection.
3838
3839 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3840 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3841 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3842 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3843 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3844
3845 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3846 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3847 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3848 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3849 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3850 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3851 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3852 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3853 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3854 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3855 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3856 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3857 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3858 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3859 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3860
3861 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3862 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3863 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3864 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3865 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3866 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3867 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3868 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3869 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3870 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3871
3872 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3873 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3874 .cindex "freezing messages"
3875 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3876 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3877 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3878 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3879 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3880 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3881 user.
3882
3883 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3884 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3885 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3886 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3887 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3888 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3889 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3890 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3891 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3892 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3893 user.
3894
3895 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3896 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3897 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3898 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3899 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3900 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3901 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3902
3903 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3904 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3905 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3906 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3907 .cindex "removing recipients"
3908 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3909 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3910 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3911 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3912 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3913 can be used only by an admin user.
3914
3915 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3916 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3917 .cindex "removing messages"
3918 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3919 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3920 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3921 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3922 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3923 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3924 placed on the queue.
3925
3926 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3927 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3928 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3929 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3930 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3931 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3932 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3933 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3934 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3935 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3936 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3937
3938 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3939 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3940 .cindex "thawing messages"
3941 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3942 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3943 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3944 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3945 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3946 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3947 by an admin user.
3948
3949 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3950 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3951 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3952 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3953 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3954 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3955
3956 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3957 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3958 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3959 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3960 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3961 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3962 only by an admin user.
3963
3964 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3965 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3966 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3967 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3968 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3969 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3970 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3971
3972 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3973 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3974 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3975 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3976 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3977 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3978
3979 .vitem &%-m%&
3980 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3981 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3982 treats it that way too.
3983
3984 .vitem &%-N%&
3985 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3986 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3987 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3988 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3989 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3990 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3991 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3992 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3993 than &"=>"&.
3994
3995 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3996 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3997 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3998 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3999 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4000 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4001 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4002 for that message.
4003
4004 .vitem &%-n%&
4005 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4006 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4007 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4008 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4009
4010 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4011 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4012 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4013 Exim.
4014
4015 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4016 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4017 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4018 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4019 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4020 description above.
4021
4022 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4023 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4024 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4025 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4026 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4027 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4028 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4029 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4030
4031 .vitem &%-odb%&
4032 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4033 .cindex "background delivery"
4034 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4035 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4036 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4037 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4038 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4039 processes to finish.
4040
4041 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4042 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4043 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4044 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4045
4046 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4047 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4048 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4049 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4050
4051 .vitem &%-odf%&
4052 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4053 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4054 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4055 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4056 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4057 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4058 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4059
4060 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4061 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4062 during deliveries.
4063
4064 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4065 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4066
4067 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4068 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4069 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4070 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4071
4072
4073 .vitem &%-odi%&
4074 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4075 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4076 Sendmail.
4077
4078 .vitem &%-odq%&
4079 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4080 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4081 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4082 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4083 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4084 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4085 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4086 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4087 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4088 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4089 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4090 forces queueing.
4091
4092 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4093 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4094 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4095 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4096 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4097 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4098 configuration file is in effect.
4099
4100 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4101 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4102 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4103 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4104 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4105 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4106 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4107 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4108 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4109 &%-qq%& option.
4110
4111 .vitem &%-oee%&
4112 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4113 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4114 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4115 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4116 message.
4117
4118 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4119 Provided
4120 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4121 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4122 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4123 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4124
4125 .vitem &%-oem%&
4126 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4127 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4128 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4129 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4130 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4131 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4132
4133 .vitem &%-oep%&
4134 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4135 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4136 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4137 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4138 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4139 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4140
4141 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4142 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4143 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4144 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4145 effect as &%-oep%&.
4146
4147 .vitem &%-oew%&
4148 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4149 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4150 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4151 effect as &%-oem%&.
4152
4153 .vitem &%-oi%&
4154 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4155 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4156 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4157 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4158 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4159 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4160 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4161
4162 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4163 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4164 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4165
4166 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4167 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4168 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4169 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4170 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4171 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4172 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4173 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4174
4175 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4176 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4177 .code
4178 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4179 .endd
4180 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4181 followed by a colon and the port number:
4182 .code
4183 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4184 .endd
4185 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4186 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4187 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4188 whichever one is last.
4189
4190 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4191 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4192 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4193 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4194 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4195 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4196 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4197 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4198
4199 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4200 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4201 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4202 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4203 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4204 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4205 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4206 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4207
4208 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4209 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4210 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4211 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4212 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4213 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4214 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4215 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4216 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4217 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4218
4219 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4220 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4221 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4222 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4223 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4224 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4225 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4226
4227 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4228 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4229 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4230 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4231 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4232 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4233 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4234 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4235 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4236
4237 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4238 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4239 is sending the bounce.
4240
4241 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4242 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4243 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4244 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4245 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4246 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4247 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4248 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4249 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4250 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4251 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4252 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4253
4254 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4255 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4256 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4257 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4258 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4259 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4260 uses the name it is given.
4261
4262 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4263 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4264 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4265 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4266 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4267 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4268 used, when there is no default.
4269
4270 .vitem &%-om%&
4271 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4272 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4273 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4274 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4275 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4276
4277 .vitem &%-oo%&
4278 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4279 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4280 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4281 whatever that means.
4282
4283 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4284 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4285 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4286 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4287 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4288 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4289 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4290 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4291 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4292
4293 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4294 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4295 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4296 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4297 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4298 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4299 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4300
4301 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4302 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4303 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4304 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4305 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4306 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4307 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4308 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4309
4310 .vitem &%-ov%&
4311 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4312 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4313
4314 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4315 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4316 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4317 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4318 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4319 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4320 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4321 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4322 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4323 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4324
4325 .vitem &%-pd%&
4326 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4327 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4328 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4329 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4330 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4331 needed.
4332
4333 .vitem &%-ps%&
4334 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4335 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4336 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4337 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4338 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4339 started.
4340
4341 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4342 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4343 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4344 .display
4345 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4346 .endd
4347 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4348 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4349 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4350 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4351 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4352
4353 .vitem &%-q%&
4354 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4355 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4356 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4357 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4358 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4359 and &%-S%& options).
4360
4361 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4362 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4363 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4364 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4365 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4366 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4367
4368 If
4369 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4370 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4371 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4372 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4373 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4374 proceeding.
4375
4376 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4377 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4378 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4379 this to be repeated periodically.
4380
4381 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4382 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4383 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4384 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4385
4386 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4387 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4388 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4389
4390 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4391 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4392 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4393 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4394
4395 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4396 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4397 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4398 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4399 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4400 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4401 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4402 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4403 transports are run.
4404
4405 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4406 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4407 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4408 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4409 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4410 delivered down a single SMTP
4411 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4412 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4413 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4414 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4415 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4416 intermittently.
4417
4418 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4419 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4420 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4421 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4422 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4423 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4424 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4425
4426 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4427 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4428 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4429 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4430 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4431 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4432 their retry times are tried.
4433
4434 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4435 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4436 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4437 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4438 frozen or not.
4439
4440 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4441 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4442 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4443 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4444 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4445 for later delivery.
4446
4447 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4448 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4449 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4450 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4451 starting message id. For example:
4452 .code
4453 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4454 .endd
4455 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4456 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4457 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4458 .code
4459 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4460 .endd
4461 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4462 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4463 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4464 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4465 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4466 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4467
4468 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4469 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4470 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4471 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4472 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4473 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4474 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4475 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4476 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4477 .code
4478 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4479 .endd
4480 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4481 process every 30 minutes.
4482
4483 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4484 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4485
4486 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4487 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4488 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4489 compatibility.
4490
4491 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4492 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4493 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4494
4495 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4496 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4497 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4498 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4499 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4500 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4501 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4502 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4503 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4504
4505 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4506 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4507 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4508 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4509 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4510 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4511
4512 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4513 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4514 .code
4515 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4516 .endd
4517 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4518 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4519 applied to each queue run.
4520
4521 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4522 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4523 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4524 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4525 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4526 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4527 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4528 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4529 address will be skipped.
4530
4531 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4532 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4533 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4534 &'ff'& is present.
4535
4536 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4537 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4538 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4539 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4540 an arbitrary command instead.
4541
4542 .vitem &%-r%&
4543 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4544 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4545
4546 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4547 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4548 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4549 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4550 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4551 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4552 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4553 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4554
4555 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4556 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4557 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4558 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4559 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4560
4561 .vitem &%-t%&
4562 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4563 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4564 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4565 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4566 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4567 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4568 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4569 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4570 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4571 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4572
4573 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4574 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4575 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4576 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4577 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4578 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4579 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4580 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4581 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4582 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4583 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4584
4585 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4586 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4587 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4588 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4589 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4590 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4591
4592 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4593 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4594 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4595 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4596 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4597 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4598 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4599 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4600 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4601
4602 .vitem &%-ti%&
4603 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4604 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4605 compatibility with Sendmail.
4606
4607 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4608 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4609 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4610 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4611 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4612 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4613 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4614 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4615
4616
4617 .vitem &%-U%&
4618 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4619 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4620 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4621 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4622 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4623 set. Exim ignores this option.
4624
4625 .vitem &%-v%&
4626 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4627 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4628 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4629 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4630 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4631 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4632 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4633 unconditional.
4634
4635 .vitem &%-x%&
4636 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4637 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4638 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4639 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4640 this option.
4641
4642 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4643 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4644 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4645 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4646
4647 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4648 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4649 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4650 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4651 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4652 under most shells.
4653 .endlist
4654
4655 .ecindex IIDclo1
4656 .ecindex IIDclo2
4657
4658
4659 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4660 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4661 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4662 . creates a man page for the options.
4663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4664
4665 .literal xml
4666 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4667 .literal off
4668
4669
4670
4671
4672
4673 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4674 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4675
4676
4677 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4678 "The runtime configuration file"
4679
4680 .cindex "run time configuration"
4681 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4682 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4683 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4684 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4685 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4686 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4687 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4688 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4689 control.
4690
4691 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4692 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4693 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4694 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4695 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4696 actually alter the string.
4697
4698 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4699 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4700 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4701 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4702 existing file in the list.
4703
4704 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4705 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4706 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4707 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4708 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4709 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4710 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4711 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4712 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4713 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4714 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4715
4716 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4717 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4718 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4719 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4720 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4721
4722 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4723 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4724 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4725 compromise the Exim user account.
4726
4727 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4728 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4729 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4730 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4731 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4732 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4733 configuration.
4734
4735
4736
4737 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4738 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4739 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4740 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4741 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4742 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4743 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4744 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4745 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4746 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4747 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4748
4749 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4750 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4751 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4752 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4753 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4754 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4755 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4756 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4757 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4758 &%-M%&).
4759
4760 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4761 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4762 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4763 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4764 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4765
4766 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4767 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4768 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4769 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4770 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4771 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4772
4773 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4774 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4775 necessarily be discarded.
4776 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4777 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4778 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4779 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4780 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4781 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4782
4783 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4784 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4785 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4786 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4787 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4788 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4789 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4790
4791 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4792 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4793 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4794
4795
4796
4797 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4798 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4799 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4800 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4801 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4802 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4803 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4804 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4805
4806 .ilist
4807 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4808 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4809 .next
4810 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4811 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4812 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4813 .next
4814 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4815 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4816 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4817 .next
4818 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4819 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4820 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4821 .next
4822 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4823 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4824 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4825 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4826 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4827 .next
4828 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4829 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4830 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4831 .next
4832 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4833 want to use this feature, you must set
4834 .code
4835 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4836 .endd
4837 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4838 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4839 .endlist
4840
4841 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4842 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4843 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4844 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4845
4846 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4847 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4848 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4849 and does not introduce a comment.
4850
4851 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4852 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4853 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4854 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4855 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4856
4857 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4858 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4859 change settings as required.
4860
4861 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4862 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4863 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4864 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4865 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4866 described.
4867
4868
4869
4870 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4871 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4872 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4873 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4874 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4875 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4876 using this syntax:
4877 .display
4878 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4879 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4880 .endd
4881 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4882 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4883 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4884 name is required.
4885
4886 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4887 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4888 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4889 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4890
4891 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4892 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4893 for example:
4894 .code
4895 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4896 .include /some/file
4897 .endd
4898 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4899 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4900 inclusion appears.
4901
4902
4903
4904 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4905 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4906 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4907 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4908 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4909 definition, and must be of the form
4910 .display
4911 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4912 .endd
4913 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4914 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4915 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4916 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4917 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4918
4919 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4920 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4921 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4922
4923 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4924 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4925 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4926 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4927 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4928 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4929 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4930 define
4931 .display
4932 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4933 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4934 .endd
4935 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4936 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4937 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4938 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4939 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4940 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4941
4942
4943 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4944 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4945 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4946 &'='&. For example:
4947 .code
4948 MAC = initial value
4949 ...
4950 MAC == updated value
4951 .endd
4952 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4953 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4954 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4955 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4956 .code
4957 MAC = initial value
4958 ...
4959 MAC == MAC and something added
4960 .endd
4961 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4962 from a number of other files.
4963
4964 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4965 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4966 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4967 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4968 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4969 file to be ignored.
4970
4971
4972
4973 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4974 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4975 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4976 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4977 .code
4978 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4979 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4980 .endd
4981 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4982 .code
4983 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4984 .endd
4985 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4986 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4987 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4988
4989
4990 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4991 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4992 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4993 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4994 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4995 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4996 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4997
4998 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4999 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5000 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5001 line. Thus:
5002 .code
5003 .ifdef AAA
5004 message_size_limit = 50M
5005 .else
5006 message_size_limit = 100M
5007 .endif
5008 .endd
5009 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5010 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5011 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5012 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5013 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5014
5015 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5016 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5017 in this line"& will always be true.
5018
5019 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5020 to clarify complicated nestings.
5021
5022
5023
5024 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5025 .cindex "common option syntax"
5026 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5027 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5028 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5029 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5030 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5031 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5032 space) and then the value. For example:
5033 .code
5034 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5035 .endd
5036 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5037 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5038 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5039 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5040 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5041 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5042 word &"hide"&. For example:
5043 .code
5044 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5045 .endd
5046 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5047 .code
5048 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5049 .endd
5050 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5051 all instances of the same driver.
5052
5053 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5054 that are found in option settings.
5055
5056
5057 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5058 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5059 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5060 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5061 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5062 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5063 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5064 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5065 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5066 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5067 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5068 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5069 .code
5070 queue_only
5071 queue_only = true
5072 .endd
5073 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5074 .code
5075 no_queue_only
5076 queue_only = false
5077 .endd
5078 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5079
5080
5081
5082
5083 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5084 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5085 .cindex "format" "integer"
5086 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5087 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5088 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5089 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5090 hexadecimal number.
5091
5092 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5093 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5094 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5095 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5096 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5097 used.
5098
5099
5100 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5101 .cindex "integer format"
5102 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5103 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5104 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5105 Such options are always output in octal.
5106
5107
5108 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5109 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5110 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5111 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5112 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5113
5114
5115
5116 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5117 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5118 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5119 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5120 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5121
5122 .table2 30pt
5123 .irow &%s%& seconds
5124 .irow &%m%& minutes
5125 .irow &%h%& hours
5126 .irow &%d%& days
5127 .irow &%w%& weeks
5128 .endtable
5129
5130 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5131 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5132 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5133
5134
5135
5136 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5137 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5138 .cindex "format" "string"
5139 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5140 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5141 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5142 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5143 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5144 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5145 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5146 therefore equivalent:
5147 .code
5148 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5149 trusted_users = uucp:\
5150 # This comment line is ignored
5151 mail
5152 .endd
5153 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5154 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5155 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5156 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5157 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5158
5159 .table2 100pt
5160 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5161 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5162 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5163 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5164 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5165 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5166 character"
5167 .endtable
5168
5169 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5170 character, that character replaces the pair.
5171
5172 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5173 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5174 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5175 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5176 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5177 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5178
5179
5180 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5181 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5182 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5183 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5184 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5185 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5186 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5187 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5188 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5189 within a quoted configuration string.
5190
5191
5192 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5193 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5194 .cindex "format" "user name"
5195 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5196 .cindex "format" "group name"
5197 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5198 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5199 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5200 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5201
5202
5203 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5204 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5205 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5206 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5207 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5208 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5209 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5210 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5211 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5212 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5213 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5214
5215 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5216 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5217 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5218 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5219 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5220 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5221 example, the list
5222 .code
5223 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5224 .endd
5225 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5226
5227 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5228 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5229 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5230 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5231
5232 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5233 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5234 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5235 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5236 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5237 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5238 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5239 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5240 .code
5241 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5242 .endd
5243 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5244 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5245 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5246
5247 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5248 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5249 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5250 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5251 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5252 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5253 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5254 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5255 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5256 .code
5257 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5258 .endd
5259 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5260 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5261 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5262 the value in quotes. For example:
5263 .code
5264 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5265 .endd
5266 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5267 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5268 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5269 enclosing an empty list item.
5270
5271
5272
5273 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5274 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5275 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5276 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5277 .code
5278 senders = user@domain :
5279 .endd
5280 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5281 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5282 items, the second of which is empty:
5283 .code
5284 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5285 .endd
5286 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5287 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5288 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5289 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5290 .code
5291 senders = :
5292 .endd
5293 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5294 is at the end of the list.
5295
5296
5297
5298
5299 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5300 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5301 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5302 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5303 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5304 a sequence of lines like this:
5305 .display
5306 <&'instance name'&>:
5307 <&'option'&>
5308 ...
5309 <&'option'&>
5310 .endd
5311 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5312 followed by three options settings:
5313 .code
5314 localuser:
5315 driver = accept
5316 check_local_user
5317 transport = local_delivery
5318 .endd
5319 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5320 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5321 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5322 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5323 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5324 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5325
5326 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5327 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5328
5329 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5330 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5331 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5332 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5333 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5334 server.
5335
5336 .cindex "generic options"
5337 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5338 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5339 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5340 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5341 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5342 .cindex "private options"
5343 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5344 they all have default values.
5345
5346 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5347 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5348 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5349
5350 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5351 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5352 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5353 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5354 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5355 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5356 configuration lines:
5357 .code
5358 remote_smtp:
5359 driver = smtp
5360 .endd
5361 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5362 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5363 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5364 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5365 thus:
5366 .code
5367 special_smtp:
5368 driver = smtp
5369 port = 1234
5370 command_timeout = 10s
5371 .endd
5372 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5373 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5374 lines.
5375
5376 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5377 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5378 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5379 option.
5380
5381
5382
5383
5384
5385
5386 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5387 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5388
5389 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5390 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5391 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5392 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5393 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5394 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5395 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5396 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5397 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5398 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5399 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5400
5401
5402
5403 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5404 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5405 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5406 the line
5407 .code
5408 # primary_hostname =
5409 .endd
5410 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5411 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5412 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5413 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5414
5415 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5416 .code
5417 domainlist local_domains = @
5418 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5419 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5420 .endd
5421 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5422 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5423 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5424 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5425
5426 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5427 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5428 on the local host.
5429
5430 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5431 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5432 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5433 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5434 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5435 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5436
5437 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5438 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5439 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5440 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5441 domain is permitted.
5442
5443 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5444 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5445 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5446 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5447 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5448 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5449
5450 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5451 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5452 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5453
5454 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5455 .code
5456 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5457 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5458 .endd
5459 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5460 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5461 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5462 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5463 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5464 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5465 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5466 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5467 contents of a message to be checked.
5468
5469 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5470 .code
5471 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5472 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5473 .endd
5474 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5475 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5476 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5477 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5478
5479 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5480 .code
5481 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5482 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5483 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5484 .endd
5485 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5486 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5487 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5488 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5489 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5490 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5491 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5492
5493 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5494 .code
5495 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5496 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5497 .endd
5498 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5499 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5500 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5501 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5502 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5503 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5504 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5505 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5506 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5507 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5508 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5509 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5510 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5511 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5512 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5513 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5514
5515 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5516 .code
5517 # qualify_domain =
5518 # qualify_recipient =
5519 .endd
5520 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5521 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5522 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5523 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5524 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5525 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5526
5527 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5528 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5529 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5530 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5531 .code
5532 # allow_domain_literals
5533 .endd
5534 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5535 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5536 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5537 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5538 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5539 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5540
5541 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5542 .code
5543 never_users = root
5544 .endd
5545 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5546 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5547 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5548 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5549 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5550 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5551 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5552 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5553
5554 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5555 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5556 line,
5557 .code
5558 host_lookup = *
5559 .endd
5560 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5561 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5562 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5563 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5564 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5565 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5566 unreachable.
5567
5568 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5569 1413 (hence their names):
5570 .code
5571 rfc1413_hosts = *
5572 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5573 .endd
5574 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5575 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5576 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5577 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5578 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5579 information, you can change this.
5580
5581 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5582 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5583 .code
5584 prdr_enable = true
5585 .endd
5586
5587 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5588 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5589 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5590 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5591 .code
5592 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5593 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5594 .endd
5595 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5596 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5597
5598 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5599 over the default:
5600 .code
5601 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5602 +tls_certificate_verified
5603 .endd
5604
5605 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5606 .code
5607 # percent_hack_domains =
5608 .endd
5609 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5610 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5611 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5612
5613 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5614 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5615 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5616 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5617 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5618 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5619 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5620 always bounce messages.
5621 .code
5622 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5623 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5624 .endd
5625 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5626 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5627 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5628 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5629 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5630
5631
5632
5633 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5634 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5635 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5636 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5637 It starts with the line
5638 .code
5639 begin acl
5640 .endd
5641 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5642 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5643 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5644
5645 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5646 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5647 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5648 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5649 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5650 result of the ACL processing.
5651 .code
5652 acl_check_rcpt:
5653 .endd
5654 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5655 ACL, and names it.
5656 .code
5657 accept hosts = :
5658 .endd
5659 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5660 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5661 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5662 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5663 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5664 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5665
5666 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5667 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5668 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5669 manner.
5670 .code
5671 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5672 domains = +local_domains
5673 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5674
5675 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5676 domains = !+local_domains
5677 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5678 .endd
5679 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5680 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5681 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5682 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5683 in Internet mail addresses.
5684
5685 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5686 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5687 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5688 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5689 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5690 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5691 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5692 policy of being as safe as possible.
5693
5694 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5695 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5696 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5697 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5698 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5699 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5700
5701 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5702 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5703 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5704 have to modify this rule.
5705
5706 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5707 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5708 common convention of local parts constructed as
5709 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5710 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5711 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5712 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5713 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5714 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5715
5716 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5717 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5718 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5719 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5720 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5721 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5722 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5723 .code
5724 accept local_parts = postmaster
5725 domains = +local_domains
5726 .endd
5727 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5728 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5729 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5730 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5731 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5732
5733 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5734 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5735 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5736 .code
5737 require verify = sender
5738 .endd
5739 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5740 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5741 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5742 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5743 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5744 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5745 discusses the details of address verification.
5746 .code
5747 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5748 control = submission
5749 .endd
5750 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5751 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5752 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5753 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5754 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5755 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5756 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5757 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5758 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5759 .code
5760 accept authenticated = *
5761 control = submission
5762 .endd
5763 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5764 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5765 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5766 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5767 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5768 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5769 .code
5770 require message = relay not permitted
5771 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5772 .endd
5773 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5774 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5775 .code
5776 require verify = recipient
5777 .endd
5778 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5779 fails, the address is rejected.
5780 .code
5781 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5782 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5783 # $dnslist_text
5784 # dnslists = black.list.example
5785 #
5786 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5787 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5788 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5789 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5790 .endd
5791 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5792 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5793 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5794 line.
5795 .code
5796 # require verify = csa
5797 .endd
5798 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5799 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5800 records.
5801 .code
5802 accept
5803 .endd
5804 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5805 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5806 .code
5807 acl_check_data:
5808 .endd
5809 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5810 of this ACL are commented out:
5811 .code
5812 # deny malware = *
5813 # message = This message contains a virus \
5814 # ($malware_name).
5815 .endd
5816 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5817 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5818 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5819 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5820 .code
5821 # warn spam = nobody
5822 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5823 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5824 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5825 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5826 .endd
5827 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5828 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5829 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5830 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5831 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5832 whatever the spam score.
5833 .code
5834 accept
5835 .endd
5836 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5837
5838
5839 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5840 .cindex "default" "routers"
5841 .cindex "routers" "default"
5842 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5843 by the line
5844 .code
5845 begin routers
5846 .endd
5847 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5848 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5849 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5850 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5851 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5852 .code
5853 # domain_literal:
5854 # driver = ipliteral
5855 # domains = !+local_domains
5856 # transport = remote_smtp
5857 .endd
5858 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5859 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5860 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5861 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5862 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5863 .code
5864 dnslookup:
5865 driver = dnslookup
5866 domains = ! +local_domains
5867 transport = remote_smtp
5868 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5869 no_more
5870 .endd
5871 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5872 domains. This is specified by the line
5873 .code
5874 domains = ! +local_domains
5875 .endd
5876 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5877 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5878 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5879 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5880 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5881 passed on to the following routers.
5882
5883 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5884 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5885 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5886 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5887 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5888
5889 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5890 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5891 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5892 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5893 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5894 the address fails and is bounced.
5895
5896 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5897 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5898 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5899 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5900 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5901 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5902 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5903 out.
5904 .code
5905 system_aliases:
5906 driver = redirect
5907 allow_fail
5908 allow_defer
5909 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5910 # user = exim
5911 file_transport = address_file
5912 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5913 .endd
5914 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5915 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5916 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5917 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5918 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5919 the next router.
5920
5921 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5922 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5923 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5924 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5925 .code
5926 userforward:
5927 driver = redirect
5928 check_local_user
5929 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5930 # local_part_suffix_optional
5931 file = $home/.forward
5932 # allow_filter
5933 no_verify
5934 no_expn
5935 check_ancestor
5936 file_transport = address_file
5937 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5938 reply_transport = address_reply
5939 .endd
5940 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5941 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5942 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5943 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5944 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5945 namely:
5946 .code
5947 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5948 # local_part_suffix_optional
5949 .endd
5950 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5951 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5952 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5953 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5954 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5955 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5956 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5957
5958 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5959 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5960 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5961 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5962
5963 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5964 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5965 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5966 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5967 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5968 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5969 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5970
5971 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5972 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5973 There are two reasons for doing this:
5974
5975 .olist
5976 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5977 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5978 unnecessary work.
5979 .next
5980 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5981 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5982 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5983 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5984 this time.
5985 .endlist
5986
5987 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5988 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5989 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5990 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5991
5992 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5993 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5994 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5995 .code
5996 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5997 .endd
5998 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5999 transport.
6000 .code
6001 localuser:
6002 driver = accept
6003 check_local_user
6004 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6005 # local_part_suffix_optional
6006 transport = local_delivery
6007 .endd
6008 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6009 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6010 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6011 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6012 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6013
6014
6015 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6016 .cindex "default" "transports"
6017 .cindex "transports" "default"
6018 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6019 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6020 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6021 .code
6022 begin transports
6023 .endd
6024 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6025 .code
6026 remote_smtp:
6027 driver = smtp
6028 hosts_try_prdr = *
6029 .endd
6030 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6031 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6032 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6033 It is negotiated between client and server
6034 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6035 All other options are defaulted.
6036 .code
6037 local_delivery:
6038 driver = appendfile
6039 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6040 delivery_date_add
6041 envelope_to_add
6042 return_path_add
6043 # group = mail
6044 # mode = 0660
6045 .endd
6046 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6047 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6048 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6049 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6050 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6051 show how this can be done.
6052
6053 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6054 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6055 similarly-named options above.
6056 .code
6057 address_pipe:
6058 driver = pipe
6059 return_output
6060 .endd
6061 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6062 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6063 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6064 be returned to the sender.
6065 .code
6066 address_file:
6067 driver = appendfile
6068 delivery_date_add
6069 envelope_to_add
6070 return_path_add
6071 .endd
6072 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6073 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6074 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6075 .code
6076 address_reply:
6077 driver = autoreply
6078 .endd
6079 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6080 filter files.
6081
6082
6083
6084 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6085 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6086 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6087 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6088 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6089 introduced by the line
6090 .code
6091 begin retry
6092 .endd
6093 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6094 errors:
6095 .code
6096 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6097 .endd
6098 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6099 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6100 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6101 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6102
6103 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6104 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6105 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6106
6107
6108 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6109 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6110 .code
6111 begin rewrite
6112 .endd
6113 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6114 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6115
6116
6117
6118 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6119 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6120 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6121 .code
6122 begin authenticators
6123 .endd
6124 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6125 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6126 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6127 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6128 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6129 to support most MUA software.
6130
6131 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6132 .code
6133 #PLAIN:
6134 # driver = plaintext
6135 # server_set_id = $auth2
6136 # server_prompts = :
6137 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6138 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6139 .endd
6140 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6141 .code
6142 #LOGIN:
6143 # driver = plaintext
6144 # server_set_id = $auth1
6145 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6146 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6147 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6148 .endd
6149
6150 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6151 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6152 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6153 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6154 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6155 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6156 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6157 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6158
6159 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6160 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6161 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6162 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6163
6164 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6165 usercode and password are in different positions.
6166 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6167
6168 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6169
6170
6171
6172 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6173 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6174
6175 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6176
6177 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6178 .cindex "PCRE"
6179 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6180 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6181 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6182 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6183 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6184 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6185
6186 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6187 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6188 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6189 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6190 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6191 case-insensitive.
6192
6193 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6194 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6195 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6196 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6197 .code
6198 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6199 .endd
6200 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6201 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6202 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6203 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6204 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6205 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6206 matched.
6207
6208 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6209 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6210 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6211 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6212 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6213 match anywhere in the subject string.
6214
6215 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6216 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6217 .code
6218 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6219 .endd
6220 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6221 You need to use:
6222 .code
6223 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6224 .endd
6225 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6226 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6227
6228
6229
6230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6231 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6232
6233 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6234 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6235 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6236 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6237 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6238 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6239
6240 .olist
6241 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6242 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6243 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6244 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6245 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6246 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6247 .next
6248 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6249 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6250 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6251 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6252 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6253 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6254 .endlist
6255
6256 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6257 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6258 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6259 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6260 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6261 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6262
6263 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6264 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6265 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6266 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6267 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6268 .code
6269 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6270 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6271 .endd
6272 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6273 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6274 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6275 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6276 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6277 .code
6278 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6279 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6280 .endd
6281 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6282 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6283
6284 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6285 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6286 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6287 .code
6288 domain1:
6289 domain2:
6290 .endd
6291 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6292 matches the list item.
6293
6294 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6295 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6296 .code
6297 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6298 .endd
6299 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6300 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6301 causes a second lookup to occur.
6302
6303 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6304 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6305 lookup is permitted.
6306
6307
6308 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6309 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6310 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6311 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6312
6313 .ilist
6314 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6315 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6316 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6317 .next
6318 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6319 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6320 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6321 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6322 .endlist
6323
6324 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6325 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6326 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6327 .code
6328 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6329 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6330 .endd
6331 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6332 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6333 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6334
6335
6336
6337
6338 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6339 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6340 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6341 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6342
6343 .ilist
6344 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6345 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6346 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6347 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6348 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6349 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6350 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6351 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6352 be found in several places:
6353 .display
6354 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6355 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6356 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6357 .endd
6358 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6359 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6360 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6361 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6362 .next
6363 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6364 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6365 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6366 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6367 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6368 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6369 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6370
6371 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6372 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6373 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6374 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6375 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6376 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6377 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6378 .next
6379 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6380 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6381 .cindex "sasldb2"
6382 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6383 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6384 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6385 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6386 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6387 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6388 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6389 .next
6390 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6391 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6392 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6393 .cindex "Courier"
6394 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6395 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6396 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6397 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6398 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6399 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6400 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6401 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6402 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6403 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6404 .next
6405 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6406 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6407 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6408 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6409 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6410 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6411 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6412 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6413 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6414 .next
6415 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6416 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6417 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6418 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6419 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6420 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6421 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6422 .code
6423 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6424 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6425 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6426 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6427 .endd
6428 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6429 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6430 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6431 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6432 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6433
6434 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6435 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6436 lookup types support only literal keys.
6437
6438 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6439 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6440 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6441 .next
6442 .cindex "linear search"
6443 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6444 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6445 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6446 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6447 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6448 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6449 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6450 in the file is used.
6451
6452 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6453 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6454 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6455 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6456 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6457 colon, for example:
6458 .code
6459 baduser: :fail:
6460 .endd
6461 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6462 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6463 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6464 wildcarding of any kind.
6465
6466 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6467 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6468 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6469 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6470 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6471 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6472 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6473 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6474 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6475
6476 .next
6477 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6478 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6479 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6480 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6481 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6482 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6483 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6484 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6485
6486 .next
6487 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6488 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6489 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6490 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6491 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6492 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6493 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6494 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6495 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6496
6497 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6498 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6499 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6500 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6501
6502 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6503 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6504
6505 .olist
6506 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6507 .code
6508 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6509 *fish data for anythingfish
6510 .endd
6511 .next
6512 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6513 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6514 .code
6515 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6516 .endd
6517 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6518 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6519 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6520 .code
6521 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6522 .endd
6523 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6524 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6525 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6526 .code
6527 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6528 .endd
6529
6530 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6531 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6532 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6533 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6534 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6535
6536 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6537 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6538 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6539 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6540 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6541
6542 .next
6543 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6544 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6545 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6546 example:
6547 .code
6548 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6549 .endd
6550 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6551 .endlist olist
6552
6553 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6554 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6555 be followed by optional colons.
6556
6557 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6558 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6559 lookup types support only literal keys.
6560 .endlist ilist
6561
6562
6563 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6564 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6565 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6566 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6567 many of them are given in later sections.
6568
6569 .ilist
6570 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6571 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6572 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6573 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6574 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6575 .next
6576 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6577 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6578 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6579 .next
6580 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6581 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6582 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6583 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6584 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6585 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6586 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6587 .next
6588 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6589 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6590 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6591 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6592 .next
6593 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6594 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6595 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6596 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6597 .next
6598 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6599 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6600 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6601 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6602 .next
6603 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6604 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6605 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6606 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6607 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6608 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6609 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6610 password value. For example:
6611 .code
6612 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6613 .endd
6614 .next
6615 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6616 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6617 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6618 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6619
6620 .next
6621 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6622 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6623 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6624 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6625
6626 .next
6627 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6628 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6629 .next
6630 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6631 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6632 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6633 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6634 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6635 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6636 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6637 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6638 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6639 .code
6640 require condition = \
6641 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6642 .endd
6643 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6644 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6645 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6646 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6647 .endlist
6648
6649
6650
6651 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6652 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6653 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6654 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6655 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6656 options such as a list of local domains.
6657
6658 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6659 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6660 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6661 or may give up altogether.
6662
6663
6664
6665 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6666 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6667 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6668 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6669 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6670 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6671 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6672 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6673
6674 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6675 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6676 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6677
6678 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6679 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6680 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6681
6682 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6683 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6684 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6685 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6686 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6687 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6688 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6689 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6690 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6691 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6692 .code
6693 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6694 .endd
6695 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6696 looks up these keys, in this order:
6697 .code
6698 jane@eyre.example
6699 *@eyre.example
6700 *
6701 .endd
6702 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6703 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6704 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6705 Exim move on to try the next key.
6706
6707
6708
6709 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6710 .cindex "partial matching"
6711 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6712 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6713 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6714 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6715 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6716 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6717 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6718 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6719 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6720 a key in a DBM file is
6721 .code
6722 *.dates.fict.example
6723 .endd
6724 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6725 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6726 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6727 file.
6728
6729 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6730 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6731 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6732
6733 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6734 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6735 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6736 partial matching keys
6737 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6738 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6739 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6740
6741 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6742 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6743 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6744 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6745 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6746 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6747 remains.
6748
6749 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6750 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6751 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6752 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6753 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6754 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6755 .code
6756 2250.dates.fict.example
6757 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6758 *.dates.fict.example
6759 *.fict.example
6760 .endd
6761 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6762 finishes.
6763
6764 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6765 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6766 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6767 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6768 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6769 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6770 .code
6771 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6772 .endd
6773 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6774 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6775 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6776 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6777 .code
6778 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6779 .endd
6780 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6781 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6782
6783 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6784 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6785 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6786
6787 .ilist
6788 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6789 .next
6790 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6791 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6792 .next
6793 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6794 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6795 for &"*"& on its own.
6796 .next
6797 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6798 .endlist
6799
6800
6801 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6802 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6803 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6804 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6805 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6806 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6807 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6808
6809 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6810 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6811 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6812 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6813 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6814
6815
6816
6817
6818 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6819 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6820 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6821 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6822 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6823 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6824 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6825
6826 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6827 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6828 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6829 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6830 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6831 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6832
6833 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6834 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6835 complete.
6836
6837
6838
6839
6840 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6841 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6842 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6843 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6844 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6845 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6846 .code
6847 [name=$local_part]
6848 .endd
6849 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6850 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6851 .code
6852 [name="$local_part"]
6853 .endd
6854 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6855 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6856 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6857 of the following form is provided:
6858 .code
6859 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6860 .endd
6861 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6862 .code
6863 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6864 .endd
6865 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6866 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6867 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6868
6869
6870
6871
6872 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6873 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6874 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6875 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6876 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6877 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6878 an expansion string could contain:
6879 .code
6880 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6881 .endd
6882 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6883 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6884 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6885 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6886
6887 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6888 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6889 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6890
6891 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6892 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6893 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6894 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6895 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6896 .code
6897 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6898 .endd
6899 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6900 white space is ignored.
6901 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6902 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6903 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6904
6905 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6906 When the type is PTR,
6907 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6908 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6909 .code
6910 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6911 .endd
6912 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6913 altered and nothing is added.
6914
6915 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6916 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6917 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6918 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6919 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6920 The field separator can be modified as above.
6921
6922 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6923 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6924 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6925 unless a field separator is specified.
6926 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6927 For SPF records the
6928 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6929 .code
6930 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6931 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6932 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6933 .endd
6934 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6935 white space is ignored.
6936
6937 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6938 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6939 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6940 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6941 specified.
6942 .code
6943 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6944 .endd
6945
6946 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6947 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6948 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6949 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6950 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
6951 each followed by a comma,
6952 that may appear before the record type.
6953
6954 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6955 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6956 a defer-option modifier.
6957 The possible keywords are
6958 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6959 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6960 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6961 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6962 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6963 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6964 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6965 .code
6966 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6967 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6968 .endd
6969 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6970 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6971
6972 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6973 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6974 The possible keywords are
6975 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6976 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6977 with the lookup.
6978 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6979 is not labelled as authenticated data
6980 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
6981 The default is &"never"&.
6982
6983 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
6984
6985 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
6986 .cindex "DNS" timeout
6987 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
6988 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
6989 (e.g. &"5s"&).
6990 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
6991
6992 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
6993 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
6994 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
6995
6996 .new
6997 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
6998 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
6999 .cindex DNS TTL
7000 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7001 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7002 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7003 .wen
7004
7005
7006 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7007 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7008 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7009 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7010 the pseudo-type MXH:
7011 .code
7012 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7013 .endd
7014 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7015 returned.
7016
7017 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7018 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7019 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7020 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7021 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7022 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7023 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7024 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7025 .code
7026 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7027 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7028 .endd
7029 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7030 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7031 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7032
7033 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7034 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7035 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7036 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7037 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7038 such a list.
7039
7040 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7041 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7042 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7043 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7044 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7045 result of a successful lookup such as:
7046 .code
7047 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7048 .endd
7049 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7050 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7051 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7052
7053 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7054 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7055 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7056 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7057 .code
7058 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7059 .endd
7060
7061
7062 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7063 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7064 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7065 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7066 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7067 .code
7068 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7069 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7070 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7071 .endd
7072 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7073 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7074 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7075 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7076
7077 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7078 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7079 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7080
7081
7082
7083
7084 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7085 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7086 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7087 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7088 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7089 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7090 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7091 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7092 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7093 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7094 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7095 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7096 .code
7097 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7098 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7099 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7100 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7101 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7102 .endd
7103 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7104 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7105
7106 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7107 the way they handle the results of a query:
7108
7109 .ilist
7110 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7111 gives an error.
7112 .next
7113 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7114 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7115 .next
7116 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7117 from all of them are returned.
7118 .endlist
7119
7120
7121 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7122 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7123 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7124 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7125
7126
7127 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7128 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7129 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7130 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7131 .code
7132 data = ${lookup ldap \
7133 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7134 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7135 .endd
7136 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7137 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7138 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7139 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7140
7141 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7142 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7143 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7144
7145 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7146 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7147 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7148 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7149 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7150 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7151 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7152 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7153 &_exim.conf_&.
7154
7155
7156 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7157 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7158 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7159 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7160 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7161 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7162
7163 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7164 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7165 the string:
7166 .code
7167 * => \2A
7168 ( => \28
7169 ) => \29
7170 \ => \5C
7171 .endd
7172 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7173 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7174 .code
7175 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7176 .endd
7177 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7178 .code
7179 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7180 .endd
7181 yields
7182 .code
7183 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7184 .endd
7185 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7186 .code
7187 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7188 .endd
7189 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7190 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7191 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7192 .code
7193 , + " \ < > ;
7194 .endd
7195 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7196 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7197 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7198 .code
7199 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7200 .endd
7201 yields
7202 .code
7203 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7204 .endd
7205 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7206 .code
7207 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7208 .endd
7209 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7210 authentication below.
7211
7212
7213 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7214 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7215 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7216 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7217 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7218 by starting it with
7219 .code
7220 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7221 .endd
7222 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7223 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7224 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7225 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7226 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7227 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7228 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7229 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7230 failures, and timeouts.
7231
7232 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7233 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7234 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7235 doubled. For example
7236 .code
7237 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7238 .endd
7239 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7240 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7241 the local host) is used.
7242
7243 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7244 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7245 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7246 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7247 not available.
7248
7249 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7250 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7251 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7252 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7253 .code
7254 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7255 .endd
7256 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7257 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7258 .code
7259 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7260 .endd
7261 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7262 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7263 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7264 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7265 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7266 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7267 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7268 backup host.
7269
7270 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7271 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7272 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7273
7274 .ilist
7275 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7276 interface.
7277 .next
7278 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7279 .endlist
7280
7281
7282 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7283 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7284
7285
7286
7287 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7288 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7289 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7290 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7291 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7292 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7293 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7294 them. The following names are recognized:
7295 .display
7296 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7297 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7298 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7299 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7300 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7301 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7302 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7303 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7304 .endd
7305 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7306 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7307 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7308 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7309
7310 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7311 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7312 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7313 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7314 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7315 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7316 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7317 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7318 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7319
7320 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7321 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7322
7323 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7324 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7325 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7326 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7327 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7328 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7329 alternate list (colon-separated).
7330
7331 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7332 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7333 .code
7334 ${lookup ldap
7335 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7336 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7337 {$value}fail}
7338 .endd
7339 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7340 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7341 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7342 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7343
7344 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7345 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7346 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7347
7348 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7349 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7350 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7351 quoting has two advantages:
7352
7353 .ilist
7354 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7355 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7356 .next
7357 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7358 .endlist
7359
7360 For example, a setting such as
7361 .code
7362 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7363 .endd
7364 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7365
7366 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7367 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7368 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7369 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7370 .code
7371 PASS=${quote:$3}
7372 .endd
7373 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7374 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7375 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7376
7377
7378
7379 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7380 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7381 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7382 as a sequence of values, for example
7383 .code
7384 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7385 .endd
7386 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7387 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7388 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7389 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7390 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7391 directory.
7392
7393 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7394 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7395 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7396
7397 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7398 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7399 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7400 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7401 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7402 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7403 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7404 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7405 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7406
7407 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7408 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7409 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7410 &%attr2%& has only one value:
7411 .code
7412 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7413 value1.1,value1,,2
7414
7415 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7416 value two
7417
7418 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7419 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7420
7421 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7422 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7423 .endd
7424 You can
7425 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7426 results of LDAP lookups.
7427 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7428 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7429 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7430 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7431 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7432 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7433
7434
7435
7436
7437 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7438 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7439 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7440 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7441 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7442 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7443 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7444 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7445 .code
7446 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7447 .endd
7448 might return the string
7449 .code
7450 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7451 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7452 .endd
7453 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7454 .code
7455 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7456 .endd
7457 would just return
7458 .code
7459 Martin Guerre
7460 .endd
7461 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7462 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7463 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7464
7465
7466
7467 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7468 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7469 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7470 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7471 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7472 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7473 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7474 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7475 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7476 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7477 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7478 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7479 might be
7480 .code
7481 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7482 {$value}fail}
7483 .endd
7484 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7485 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7486 .code
7487 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7488 {$value}}
7489 .endd
7490 might be
7491 .code
7492 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7493 .endd
7494 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7495 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7496 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7497 .code
7498 Mister X
7499 .endd
7500 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7501 with a newline between the data for each row.
7502
7503
7504 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7505 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7506 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7507 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7508 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7509 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7510 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7511 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7512 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7513 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7514 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7515 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7516 information.
7517 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7518 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7519 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7520 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7521 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7522 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7523 .code
7524 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7525 .endd
7526 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7527 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7528 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7529 .code
7530 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7531 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7532 .endd
7533 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7534 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7535 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7536 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7537 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7538 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7539
7540 .new
7541 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7542 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7543 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7544 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7545 .wen
7546
7547 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7548 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7549 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7550 done by starting the query with
7551 .display
7552 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7553 .endd
7554 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7555 .olist
7556 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7557 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7558 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7559 taken from there.
7560 .next
7561 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7562 .endlist
7563 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7564 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7565 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7566
7567 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7568 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7569 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7570 like this:
7571 .code
7572 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7573 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7574 master/db/name/pw
7575 .endd
7576 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7577 .code
7578 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7579 .endd
7580 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7581 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7582 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7583 .code
7584 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7585 .endd
7586
7587
7588 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7589 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7590 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7591 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7592 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7593 .display
7594 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7595 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7596 .endd
7597 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7598 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7599
7600 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7601 the queries.
7602
7603 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7604 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7605
7606 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7607 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7608 is zero because no rows are affected.
7609
7610
7611 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7612 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7613 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7614 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7615 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7616 looks like this:
7617 .code
7618 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7619 .endd
7620 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7621 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7622 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7623
7624 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7625 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7626 affected.
7627
7628 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7629 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7630 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7631 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7632 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7633 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7634 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7635 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7636 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7637 .code
7638 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7639 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7640 .endd
7641 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7642 .code
7643 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7644 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7645 .endd
7646 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7647 quote, which it doubles.
7648
7649 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7650 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7651 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7652 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7653 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7654 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7655 option.
7656 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7657 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7658
7659
7660 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7661 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7662
7663 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7664 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7665 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7666 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7667 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7668 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7669 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7670 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7671 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7672
7673 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7674 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7675 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7676 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7677
7678 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7679 support all the complexity available in
7680 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7681
7682
7683
7684 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7685 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7686 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7687 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7688 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7689 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7690 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7691 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7692
7693
7694 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7695 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7696 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7697
7698 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7699 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7700 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7701 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7702 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7703 .code
7704 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7705 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7706 .endd
7707 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7708 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7709 senders based on the receiving domain.
7710
7711
7712
7713
7714 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7715 .cindex "list" "negation"
7716 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7717 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7718 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7719 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7720 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7721 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7722
7723 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7724 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7725 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7726 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7727 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7728 .code
7729 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7730 .endd
7731 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7732 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7733 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7734 .code
7735 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7736 .endd
7737 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7738 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7739 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7740
7741 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7742 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7743 item.
7744
7745
7746
7747 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7748 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7749 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7750 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7751 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7752 file names are not allowed,
7753 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7754 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7755 lines:
7756
7757 .ilist
7758 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7759 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7760 .next
7761 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7762 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7763 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7764 .code
7765 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7766 .endd
7767 .endlist
7768
7769 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7770 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7771 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7772 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7773
7774 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7775 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7776 .code
7777 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7778 .endd
7779 and the file contains the lines
7780 .code
7781 !a.b.c
7782 *.b.c
7783 .endd
7784 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7785 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7786
7787
7788
7789 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7790 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7791 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7792 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7793 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7794 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7795 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7796 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7797
7798 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7799 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7800 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7801 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7802
7803
7804
7805
7806 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7807 .cindex "named lists"
7808 .cindex "list" "named"
7809 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7810 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7811 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7812 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7813 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7814 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7815 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7816 .code
7817 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7818 .endd
7819 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7820 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7821 configured with the line
7822 .code
7823 domains = +local_domains
7824 .endd
7825 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7826 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7827 .code
7828 dnslookup:
7829 driver = dnslookup
7830 domains = ! +local_domains
7831 transport = remote_smtp
7832 no_more
7833 .endd
7834 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7835 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7836 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7837 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7838 .code
7839 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7840 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7841 .endd
7842 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7843 .code
7844 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7845 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7846 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7847 .endd
7848 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7849 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7850 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7851 .code
7852 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7853 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7854 .endd
7855 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7856 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7857 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7858 .code
7859 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7860 .endd
7861 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7862 referenced lists if you can.
7863
7864 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7865 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7866 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7867 .code
7868 domains = +local_domains
7869 .endd
7870 on several of your routers
7871 or in several ACL statements,
7872 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7873 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7874 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7875 the same each time they are referenced.
7876
7877 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7878 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7879 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7880 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7881
7882
7883
7884 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7885 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7886 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7887 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7888 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7889 write
7890 .code
7891 ALIST = host1 : host2
7892 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7893 .endd
7894 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7895 .code
7896 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7897 .endd
7898 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7899 list, and write
7900 .code
7901 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7902 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7903 .endd
7904 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7905 .code
7906 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7907 .endd
7908
7909
7910 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7911 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7912 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7913 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7914 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7915 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7916 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7917 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7918 message. For example:
7919 .code
7920 domainlist special_domains = \
7921 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7922 .endd
7923 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7924 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7925 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7926 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7927 same list each time.
7928
7929 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7930 cache the result anyway. For example:
7931 .code
7932 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7933 .endd
7934 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7935 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7936
7937
7938
7939 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7940 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7941 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7942 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7943 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7944
7945 .ilist
7946 .cindex "primary host name"
7947 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7948 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7949 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7950 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7951 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7952 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7953 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7954 differ only in their names.
7955 .next
7956 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7957 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7958 .cindex "domain literal"
7959 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7960 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7961 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7962 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7963 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7964 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7965 .next
7966 .cindex "@mx_any"
7967 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7968 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7969 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7970 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7971 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7972 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7973 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7974 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7975 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7976 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7977 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7978
7979 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7980 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7981 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7982 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7983 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7984
7985 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7986 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7987 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7988 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7989 on a router). For example:
7990 .code
7991 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7992 .endd
7993 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7994 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7995
7996 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7997 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7998 contain negative items.
7999
8000 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8001 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8002 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8003 .code
8004 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8005 an.other.domain : ...
8006 .endd
8007 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8008 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8009 .code
8010 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8011 an.other.domain ? ...
8012 .endd
8013 .next
8014 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8015 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8016 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8017 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8018 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8019 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8020 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8021 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8022 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8023 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8024
8025 .next
8026 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8027 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8028 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8029 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8030 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8031 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8032 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8033 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8034 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8035
8036 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8037 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8038 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8039 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8040 expression by expansion, of course).
8041 .next
8042 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8043 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8044 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8045 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8046 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8047 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8048 .code
8049 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8050 .endd
8051 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8052 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8053 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8054 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8055 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8056 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8057 other statements in the same ACL.
8058
8059 .next
8060 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8061 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8062 .code
8063 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8064 .endd
8065 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8066 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8067
8068 .next
8069 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8070 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8071 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8072 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8073 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8074 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8075 expansion variable.
8076 .next
8077 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8078 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8079 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8080 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8081 .code
8082 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8083 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8084 .endd
8085 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8086 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8087 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8088 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8089 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8090 .next
8091 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8092 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8093 between the pattern and the domain.
8094 .endlist
8095
8096 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8097 .code
8098 domainlist funny_domains = \
8099 @ : \
8100 lib.unseen.edu : \
8101 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8102 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8103 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8104 nis;domains.byname : \
8105 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8106 .endd
8107 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8108 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8109 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8110 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8111 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8112 patterns earlier.
8113
8114
8115
8116 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8117 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8118 .cindex "list" "host list"
8119 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8120 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8121 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8122 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8123 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8124 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8125 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8126
8127
8128 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8129 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8130 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8131 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8132 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8133 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8134 not used.
8135
8136 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8137 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8138 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8139
8140
8141
8142 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8143 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8144 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8145 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8146 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8147 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8148 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8149 concerns.)
8150
8151 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8152 inspecting its IP address:
8153
8154 .ilist
8155 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8156 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8157 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8158 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8159 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8160 with the IP address of the subject host.
8161
8162 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8163 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8164 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8165 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8166 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8167
8168 .next
8169 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8170 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8171 domain name, as just described.
8172
8173 .next
8174 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8175 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8176 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8177 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8178 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8179 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8180 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8181 that can never match a client host.
8182
8183 .next
8184 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8185 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8186 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8187 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8188 .code
8189 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8190 accept hosts = @[]
8191 .endd
8192 .next
8193 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8194 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8195 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8196 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8197 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8198 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8199 significant end of the address.
8200
8201 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8202 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8203 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8204 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8205 .code
8206 192.168.23.236/31
8207 .endd
8208 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8209 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8210 matches.
8211
8212 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8213 .code
8214 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8215 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8216 .endd
8217 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8218 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8219 For example:
8220 .code
8221 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8222 .endd
8223 could make use of a file containing
8224 .code
8225 172.16.0.0/12
8226 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8227 .endd
8228 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8229 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8230 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8231 .code
8232 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8233 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8234 .endd
8235 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8236 list.
8237 .endlist
8238
8239
8240
8241 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8242 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8243 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8244 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8245 address, the pattern takes this form:
8246 .display
8247 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8248 .endd
8249 For example:
8250 .code
8251 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8252 .endd
8253 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8254 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8255 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8256 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8257 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8258 returned by the lookup is not used.
8259
8260 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8261 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8262 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8263 patterns of this form:
8264 .display
8265 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8266 .endd
8267 For example:
8268 .code
8269 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8270 .endd
8271 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8272 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8273 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8274 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8275 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8276
8277 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8278 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8279 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8280 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8281 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8282 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8283 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8284 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8285 addresses are always used.
8286
8287 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8288 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8289 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8290 configurations.
8291
8292 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8293 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8294 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8295 case the IP address is used on its own.
8296
8297
8298
8299 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8300 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8301 .cindex "unknown host name"
8302 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8303 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8304 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8305 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8306 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8307 above.)
8308
8309 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8310 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8311 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8312 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8313 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8314 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8315 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8316
8317 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8318 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8319
8320 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8321 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8322 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8323 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8324 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8325 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8326 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8327 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8328 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8329
8330 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8331 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8332
8333 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8334 .cindex "alias for host"
8335 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8336 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8337
8338 .ilist
8339 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8340 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8341 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8342 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8343 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8344 expression.
8345 .next
8346 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8347 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8348 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8349 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8350 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8351 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8352 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8353 example,
8354 .code
8355 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8356 .endd
8357 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8358 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8359 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8360 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8361 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8362 .code
8363 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8364 .endd
8365 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8366 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8367 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8368 required.
8369 .endlist
8370
8371
8372
8373
8374 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8375 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8376 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8377 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8378 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8379 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8380
8381 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8382 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8383
8384 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8385 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8386 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8387 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8388 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8389 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8390 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8391 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8392 not recognized in an indirected file).
8393
8394 .ilist
8395 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8396 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8397 .code
8398 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8399 .endd
8400 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8401 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8402
8403 .next
8404 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8405 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8406 example:
8407 .code
8408 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8409 192.168.4.5
8410 .endd
8411 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8412 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8413 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8414 .endlist
8415
8416 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8417 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8418 list.
8419
8420 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8421 "SECTmixwilhos"
8422 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8423
8424 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8425 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8426 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8427
8428 .ilist
8429 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8430 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8431 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8432 .code
8433 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8434 .endd
8435 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8436 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8437 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8438 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8439 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8440 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8441 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8442
8443 .next
8444 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8445 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8446 .code
8447 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8448 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8449 .endd
8450 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8451 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8452 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8453 this section.
8454 .endlist
8455
8456
8457 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8458 "SECTtemdnserr"
8459 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8460 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8461 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8462 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8463 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8464 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8465 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8466 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8467 host lists such as whitelists.
8468
8469
8470
8471 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8472 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8473 .cindex "unknown host name"
8474 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8475 If a pattern is of the form
8476 .display
8477 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8478 .endd
8479 for example
8480 .code
8481 dbm;/host/accept/list
8482 .endd
8483 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8484 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8485 is not used.
8486
8487 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8488 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8489 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8490 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8491 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8492 lookup, both using the same file.
8493
8494
8495
8496 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8497 If a pattern is of the form
8498 .display
8499 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8500 .endd
8501 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8502 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8503 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8504 .code
8505 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8506 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8507 .endd
8508 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8509 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8510 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8511 operator.
8512
8513 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8514 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8515 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8516
8517 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8518 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8519 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8520 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8521 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8522 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8523
8524
8525
8526
8527
8528 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8529 .cindex "list" "address list"
8530 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8531 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8532 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8533 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8534 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8535 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8536 using this option setting:
8537 .code
8538 senders = :
8539 .endd
8540 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8541 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8542 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8543 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8544
8545 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8546 example:
8547 .code
8548 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8549 .endd
8550 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8551 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8552 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8553 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8554 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8555 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8556 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8557 .code
8558 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8559 *@+hostile_domains:\
8560 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8561 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8562 .endd
8563 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8564 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8565 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8566 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8567 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8568
8569 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8570 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8571 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8572 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8573 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8574 .code
8575 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8576 .endd
8577
8578 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8579 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8580 senders:
8581
8582 .ilist
8583 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8584 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8585 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8586 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8587 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8588 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8589 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8590 .code
8591 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8592 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8593 .endd
8594 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8595 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8596
8597 .next
8598 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8599 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8600 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8601 example:
8602 .code
8603 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8604 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8605 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8606 .endd
8607 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8608 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8609 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8610 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8611
8612 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8613 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8614 panic log.
8615 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8616 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8617 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8618 default. For example, with this lookup:
8619 .code
8620 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8621 .endd
8622 the file could contains lines like this:
8623 .code
8624 user1@domain1.example
8625 *@domain2.example
8626 .endd
8627 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8628 that are tried is:
8629 .code
8630 nimrod@jaeger.example
8631 *@jaeger.example
8632 *
8633 .endd
8634 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8635 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8636
8637 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8638 .code
8639 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8640 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8641 .endd
8642 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8643 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8644 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8645 .endlist
8646
8647
8648 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8649 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8650 always fails.
8651
8652
8653 .ilist
8654 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8655 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8656 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8657 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8658 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8659 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8660 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8661 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8662 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8663
8664 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8665 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8666 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8667 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8668 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8669 with
8670 .code
8671 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8672 .endd
8673 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8674 .code
8675 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8676 .endd
8677 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8678
8679 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8680 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8681 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8682 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8683 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8684 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8685 .code
8686 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8687 spammer3 : spammer4
8688 .endd
8689 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8690 doubling.
8691
8692 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8693 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8694 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8695 might have entries like
8696 .code
8697 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8698 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8699 *: ^\d{8}$
8700 .endd
8701 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8702 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8703 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8704 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8705
8706 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8707 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8708 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8709
8710 .next
8711 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8712 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8713 can only return a single list of local parts.
8714 .endlist
8715
8716 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8717 in these two examples:
8718 .code
8719 senders = +my_list
8720 senders = *@+my_list
8721 .endd
8722 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8723 example it is a named domain list.
8724
8725
8726
8727
8728 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8729 .cindex "case of local parts"
8730 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8731 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8732 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8733 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8734 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8735 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8736 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8737 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8738 default.
8739
8740 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8741 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8742 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8743 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8744 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8745 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8746 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8747 case-independent.
8748
8749 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8750 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8751 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8752 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8753 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8754 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8755 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8756 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8757
8758
8759
8760 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8761 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8762 .cindex "local part" "list"
8763 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8764 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8765 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8766 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8767 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8768 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8769 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8770 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8771
8772 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8773 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8774 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8775 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8776 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8777 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8778 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8779 types.
8780 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8781
8782
8783
8784
8785 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8786 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8787
8788 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8789 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8790 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8791 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8792
8793 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8794 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8795 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8796 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8797 escape character, as described in the following section.
8798
8799 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8800 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8801 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8802 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8803 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8804 reasons.
8805
8806
8807
8808 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8809 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8810 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8811 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8812 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8813 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8814 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8815 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8816
8817 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8818 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8819 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8820 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8821 .code
8822 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8823 .endd
8824 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8825 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8826 string.
8827
8828
8829
8830 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8831 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8832 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8833 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8834 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8835 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8836 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8837 encoding.
8838
8839 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8840 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8841 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8842
8843
8844 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8845 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8846 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8847 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8848 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8849 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8850 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8851 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8852 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8853 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8854 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8855 and &%nhash%&.
8856
8857 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8858 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8859 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8860
8861 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8862 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8863 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8864 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8865 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8866 .code
8867 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8868 .endd
8869 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8870 Exim message identifier. For example:
8871 .code
8872 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8873 .endd
8874 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8875 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8876
8877
8878 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8879 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8880 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8881 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8882 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8883 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8884 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8885 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8886 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8887 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8888 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8889 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8890 being expanded.
8891
8892
8893
8894
8895 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8896 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8897 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8898 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8899 white space is significant.
8900
8901 .vlist
8902 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8903 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8904 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8905 .code
8906 $local_part
8907 ${domain}
8908 .endd
8909 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8910 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8911 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8912 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8913 given, the expansion fails.
8914
8915 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8916 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8917 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8918 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8919 .code
8920 ${lc:$local_part}
8921 .endd
8922 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8923 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8924 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8925 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8926 string easier to understand.
8927
8928 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8929 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8930 expansion item below.
8931
8932
8933 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8934 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8935 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8936 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8937 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8938 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8939 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8940 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8941 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8942 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8943 the result of the expansion.
8944 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8945 the expansion result is an empty string.
8946 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8947
8948
8949 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8950 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8951 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8952 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8953 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8954 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8955 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
8956 the certificate. Supported fields are:
8957 .display
8958 &`version `&
8959 &`serial_number `&
8960 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8961 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8962 &`notbefore `& time
8963 &`notafter `& time
8964 &`sig_algorithm `&
8965 &`signature `&
8966 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
8967 &`ocsp_uri `& list
8968 &`crl_uri `& list
8969 .endd
8970 If the field is found,
8971 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8972 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8973 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8974 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8975
8976 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8977 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8978 extracted is used.
8979
8980 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8981
8982 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8983 output a Distinguished Name string which is
8984 not quite
8985 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8986 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
8987 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8988 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
8989 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
8990 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
8991 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8992 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
8993
8994 The field selectors marked as "time" above
8995 take an optional modifier of "int"
8996 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
8997 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
8998 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
8999
9000 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9001 newline-separated by default,
9002 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9003 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9004 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9005
9006 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9007 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9008 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9009 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9010 if so the element tags are omitted.
9011
9012 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9013
9014 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9015 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9016 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9017 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9018 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9019 .code
9020 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9021 .endd
9022 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9023 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9024 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9025
9026 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9027 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9028 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9029 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9030 must have the following type:
9031 .code
9032 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9033 .endd
9034 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9035 function should return one of the following values:
9036
9037 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9038 into the expanded string that is being built.
9039
9040 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9041 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9042
9043 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9044 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9045
9046 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9047
9048 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9049 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9050 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9051
9052
9053 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9054 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9055 .cindex "environment" "value from"
9056 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9057 removed.
9058 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9059 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9060 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9061
9062 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9063 appear, for example:
9064 .code
9065 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9066 .endd
9067 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9068 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9069
9070 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9071 search failure.
9072 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9073 search success.
9074
9075
9076 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9077 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9078 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9079 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9080 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9081 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9082 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9083 form:
9084 .display
9085 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9086 .endd
9087 .vindex "&$value$&"
9088 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9089 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9090 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9091 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9092 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9093 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9094 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9095 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9096 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9097
9098 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9099 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9100 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9101 yield &"2001"&:
9102 .code
9103 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9104 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9105 .endd
9106 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9107 appear, for example:
9108 .code
9109 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9110 .endd
9111 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9112 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9113
9114
9115 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9116 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9117 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9118 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9119 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9120 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9121 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9122 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9123 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9124 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9125 <&'string3'&> as before.
9126
9127 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9128 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9129 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9130 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9131 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9132 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9133 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9134 provided. For example:
9135 .code
9136 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9137 .endd
9138 yields &"42"&, and
9139 .code
9140 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9141 .endd
9142 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9143 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9144
9145
9146 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9147 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9148 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9149 .vindex "&$item$&"
9150 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9151 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9152 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9153 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9154 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9155 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9156 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9157 .code
9158 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9159 .endd
9160 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9161 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9162
9163
9164 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9165 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9166 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9167 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9168 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9169 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9170
9171 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9172 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9173 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9174 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9175 .code
9176 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9177 .endd
9178 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9179 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9180 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9181 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9182 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9183 .code
9184 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9185 .endd
9186 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9187 letters appear. For example:
9188 .display
9189 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9190 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9191 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9192 .endd
9193
9194 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9195 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9196 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9197 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9198 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9199 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9200 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9201 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9202 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9203 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9204 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9205 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9206 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9207 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9208 .code
9209 $header_reply-to:
9210 .endd
9211 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9212 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9213 lines) may be present.
9214
9215 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9216 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9217
9218 .ilist
9219 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9220 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9221 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9222
9223 .next
9224 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9225 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9226 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9227 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9228 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9229 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9230 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9231 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9232
9233 .next
9234 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9235 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9236 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9237 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9238 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9239 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9240 .endlist ilist
9241
9242 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9243 command of the following form:
9244 .code
9245 headers charset "UTF-8"
9246 .endd
9247 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9248 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9249 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9250 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9251 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9252 ISO-8859-1.
9253
9254 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9255 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9256 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9257 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9258
9259 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9260 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9261 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9262 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9263 router or transport are not accessible.
9264
9265 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9266 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9267 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9268 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9269 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9270 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9271
9272 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9273 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9274 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9275 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9276 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9277 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9278 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9279 header.)
9280
9281 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9282 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9283 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9284 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9285 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9286 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9287 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9288 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9289
9290
9291 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9292 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9293 .cindex &%hmac%&
9294 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9295 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9296 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9297 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9298 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9299 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9300 present. For example:
9301 .code
9302 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9303 .endd
9304 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9305 produces:
9306 .code
9307 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9308 .endd
9309 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9310 an Exim configuration:
9311 .code
9312 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9313 .endd
9314 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9315 .code
9316 headers_add = \
9317 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9318 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9319 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9320 .endd
9321 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9322 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9323 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9324 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9325 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9326 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9327
9328
9329 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9330 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9331 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9332 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9333 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9334 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9335 .code
9336 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9337 .endd
9338 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9339 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9340 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9341 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9342 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9343
9344 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9345 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9346 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9347 .code
9348 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9349 .endd
9350 you can use
9351 .code
9352 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9353 .endd
9354
9355 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9356 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9357 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9358 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9359 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9360 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9361 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9362 some of the braces:
9363 .code
9364 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9365 .endd
9366 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9367 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9368 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9369
9370
9371 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9372 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9373 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9374 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9375 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9376 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9377 apart from an optional leading minus,
9378 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9379
9380 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9381 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9382
9383 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9384 If the number is negative, the fields are
9385 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9386 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9387 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9388
9389 If the modulus of the
9390 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9391 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9392
9393 For example:
9394 .code
9395 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9396 .endd
9397 yields &"42"&, and
9398 .code
9399 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9400 .endd
9401 yields &"result: 42"&.
9402
9403 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9404 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9405 extracted is used.
9406 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9407
9408
9409 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9410 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9411 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9412 described in the next item.
9413
9414 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9415 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9416 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9417 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9418 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9419 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9420 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9421 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9422 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9423
9424 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9425 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9426 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9427 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9428 out by the system administrator.
9429
9430 .vindex "&$value$&"
9431 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9432 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9433 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9434 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9435 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9436 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9437 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9438 original lookup fails.
9439
9440 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9441 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9442 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9443 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9444 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9445 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9446 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9447 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9448
9449 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9450 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9451 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9452 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9453
9454 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9455 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9456 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9457 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9458
9459 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9460 .code
9461 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9462 .endd
9463 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9464 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9465 .code
9466 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9467 {$value}fail}
9468 .endd
9469
9470
9471 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9472 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9473 .vindex "&$item$&"
9474 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9475 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9476 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9477 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9478 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9479 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9480 .code
9481 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9482 .endd
9483 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9484 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9485 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9486
9487 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9488 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9489 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9490 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9491 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9492 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9493 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9494 .code
9495 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9496 .endd
9497 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9498 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9499 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9500 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9501 example,
9502 .code
9503 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9504 .endd
9505 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9506
9507
9508
9509 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9510 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9511 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9512 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9513 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9514 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9515 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9516 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9517
9518 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9519 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9520 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9521 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9522 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9523 not its contents.
9524
9525 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9526 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9527 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9528
9529 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9530 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9531
9532
9533 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9534 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9535 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9536 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9537 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9538 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9539 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9540 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9541
9542 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9543 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9544 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9545 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9546 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9547 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9548 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9549 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9550 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9551 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9552
9553 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9554 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9555 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9556 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9557
9558 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9559 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9560 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9561 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9562 is the expansion of the third argument.
9563
9564 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9565 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9566 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9567
9568 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9569 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9570 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9571 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9572 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9573 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9574 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9575 newlines are left in the string.
9576 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9577 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9578 the string expansion fails.
9579
9580 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9581 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9582
9583
9584
9585 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9586 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9587 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9588 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9589 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9590 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9591 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9592 examples:
9593 .code
9594 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9595 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9596 .endd
9597 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9598 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9599 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9600 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9601 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9602 example:
9603 .code
9604 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9605 .endd
9606 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9607 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9608 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9609 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9610 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9611 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9612 .code
9613 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9614 .endd
9615 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9616 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9617 turns them into spaces:
9618 .code
9619 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9620 .endd
9621 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9622 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9623 addition, the following errors can occur:
9624
9625 .ilist
9626 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9627 .next
9628 Failure to connect the socket;
9629 .next
9630 Failure to write the request string;
9631 .next
9632 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9633 .endlist
9634
9635 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9636 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9637 errors occurs. For example:
9638 .code
9639 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9640 {socket failure}}
9641 .endd
9642 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9643 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9644 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9645 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9646 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9647
9648 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9649 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9650
9651
9652 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9653 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9654 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9655 .vindex "&$value$&"
9656 .vindex "&$item$&"
9657 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9658 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9659 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9660 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9661 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9662 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9663 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9664 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9665 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9666 .code
9667 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9668 .endd
9669 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9670 can be found:
9671 .code
9672 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9673 .endd
9674 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9675 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9676 expansion items.
9677
9678 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9679 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9680 expansion item above.
9681
9682 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9683 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9684 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9685 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9686 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9687 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9688 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9689 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9690 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9691
9692 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9693 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9694 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9695 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9696 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9697 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9698 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9699 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9700 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9701 character.
9702
9703 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9704 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9705 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9706 .vindex "&$value$&"
9707 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9708 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9709 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9710 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9711 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9712 &$value$&.
9713
9714 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9715 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9716 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9717 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9718
9719 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9720 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9721 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9722 troubleshoot:
9723 .code
9724 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9725 log_message = Output of id: $value
9726 .endd
9727 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9728 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9729 .code
9730 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9731 .endd
9732
9733 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9734 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9735 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9736 .code
9737 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9738 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9739 ...
9740 endif
9741 .endd
9742 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9743 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9744 commands.
9745
9746 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9747 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9748 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9749 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9750
9751 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9752 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9753
9754
9755 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9756 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9757 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9758 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9759 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9760 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9761 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9762 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9763 .code
9764 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9765 .endd
9766 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9767 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9768 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9769 .code
9770 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9771 .endd
9772 yields &"defabc"&, and
9773 .code
9774 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9775 .endd
9776 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9777 the regular expression from string expansion.
9778
9779
9780
9781 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9782 .cindex sorting "a list"
9783 .cindex list sorting
9784 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9785 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9786 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9787 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9788 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9789 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9790 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9791 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9792 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9793 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9794 to give values for comparison.
9795
9796 The item result is a sorted list,
9797 with the original list separator,
9798 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9799
9800 Examples:
9801 .code
9802 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9803 .endd
9804 sorts a list of numbers, and
9805 .code
9806 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9807 .endd
9808 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9809
9810
9811 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9812 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9813 .cindex "substring extraction"
9814 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9815 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9816 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9817 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9818 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9819 .code
9820 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9821 .endd
9822 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9823 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9824 omitted.
9825
9826 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9827 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9828 length required. For example
9829 .code
9830 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9831 .endd
9832 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9833 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9834 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9835 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9836
9837 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9838 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9839 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9840 .code
9841 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9842 .endd
9843 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9844 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9845 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9846 .code
9847 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9848 .endd
9849 yields an empty string, but
9850 .code
9851 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9852 .endd
9853 yields &"1"&.
9854
9855 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9856 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9857 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9858 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9859 .code
9860 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9861 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9862 .endd
9863 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9864
9865
9866
9867 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9868 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9869 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9870 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9871 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9872 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9873 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9874 replacement list. For example
9875 .code
9876 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9877 .endd
9878 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9879 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9880 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9881 place.
9882 .endlist
9883
9884
9885
9886 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9887 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9888 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9889 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9890 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9891 following operations can be performed:
9892
9893 .vlist
9894 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9895 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9896 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9897 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9898 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9899 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9900
9901
9902 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9903 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9904 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9905 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9906 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9907 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9908 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9909 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9910 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9911
9912 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9913 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9914 character. For example:
9915 .code
9916 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9917 .endd
9918 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9919 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9920 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9921 processing lists.
9922
9923 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9924 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9925 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9926 email address separator. For the example header line:
9927 .code
9928 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9929 .endd
9930 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9931 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9932 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9933 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9934 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9935 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9936 quoted.
9937 .code
9938 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9939 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9940 user@example.com
9941 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9942 Last:user@example.com
9943 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9944 user@example.com
9945 .endd
9946
9947 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9948 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9949 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9950 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9951 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9952 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9953 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9954 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9955 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9956
9957 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9958 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9959 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9960 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9961 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9962 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9963 string.
9964
9965
9966 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9967 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9968 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9969 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9970 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9971
9972
9973 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9974 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9975 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9976 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9977 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9978 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9979 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9980
9981
9982 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9983 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9984 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9985 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9986 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9987 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9988 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9989 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9990 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9991 C programming language):
9992 .table2 70pt 300pt
9993 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9994 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9995 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9996 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9997 .irow "" "and (&&)"
9998 .irow "" "xor (^)"
9999 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10000 .endtable
10001 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10002 space is permitted before or after operators.
10003
10004 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10005 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10006 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10007 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10008 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10009
10010 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10011 or 1024*1024*1024,
10012 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10013 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10014
10015 .display
10016 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10017 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10018 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10019 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10020 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10021 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10022 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10023 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10024 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10025 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10026 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10027 .endd
10028
10029 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10030 .code
10031 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10032 condition = \
10033 ${if and { \
10034 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10035 { \
10036 < \
10037 {$recipients_count} \
10038 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10039 } \
10040 }{yes}{no}}
10041 .endd
10042 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10043 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10044
10045
10046 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10047 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10048 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10049 example,
10050 .code
10051 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10052 .endd
10053 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10054 and then re-expands what it has found.
10055
10056
10057 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10058 .cindex "Unicode"
10059 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10060 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10061 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10062 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10063 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10064 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10065 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10066 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10067 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10068
10069 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10070 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10071 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10072 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10073 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10074 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10075 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10076
10077
10078 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10079 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10080 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10081 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10082 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10083 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10084 .code
10085 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10086 .endd
10087 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10088 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10089
10090
10091
10092 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10093 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10094 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10095 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10096 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10097 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10098
10099
10100
10101 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10102 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10103 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10104 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10105 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10106 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10107 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10108
10109
10110 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10111 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10112 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10113 .cindex "lower casing"
10114 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10115 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10116 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10117 .code
10118 ${lc:$local_part}
10119 .endd
10120
10121 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10122 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10123 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10124 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10125 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10126 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10127 .code
10128 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10129 .endd
10130 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10131 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10132 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10133
10134
10135 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10136 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10137 .cindex "list" "item count"
10138 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10139 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10140 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10141
10142
10143 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10144 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10145 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10146 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10147 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10148 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10149 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10150 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10151 matching list is returned.
10152
10153
10154 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10155 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10156 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10157 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10158 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10159 empty.
10160
10161
10162 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10163 .cindex "masked IP address"
10164 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10165 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10166 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10167 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10168 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10169 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10170 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10171 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10172 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10173 .code
10174 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10175 .endd
10176 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10177 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10178 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10179 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10180 .code
10181 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10182 .endd
10183 returns the string
10184 .code
10185 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10186 .endd
10187 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10188
10189
10190 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10191 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10192 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10193 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10194 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10195 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10196 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10197
10198
10199 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10200 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10201 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10202 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10203 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10204 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10205 .code
10206 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10207 .endd
10208 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10209
10210
10211 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10212 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10213 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10214 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10215 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10216 is an empty string or
10217 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10218 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10219 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10220 respectively For example,
10221 .code
10222 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10223 .endd
10224 becomes
10225 .code
10226 "ab\"*\"cd"
10227 .endd
10228 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10229 variable or a message header.
10230
10231 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10232 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10233 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10234 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10235 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10236 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10237 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10238
10239
10240 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10241 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10242 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10243 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10244 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10245 .code
10246 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10247 .endd
10248 returns
10249 .code
10250 two%20%5C2A%20two
10251 .endd
10252 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10253 yields an unchanged string.
10254
10255
10256 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10257 .cindex "random number"
10258 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10259 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10260 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10261 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10262 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10263 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10264 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10265 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10266 random().
10267
10268
10269 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10270 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10271 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10272 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10273 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10274 for DNS. For example,
10275 .code
10276 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10277 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10278 .endd
10279 returns
10280 .code
10281 4.2.0.192
10282 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10283 .endd
10284
10285
10286 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10287 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10288 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10289 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10290 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10291 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10292 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10293 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10294 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10295 characters
10296 .code
10297 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10298 .endd
10299 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10300 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10301 characters.
10302
10303
10304 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10305 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10306 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10307 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10308 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10309 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10310 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10311 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10312
10313 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10314 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10315 to use this operator as well.
10316
10317
10318
10319 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10320 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10321 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10322 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10323 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10324 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10325 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10326
10327
10328 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10329 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10330 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10331 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10332 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10333 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10334 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10335
10336
10337 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10338 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10339 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10340 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10341 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10342 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10343 certificate,
10344 and returns
10345 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10346 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10347
10348
10349 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10350 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10351 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10352 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10353 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10354 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10355 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10356 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10357 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10358 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10359 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10360 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10361 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10362
10363 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10364 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10365 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10366
10367 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10368 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10369 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10370 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10371 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10372
10373
10374
10375 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10376 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10377 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10378 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10379 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10380 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10381
10382
10383 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10384 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10385 .cindex "substring extraction"
10386 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10387 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10388 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10389 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10390 .code
10391 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10392 .endd
10393 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10394 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10395
10396 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10397 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10398 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10399 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10400 seconds.
10401
10402 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10403 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10404 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10405 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10406 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10407 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10408 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10409
10410 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10411 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10412 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10413 .cindex "upper casing"
10414 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10415 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10416 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10417
10418 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10419 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10420 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10421 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10422 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10423 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10424 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10425 .endlist
10426
10427
10428
10429
10430
10431
10432 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10433 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10434 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10435 while expanding strings:
10436
10437 .vlist
10438 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10439 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10440 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10441 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10442 condition.
10443
10444 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10445 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10446 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10447 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10448 are:
10449 .display
10450 &`= `& equal
10451 &`== `& equal
10452 &`> `& greater
10453 &`>= `& greater or equal
10454 &`< `& less
10455 &`<= `& less or equal
10456 .endd
10457 For example:
10458 .code
10459 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10460 .endd
10461 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10462 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10463 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10464 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10465 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10466 zero.
10467
10468 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10469 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10470 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10471
10472
10473 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10474 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10475 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10476 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10477 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10478 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10479 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10480 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10481 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10482 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10483 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10484 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10485 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10486 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10487
10488 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10489 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10490 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10491 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10492 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10493 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10494 false if zero.
10495 An empty string is treated as false.
10496 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10497 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10498 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10499
10500 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10501 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10502 For example:
10503 .code
10504 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10505 .endd
10506
10507
10508 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10509 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10510 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10511 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10512 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10513 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10514 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10515 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10516
10517 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10518
10519 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10520 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10521 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10522 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10523 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10524 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10525 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10526 included in the binary.
10527
10528 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10529 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10530 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10531 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10532 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10533 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10534 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10535 string in LDAP form is:
10536 .code
10537 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10538 .endd
10539 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10540 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10541 .code
10542 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10543 .endd
10544 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10545 supported:
10546
10547 .ilist
10548 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10549 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10550 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10551 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10552 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10553 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10554 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10555 comparison fails.
10556
10557 .next
10558 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10559 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10560 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10561 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10562 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10563 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10564
10565 .next
10566 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10567 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10568 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10569 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10570 whatever its length.
10571
10572 .next
10573 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10574 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10575 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10576 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10577 .endlist
10578 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10579 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10580 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10581 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10582 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10583 support &[crypt16()]&.
10584
10585 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10586 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10587 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10588 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10589 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10590
10591 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10592 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10593 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10594
10595 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10596 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10597 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10598 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10599 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10600
10601 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10602 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10603 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10604 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10605 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10606 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10607 .code
10608 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10609 .endd
10610 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10611 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10612
10613 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10614 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10615 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10616 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10617 exists in the message. For example,
10618 .code
10619 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10620 .endd
10621 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10622 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10623
10624 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10625 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10626 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10627 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10628 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10629 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10630 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10631 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10632 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10633
10634 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10635 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10636 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10637 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10638 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10639 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10640 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10641 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10642
10643 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10644 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10645 .cindex "first delivery"
10646 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10647 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10648 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10649 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10650
10651
10652 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10653 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10654 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10655 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10656 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10657 .vindex "&$item$&"
10658 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10659 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10660 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10661 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10662 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10663 .ilist
10664 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10665 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10666 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10667 .next
10668 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10669 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10670 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10671 .endlist
10672 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10673 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10674 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10675 list separator is changed to a comma:
10676 .code
10677 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10678 .endd
10679 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10680 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10681
10682 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10683
10684
10685 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10686 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10687 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10688 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10689 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10690 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10691 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10692 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10693 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10694 case-independent.
10695
10696 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10697 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10698 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10699 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10700 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10701 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10702 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10703 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10704 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10705 case-independent.
10706
10707 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10708 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10709 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10710 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10711 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10712 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10713 is true.
10714
10715 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10716 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10717 .code
10718 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10719 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10720 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10721 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10722 .endd
10723
10724 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10725 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10726 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10727 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10728 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10729 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10730 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10731 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10732 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10733 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10734 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10735
10736 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10737 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10738 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10739 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10740 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10741
10742 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10743 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10744 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10745 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10746 .code
10747 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10748 .endd
10749 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10750
10751 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10752 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10753 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10754 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10755 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10756 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10757 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10758 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10759 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10760 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10761 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10762 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10763 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10764 this can be used.
10765
10766
10767 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10768 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10769 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10770 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10771 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10772 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10773 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10774 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10775 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10776 case-independent.
10777
10778 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10779 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10780 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10781 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10782 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10783 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10784 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10785 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10786 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10787 case-independent.
10788
10789
10790 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10791 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10792 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10793 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10794 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10795 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10796 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10797 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10798 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10799 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10800 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10801 For example,
10802 .code
10803 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10804 .endd
10805 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10806 backslashes is also required.
10807
10808 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10809 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10810 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10811 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10812 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10813 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10814
10815 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10816 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10817 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10818 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10819 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10820 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10821 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10822 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10823
10824 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10825 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10826 See &*match_local_part*&.
10827
10828 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10829 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10830 See &*match_local_part*&.
10831
10832 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10833 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10834 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10835 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10836 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10837 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10838 .code
10839 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10840 .endd
10841 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10842
10843 .ilist
10844 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10845 .next
10846 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10847 .next
10848 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10849 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10850 in a single test such as
10851 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10852 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10853 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10854 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10855 .code
10856 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10857 .endd
10858 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10859 .next
10860 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10861 .next
10862 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10863 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10864 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10865 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10866 masks. For example:
10867 .code
10868 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10869 .endd
10870 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10871 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10872 address mask, for example:
10873 .code
10874 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10875 .endd
10876 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10877 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10878 .code
10879 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10880 .endd
10881 .endlist ilist
10882
10883 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10884 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10885
10886 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10887
10888 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10889 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10890 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10891 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10892 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10893 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10894 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10895 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10896 example is:
10897 .code
10898 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10899 .endd
10900 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10901 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10902 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10903 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10904 .code
10905 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10906 .endd
10907 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10908 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10909 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10910 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10911 caselessly.
10912
10913 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10914 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10915
10916 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10917 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10918 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10919 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10920
10921 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10922 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10923 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10924 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10925 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10926 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10927 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10928 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10929 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10930 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10931 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10932 .code
10933 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10934 .endd
10935 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10936 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10937
10938 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10939 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10940 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10941 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10942 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10943 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10944 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10945
10946 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10947 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10948 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10949 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10950 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10951 .code
10952 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10953 .endd
10954 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10955 .code
10956 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10957 .endd
10958 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10959 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10960 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10961 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10962 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10963 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10964 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10965 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10966
10967
10968 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10969 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10970 .cindex "Cyrus"
10971 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10972 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10973 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10974 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10975 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10976 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10977
10978 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10979 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10980 building Exim. For example:
10981 .code
10982 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10983 .endd
10984 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10985 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10986 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10987 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10988
10989 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10990 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10991 configuration, you might have this:
10992 .code
10993 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10994 .endd
10995 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10996 .code
10997 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10998 .endd
10999 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11000 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11001 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11002 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11003 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11004 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11005
11006
11007 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11008 .cindex "Radius"
11009 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11010 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11011 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11012 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11013 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11014 support.
11015
11016 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11017 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11018 this library, you need to set
11019 .code
11020 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11021 .endd
11022 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11023 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11024 .code
11025 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11026 .endd
11027 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11028 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11029 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11030
11031 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11032 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11033 the authentication is successful. For example:
11034 .code
11035 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11036 .endd
11037
11038
11039 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11040 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11041 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11042 .cindex "Cyrus"
11043 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11044 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11045 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11046 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11047 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11048 by a process that is not running as root.
11049
11050 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11051 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11052 building Exim. For example:
11053 .code
11054 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11055 .endd
11056 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11057 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11058 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11059
11060 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11061 two are mandatory. For example:
11062 .code
11063 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11064 .endd
11065 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11066 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11067 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11068 .endlist vlist
11069
11070
11071
11072 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11073 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11074 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11075 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11076 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11077 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11078 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11079
11080
11081 .vlist
11082 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11083 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11084 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11085 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11086 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11087 For example,
11088 .code
11089 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11090 .endd
11091 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11092 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11093 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11094
11095 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11096 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11097 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11098 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11099 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11100 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11101 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11102 parsed but not evaluated.
11103 .endlist
11104 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11105
11106
11107
11108
11109 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11110 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11111 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11112 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11113 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11114
11115 .vlist
11116 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11117 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11118 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11119 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11120 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11121 In the expansion condition case
11122 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11123 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11124 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11125 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11126 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11127 matching condition.
11128
11129 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11130 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11131 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11132 any unused variables being made empty.
11133
11134 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11135 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11136 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11137 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11138 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11139 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11140 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11141 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11142 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11143 during subsequent delivery.
11144
11145 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11146 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11147 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11148 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11149 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11150 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11151 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11152 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11153 delivery.
11154
11155 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11156 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11157 this variable has the number of arguments.
11158
11159 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11160 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11161 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11162 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11163 be preserved by coding like this:
11164 .code
11165 warn !verify = sender
11166 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11167 .endd
11168 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11169 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11170 failure.
11171
11172 .vitem &$address_data$&
11173 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11174 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11175 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11176 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11177 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11178 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11179 user filter files.
11180
11181 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11182 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11183 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11184 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11185 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11186 from the child's routing.
11187
11188 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11189 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11190 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11191 address.
11192
11193 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11194 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11195 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11196
11197 .vitem &$address_file$&
11198 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11199 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11200 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11201 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11202 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11203 .code
11204 /home/r2d2/savemail
11205 .endd
11206 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11207 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11208 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11209 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11210 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11211 to the relevant file.
11212
11213 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11214 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11215 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11216 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11217
11218 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11219 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11220 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11221 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11222
11223 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11224 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11225 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11226 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11227 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11228 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11229 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11230 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11231 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11232 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11233 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11234 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11235 command line option.
11236
11237 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11238 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11239 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11240 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11241 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11242 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11243 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11244 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11245 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11246 the ACL's as well.
11247
11248
11249 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11250 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11251 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11252 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11253 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11254 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11255 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11256 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11257 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11258 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11259 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11260
11261 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11262 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11263 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11264 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11265 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11266
11267
11268 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11269 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11270 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11271 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11272 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11273 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11274 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11275 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11276 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11277 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11278 an undefined mechanism.
11279
11280 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11281 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11282 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11283 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11284 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11285 the ACL malware condition.
11286
11287 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11288 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11289 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11290 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11291 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11292 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11293
11294 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11295 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11296 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11297 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11298 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11299 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11300 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11301
11302 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11303 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11304 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11305 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11306 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11307
11308 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11309 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11310 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11311 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11312 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11313
11314 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11315 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11316 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11317 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11318 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11319 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11320 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11321
11322 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11323 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11324 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11325 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11326 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11327 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11328 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11329
11330 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11331 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11332 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11333 address that was connected to.
11334
11335 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11336 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11337 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11338 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11339 compilations of the same version of the program.
11340
11341 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11342 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11343 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11344 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11345 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11346 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11347
11348 .vitem &$config_file$&
11349 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11350 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11351
11352 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11353 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11354 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11355 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11356 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11357
11358 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11359 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11360 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11361 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11362 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11363
11364 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11365 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11366 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11367 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11368 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11369 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11370 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11371 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11372 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11373 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11374 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11375 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11376 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11377 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11378 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11379 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11380 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11381 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11382 &$dkim_key_notes$&
11383 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11384 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11385
11386 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11387 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11388 When a message has been received this variable contains
11389 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11390 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11391
11392 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11393 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11394 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11395 &$dnslist_value$&
11396 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11397 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11398 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11399 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11400 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11401 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11402 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11403 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11404 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11405
11406 .vitem &$domain$&
11407 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11408 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11409 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11410 case for &$domain$&.
11411
11412 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11413 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11414 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11415 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11416
11417 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11418 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11419 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11420 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11421 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11422 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11423
11424 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11425 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11426 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11427
11428 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11429
11430 .ilist
11431 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11432 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11433 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11434 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11435 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11436 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11437 the &(smtp)& transport.
11438
11439 .next
11440 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11441 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11442 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11443 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11444
11445 .next
11446 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11447 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11448 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11449 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11450 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11451 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11452
11453 .next
11454 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11455 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11456 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11457 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11458 .endlist
11459
11460
11461 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11462 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11463 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11464 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11465 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11466 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11467 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11468 used.
11469
11470 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11471 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11472 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11473 to nothing.
11474
11475 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11476 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11477 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11478
11479 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11480 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11481 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11482
11483 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11484 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11485 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11486
11487 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11488 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11489 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11490 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11491 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11492 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11493
11494 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11495 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11496 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11497 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11498 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11499
11500 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11501 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11502 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11503 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11504 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11505
11506 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11507 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11508 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11509 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11510 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11511
11512 .vitem &$home$&
11513 .vindex "&$home$&"
11514 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11515 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11516 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11517 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11518 by a setting on the transport itself.
11519
11520 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11521 of the environment variable HOME.
11522
11523 .vitem &$host$&
11524 .vindex "&$host$&"
11525 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11526 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11527 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11528 to local and remote transports.
11529
11530 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11531 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11532 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11533 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11534 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11535 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11536 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11537 is connected.
11538
11539 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11540 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11541 client is connected.
11542
11543
11544 .vitem &$host_address$&
11545 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11546 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11547 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11548 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11549
11550 .vitem &$host_data$&
11551 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11552 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11553 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11554 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11555 .code
11556 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11557 message = $host_data
11558 .endd
11559 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11560 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11561 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11562 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11563 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11564 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11565 variables is set to &"1"&.
11566
11567 .ilist
11568 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11569 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11570
11571 .next
11572 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11573 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11574 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11575 .endlist ilist
11576
11577 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11578 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11579 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11580 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11581 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11582 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11583 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11584 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11585 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11586 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11587
11588 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11589 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11590 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11591
11592 .vitem &$host_port$&
11593 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11594 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11595 for an outbound connection.
11596
11597
11598 .vitem &$inode$&
11599 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11600 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11601 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11602 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11603 a unique name for the file.
11604
11605 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11606 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11607 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11608
11609 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11610 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11611 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11612
11613 .vitem &$item$&
11614 .vindex "&$item$&"
11615 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11616 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11617 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11618 empty.
11619
11620 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11621 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11622 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11623 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11624 lookup.
11625
11626 .vitem &$load_average$&
11627 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11628 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11629 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11630 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11631
11632 .vitem &$local_part$&
11633 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11634 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11635 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11636 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11637 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11638
11639 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11640 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11641 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11642 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11643 once.
11644
11645 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11646 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11647 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11648 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11649 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11650 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11651
11652 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11653 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11654 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11655 &$address_pipe$&).
11656
11657 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11658 local part of the recipient address.
11659
11660 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11661 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11662 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11663
11664 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11665 the addresses
11666 .code
11667 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11668 abc\:xyz@test.example
11669 .endd
11670 the value of &$local_part$& is
11671 .code
11672 abc:xyz
11673 .endd
11674 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11675 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11676 have:
11677 .code
11678 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11679 .endd
11680 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11681 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11682 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11683
11684 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11685 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11686 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11687 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11688 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11689 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11690 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11691
11692 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11693 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11694 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11695 variable expands to nothing.
11696
11697 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11698 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11699 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11700 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11701 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11702
11703 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11704 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11705 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11706 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11707 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11708
11709 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11710 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11711 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11712 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11713
11714 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11715 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11716 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11717
11718 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11719 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11720 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11721 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11722 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11723 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11724 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11725 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11726
11727 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11728 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11729 This contains the expanded value of the
11730 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11731 been read.
11732
11733 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11734 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11735 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11736 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11737 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11738 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11739
11740 .vitem &$log_space$&
11741 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11742 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11743 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11744 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11745 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11746 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11747
11748
11749 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11750 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11751 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11752 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11753 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11754 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11755 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11756 and &"yes"& if it was.
11757 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
11758 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
11759 as authenticated data.
11760
11761 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11762 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11763 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11764 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11765 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11766 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11767 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11768 variable is empty.
11769
11770 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11771 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11772 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11773 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11774 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11775
11776 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11777 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11778 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11779 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11780 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11781 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11782 character(s).
11783
11784 .vitem &$message_age$&
11785 .cindex "message" "age of"
11786 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11787 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11788 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11789 delivery attempt.
11790
11791 .vitem &$message_body$&
11792 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11793 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11794 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11795 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11796 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11797 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11798 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11799 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11800 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11801
11802 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11803 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11804 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11805 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11806 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11807
11808 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11809 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11810 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11811 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11812 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11813 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11814 &$message_body$&.
11815
11816 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11817 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11818 .cindex "message body" "size"
11819 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11820 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11821 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11822 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11823 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11824
11825 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11826 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11827 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11828 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11829 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11830 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11831 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11832 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11833
11834 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11835 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11836 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11837 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11838 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11839 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11840
11841 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11842 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11843 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11844 contents of header lines is done.
11845
11846 .vitem &$message_id$&
11847 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11848
11849 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11850 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11851 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11852 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11853 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11854 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11855 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11856 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11857 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11858 from the body is not counted.
11859
11860 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11861 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11862 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11863 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11864 header and the body).
11865
11866 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11867 .code
11868 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11869 condition = \
11870 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11871 .endd
11872 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11873 message has not yet been received.
11874
11875 .vitem &$message_size$&
11876 .cindex "size" "of message"
11877 .cindex "message" "size"
11878 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11879 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11880 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11881 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11882 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11883 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11884 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11885 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11886 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11887
11888 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11889 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11890 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11891 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11892
11893 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11894 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11895 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11896 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11897
11898 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11899 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11900 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11901
11902 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11903 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11904 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11905 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11906 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11907 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11908 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11909 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11910 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11911 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11912
11913 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11914 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11915 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11916
11917 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11918 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11919 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11920 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11921 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11922 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11923 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11924 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11925 the original address.
11926
11927 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11928 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11929 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11930 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11931 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11932
11933 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11934 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11935 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11936
11937 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11938 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11939 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11940 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11941 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11942 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11943 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11944 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11945 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11946
11947 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11948 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11949 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11950 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11951 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11952 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11953 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11954 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11955 user.
11956
11957 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11958 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11959 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11960 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11961
11962 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11963 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11964 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11965 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11966
11967 .vitem &$pid$&
11968 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11969 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11970 This variable contains the current process id.
11971
11972 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11973 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11974 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11975 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11976 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11977 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11978 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11979 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11980 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11981 variable"& error if encountered.
11982
11983 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11984 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11985 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11986 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11987 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11988 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11989 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11990
11991
11992 .new
11993 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
11994 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
11995 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
11996 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
11997 .wen
11998
11999 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12000 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12001 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12002 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12003
12004 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12005 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12006 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12007 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12008
12009 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12010 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12011 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12012 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12013
12014 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12015 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12016 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12017
12018 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12019 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12020 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12021 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12022
12023 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12024 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12025 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12026 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12027 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12028
12029 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12030 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12031 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12032 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12033 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12034 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12035
12036 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12037 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12038 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12039 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12040 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12041
12042 .vitem &$received_count$&
12043 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12044 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12045 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12046 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12047 delivering.
12048
12049 .vitem &$received_for$&
12050 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12051 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12052 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12053 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12054 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12055
12056 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12057 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12058 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12059 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12060 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12061 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12062 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12063 option.
12064
12065 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12066 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12067 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12068 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12069 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12070 time.
12071 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12072
12073 .vitem &$received_port$&
12074 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12075 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12076
12077 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12078 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12079 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12080 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12081 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12082 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12083 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12084 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12085 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12086
12087 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12088 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12089 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12090 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12091 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12092 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12093
12094 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12095 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12096 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12097
12098 .vitem &$received_time$&
12099 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12100 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12101 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12102
12103 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12104 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12105 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12106 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12107 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12108 .display
12109 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12110 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12111 .endd
12112 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12113 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12114 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12115 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12116
12117 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12118 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12119 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12120 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12121
12122 .ilist
12123 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12124 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12125
12126 .next
12127 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12128
12129 .next
12130 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12131 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12132 MAIL).
12133
12134 .next
12135 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12136 .next
12137
12138 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12139 .endlist
12140
12141 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12142 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12143
12144 .vitem &$recipients$&
12145 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12146 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12147 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12148 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12149 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12150 cases:
12151
12152 .olist
12153 In a system filter file.
12154 .next
12155 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12156 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12157 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12158 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12159 .next
12160 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12161 .endlist
12162
12163
12164 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12165 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12166 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12167 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12168 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12169 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12170
12171
12172 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12173 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12174 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12175 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12176
12177 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12178 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12179 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12180 these variables contain the
12181 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12182
12183
12184 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12185 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12186 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12187 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12188 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12189 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12190 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12191
12192 .vitem &$return_path$&
12193 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12194 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12195 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12196 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12197 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12198 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12199 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12200 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12201 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12202 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12203 envelope sender.
12204
12205 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12206 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12207 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12208
12209 .vitem &$router_name$&
12210 .cindex "router" "name"
12211 .cindex "name" "of router"
12212 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12213 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12214
12215 .vitem &$runrc$&
12216 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12217 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12218 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12219 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12220 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12221 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12222 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12223 another.
12224
12225 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12226 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12227 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12228 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12229 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12230 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12231 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12232 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12233
12234 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12235 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12236 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12237 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12238 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12239 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12240
12241 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12242 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12243 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12244 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12245 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12246 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12247 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12248 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12249
12250 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12251 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12252 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12253
12254 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12255 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12256 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12257
12258 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12259 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12260 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12261 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12262 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12263 this:
12264 .display
12265 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12266 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12267 .endd
12268 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12269 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12270 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12271 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12272
12273 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12274 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12275 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12276 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12277 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12278 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12279 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12280 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12281 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12282 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12283 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12284 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12285 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12286
12287 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12288 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12289 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12290 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12291 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12292
12293 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12294 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12295 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12296 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12297 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12298 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12299
12300 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12301 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12302 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12303 this variable contains that
12304 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12305
12306 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12307 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12308 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12309 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12310 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12311 &$authenticated_id$&.
12312
12313 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12314 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12315 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12316 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12317 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12318 resolver library states that both
12319 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12320 other times, this variable is false.
12321
12322 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12323 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12324 library, by setting:
12325 .code
12326 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12327 .endd
12328
12329 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12330 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12331
12332 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12333 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12334
12335
12336 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12337 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12338 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12339 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12340 other means, this variable is empty.
12341
12342 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12343 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12344 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12345 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12346 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12347 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12348 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12349
12350 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12351 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12352 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12353 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12354
12355 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12356 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12357 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12358 is set to &"1"&.
12359
12360 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12361 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12362 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12363 following are true:
12364
12365 .ilist
12366 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12367 .next
12368 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12369 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12370 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12371 .next
12372 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12373 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12374 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12375 .next
12376 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12377 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12378 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12379 .next
12380 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12381 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12382 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12383 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12384 .code
12385 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12386 .endd
12387 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12388 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12389 .endlist
12390
12391
12392 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12393 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12394 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12395 number that was used on the remote host.
12396
12397 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12398 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12399 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12400 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12401 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12402 called Exim.
12403
12404 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12405 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12406 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12407 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12408
12409 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12410 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12411 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12412 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12413 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12414 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12415 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12416 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12417 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12418 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12419 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12420 the parentheses.
12421
12422 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12423 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12424 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12425 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12426 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12427
12428 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12429 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12430 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12431 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12432 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12433
12434 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12435 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12436 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12437 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12438 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12439 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12440 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12441
12442 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12443 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12444 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12445 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12446 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12447
12448 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12449 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12450 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12451 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12452 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12453 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12454
12455 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12456 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12457 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12458 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12459 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12460 .code
12461 MAIL FROM:<>
12462 MAIL FROM: <>
12463 .endd
12464 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12465 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12466 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12467 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12468
12469 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12470 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12471 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12472 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12473 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12474 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12475 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12476
12477 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12478 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12479 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12480 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12481 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12482 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12483 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12484 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12485 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12486 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12487 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12488
12489 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12490 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12491 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12492 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12493 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12494 message is junk mail.
12495
12496 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12497 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12498 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12499 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12500
12501
12502 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12503 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12504 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12505
12506 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12507 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12508 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12509 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12510 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12511 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12512
12513 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12514 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12515 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12516 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12517 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12518 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12519 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12520 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12521 .code
12522 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12523 .endd
12524 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12525
12526
12527 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12528 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12529 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12530 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12531 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12532 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12533
12534 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12535 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12536 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12537 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12538 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12539 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12540 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12541 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12542
12543 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12544 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12545 the outbound.
12546
12547 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12548 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12549 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12550 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12551 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12552 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12553
12554 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12555 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12556 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12557 inbound connection when the message was received.
12558 It is only useful as the argument of a
12559 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12560 or a &%def%& condition.
12561
12562 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12563 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12564 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12565 inbound connection when the message was received.
12566 It is only useful as the argument of a
12567 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12568 or a &%def%& condition.
12569 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12570 which is not the leaf.
12571
12572 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12573 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12574 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12575 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12576 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12577 or a &%def%& condition.
12578
12579 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12580 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12581 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12582 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12583 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12584 or a &%def%& condition.
12585 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12586 which is not the leaf.
12587
12588 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12589 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12590 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12591 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12592
12593 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12594 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12595 the outbound.
12596
12597 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12598 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12599 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12600 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12601 and &"0"& otherwise.
12602
12603 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12604 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12605 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12606 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12607 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12608 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12609 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12610 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12611 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12612
12613 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12614 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12615 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12616
12617 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12618 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12619 This variable is
12620 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12621 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12622 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12623 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12624
12625 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12626 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12627 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12628 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12629 .code
12630 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12631 1 No response to request
12632 2 Response not verified
12633 3 Verification failed
12634 4 Verification succeeded
12635 .endd
12636
12637 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12638 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12639 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12640 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12641 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12642
12643 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12644 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12645 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12646 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12647 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12648 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12649 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12650 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12651 which is not the leaf.
12652
12653 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12654 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12655 the outbound.
12656
12657 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12658 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12659 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12660 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12661 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12662 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12663 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12664 which is not the leaf.
12665
12666 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12667 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12668 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12669 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12670 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12671 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12672 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12673 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12674 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12675 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12676 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12677
12678 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12679 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12680 the outbound.
12681
12682 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12683 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12684 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12685 During outbound
12686 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12687 the transport.
12688
12689 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12690 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12691 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12692 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12693
12694 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12695 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12696 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12697
12698 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12699 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12700 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12701
12702 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12703 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12704 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12705 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12706 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12707 values for those that are behind (west).
12708
12709 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12710 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12711 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12712 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12713
12714 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12715 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12716 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12717 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12718 flag.
12719
12720 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12721 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12722 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12723 -0500.
12724
12725 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12726 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12727 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12728 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12729
12730 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12731 .cindex "transport" "name"
12732 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12733 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12734 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12735
12736 .vitem &$value$&
12737 .vindex "&$value$&"
12738 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12739 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12740 &*reduce*& expansion.
12741
12742 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12743 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12744 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12745 or for cutthrough delivery,
12746 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12747 Otherwise, empty.
12748
12749 .vitem &$version_number$&
12750 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12751 The version number of Exim.
12752
12753 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12754 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12755 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12756 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12757
12758 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12759 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12760 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12761 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12762 .endlist
12763 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12764
12765
12766
12767 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12768 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12769
12770 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12771 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12772 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12773 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12774 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12775 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12776 the line
12777 .code
12778 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12779 .endd
12780 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12781
12782
12783 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12784 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12785 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12786 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12787 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12788 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12789 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12790 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12791 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12792
12793 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12794 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12795 should usually be something like
12796 .code
12797 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12798 .endd
12799 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12800 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12801 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12802 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12803 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12804 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12805 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12806 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12807 two ways:
12808
12809 .ilist
12810 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12811 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12812 a startup when Exim is entered.
12813 .next
12814 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12815 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12816 .endlist
12817
12818 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12819 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12820
12821
12822 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12823 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12824 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12825 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12826 forms:
12827 .code
12828 ${perl{foo}}
12829 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12830 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12831 .endd
12832 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12833 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12834 with an error message of the form
12835 .code
12836 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12837 .endd
12838 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12839 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12840 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12841 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12842 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12843 that was passed to &%die%&.
12844
12845
12846 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12847 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12848 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12849 the Perl code
12850 .code
12851 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12852 .endd
12853 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12854 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12855 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12856
12857 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12858 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12859 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12860 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12861
12862 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12863 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12864 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12865 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12866 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12867 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12868 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12869
12870
12871 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12872 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12873 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12874 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12875 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12876 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12877 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12878 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12879 avoided, but the output is lost.
12880
12881 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12882 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12883 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12884 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12885 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12886 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12887 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12888 .code
12889 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12890 .endd
12891 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12892 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12893 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12894 as the first subroutine argument.
12895 .ecindex IIDperl
12896
12897
12898 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12899 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12900
12901 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12902 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12903 "Starting the daemon"
12904 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12905 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12906 .cindex "network interface"
12907 .cindex "interface" "network"
12908 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12909 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12910 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12911 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12912 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12913 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12914 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12915 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12916 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12917 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12918 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12919
12920 .olist
12921 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12922 and ports to listen on.
12923 .next
12924 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12925 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12926 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12927 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12928 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12929 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12930 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12931 as an error situation.
12932 .next
12933 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12934 for the outgoing connection.
12935 .endlist
12936
12937
12938 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12939 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12940 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12941 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12942 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12943
12944 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12945 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12946 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12947 chapter describes how they operate.
12948
12949 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12950 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12951
12952
12953
12954 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12955 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12956 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12957 following options:
12958
12959 .ilist
12960 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12961 or service names.
12962 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12963 .next
12964 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12965 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12966 .endlist
12967
12968 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12969 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12970 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12971 colons. For example:
12972 .code
12973 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12974 192.168.23.65 ; \
12975 ::1 ; \
12976 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12977 .endd
12978 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12979 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12980
12981 .olist
12982 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12983 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12984 .code
12985 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12986 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12987 .endd
12988 .next
12989 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12990 with a colon separator, for example:
12991 .code
12992 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12993 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12994 .endd
12995 .endlist
12996
12997 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12998 default setting contains just one port:
12999 .code
13000 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13001 .endd
13002 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13003 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13004 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13005 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13006 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13007
13008
13009
13010 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13011 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13012 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13013 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13014 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13015 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13016 .code
13017 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13018 .endd
13019 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13020 .code
13021 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13022 .endd
13023 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13024
13025
13026
13027 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13028 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13029 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13030 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13031 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13032 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13033 exim.
13034
13035 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13036 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13037 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13038 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13039 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13040 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13041 .code
13042 -oX 1225
13043 .endd
13044 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13045 whereas
13046 .code
13047 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13048 .endd
13049 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13050 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13051 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13052
13053
13054
13055 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13056 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13057 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13058 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13059 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13060 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13061 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13062 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13063 list of port numbers or service names,
13064 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13065 common use of this option is expected to be
13066 .code
13067 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13068 .endd
13069 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13070 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13071 this way when a daemon is started.
13072
13073 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13074 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13075 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13076 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13077 connections via the daemon.)
13078
13079
13080
13081
13082 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13083 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13084 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13085 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13086 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13087 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13088 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13089 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13090 .code
13091 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13092 .endd
13093 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13094 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13095 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13096 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13097 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13098 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13099 .code
13100 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13101 .endd
13102 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13103 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13104 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13105 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13106 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13107
13108 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13109 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13110 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13111 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13112 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13113 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13114 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13115 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13116 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13117 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13118 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13119 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13120
13121 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13122 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13123 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13124 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13125 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13126
13127
13128
13129 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13130 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13131 .code
13132 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13133 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13134 .endd
13135 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13136 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13137 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13138 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13139
13140 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13141 .code
13142 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13143 .endd
13144 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13145 .code
13146 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13147 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13148 .endd
13149 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13150 IPv4 loopback address only:
13151 .code
13152 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13153 .endd
13154 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13155 .code
13156 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13157 .endd
13158 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13159
13160
13161
13162 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13163 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13164 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13165 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13166 treated as local.
13167
13168 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13169 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13170 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13171 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13172
13173 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13174 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13175 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13176 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13177 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13178 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13179 used for listening. Consider this example:
13180 .code
13181 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13182 192.168.53.235 ; \
13183 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13184
13185 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13186 .endd
13187 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13188 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13189 Exim is routing.
13190
13191 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13192 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13193 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13194 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13195 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13196 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13197 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13198 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13199
13200
13201
13202 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13203 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13204 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13205 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13206 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13207 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13208 details.
13209
13210
13211
13212
13213 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13214 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13215
13216 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13217 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13218 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13219 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13220
13221 .ilist
13222 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13223 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13224 .next
13225 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13226 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13227 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13228 .next
13229 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13230 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13231 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13232 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13233 settings.
13234 .endlist
13235
13236 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13237 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13238 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13239 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13240 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13241 listed in more than one group.
13242
13243 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13244 .table2
13245 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13246 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13247 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13248 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13249 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13250 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13251 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13252 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13253 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13254 .endtable
13255
13256
13257 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13258 .table2
13259 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13260 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13261 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13262 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13263 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13264 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13265 .endtable
13266
13267
13268
13269 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13270 .table2
13271 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13272 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13273 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13274 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13275 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13276 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13277 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13278 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13279 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13280 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13281 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13282 .endtable
13283
13284
13285
13286 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13287 .table2
13288 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13289 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13290 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13291 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13292 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13293 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13294 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13295 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13296 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13297 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13298 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13299 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13300 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13301 .endtable
13302
13303
13304
13305 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13306 .table2
13307 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13308 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13309 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13310 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13311 .endtable
13312
13313
13314
13315 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13316 .table2
13317 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13318 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13319 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13320 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13321 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13322 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13323 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13324 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13325 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13326 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13327 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13328 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13329 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13330 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13331 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13332 .endtable
13333
13334
13335
13336 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13337 .table2
13338 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13339 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13340 .endtable
13341
13342
13343
13344 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13345 .table2
13346 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13347 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13348 .endtable
13349
13350
13351
13352 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13353 .table2
13354 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13355 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13356 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13357 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13358 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13359 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13360 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13361 .endtable
13362
13363
13364
13365 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13366 .table2
13367 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13368 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13369 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13370 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13371 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13372 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13373 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13374 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13375 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13376 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13377 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13378 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13379 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13380 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13381 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13382 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13383 connection"
13384 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13385 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13386 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13387 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13388 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13389 .endtable
13390
13391
13392
13393 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13394 .table2
13395 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13396 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13397 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13398 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13399 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13400 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13401 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13402 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13403 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13404 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13405 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13406 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13407 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13408 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13409 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13410 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13411 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13412 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13413 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13414 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13415 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13416 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13417 words""&"
13418 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13419 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13420 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13421 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13422 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13423 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13424 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13425 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13426 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13427 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13428 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13429 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13430 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13431 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13432 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13433 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13434 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13435 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13436 .endtable
13437
13438
13439
13440 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13441 .table2
13442 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13443 item"
13444 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13445 item"
13446 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13447 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13448 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13449 .endtable
13450
13451
13452
13453 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13454 .table2
13455 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13456 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13457 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13458 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13459 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13460 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13461 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13462 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13463 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13464 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13465 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13466 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13467 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13468 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13469 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13470 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13471 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13472 .endtable
13473
13474
13475
13476 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13477 .table2
13478 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13479 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13480 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13481 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13482 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13483 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13484 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13485 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13486 .endtable
13487
13488
13489
13490 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13491 .table2
13492 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13493 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13494 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13495 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13496 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13497 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13498 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13499 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13500 .endtable
13501
13502
13503
13504
13505 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13506 .table2
13507 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13508 .endtable
13509
13510
13511
13512
13513
13514 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13515 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13516
13517 .table2
13518 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13519 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13520 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13521 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13522 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13523 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13524 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13525 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13526 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13527 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13528 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13529 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13530 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13531 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13532 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13533 connection"
13534 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13535 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13536 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13537 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13538 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13539 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13540 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13541 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13542 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13543 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13544 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13545 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13546 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13547 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13548 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13549 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13550 .endtable
13551
13552
13553
13554 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13555 .table2
13556 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13557 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13558 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13559 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13560 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13561 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13562 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13563 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13564 .endtable
13565
13566
13567
13568 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13569 .table2
13570 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13571 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13572 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13573 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13574 words""&"
13575 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13576 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13577 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13578 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13579 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13580 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13581 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13582 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13583 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13584 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13585 .endtable
13586
13587
13588
13589 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13590 .table2
13591 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13592 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13593 directory"
13594 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13595 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13596 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13597 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13598 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13599 .endtable
13600
13601
13602
13603 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13604 .table2
13605 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13606 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13607 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13608 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13609 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13610 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13611 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13612 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13613 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13614 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13615 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13616 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13617 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13618 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13619 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13620 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13621 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13622 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13623 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13624 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13625 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13626 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13627 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13628 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13629 .endtable
13630
13631
13632
13633 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13634 .table2
13635 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13636 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13637 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13638 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13639 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13640 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13641 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13642 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13643 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13644 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13645 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13646 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13647 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13648 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13649 .endtable
13650
13651
13652
13653 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13654 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13655 &dagger;.
13656
13657 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13658 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13659 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13660 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13661 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13662 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13663 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13664 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13665 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13666
13667 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13668 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13669 It now defaults to true.
13670 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13671 .display
13672 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13673 .endd
13674
13675 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13676 .code
13677 log_selector = +8bitmime
13678 .endd
13679
13680 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13681 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13682 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13683 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13684 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13685 further details.
13686
13687 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13688 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13689 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13690 SMTP messages.
13691
13692 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13693 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13694 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13695 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13696 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13697
13698 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13699 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13700 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13701 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13702 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13703
13704 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13705 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13706 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13707 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13708
13709 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13710 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13711 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13712 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13713 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13714
13715 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13716 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13717 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13718 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13719 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13720 This option defines the ACL that,
13721 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13722 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13723 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13724 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13725
13726 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13727 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13728 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13729 of a received message.
13730 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13731
13732 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13733 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13734 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13735 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13736
13737 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13738 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13739 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13740 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13741
13742 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13743 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13744 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13745 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13746 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13747
13748
13749 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13750 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13751 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13752 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13753
13754 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13755 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13756 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13757 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13758 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13759
13760 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13761 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13762 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13763 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13764 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13765
13766 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13767 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13768 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13769 ends without a QUIT command being received.
13770 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13771
13772 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13773 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13774 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13775 further details.
13776
13777 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13778 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13779 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13780 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13781
13782 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13783 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13784 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13785 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13786
13787 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13788 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13789 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13790 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13791
13792 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13793 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13794 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13795 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13796
13797 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13798 .cindex "admin user"
13799 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13800 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13801 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13802 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13803 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13804 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13805 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13806
13807 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13808 .cindex "domain literal"
13809 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13810 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13811 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13812 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13813
13814 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13815 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13816 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13817 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13818 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13819 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13820 the local host's IP addresses.
13821
13822
13823 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13824 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13825 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13826 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13827 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13828 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
13829 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13830 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13831 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13832
13833 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13834 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13835 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13836 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13837 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13838 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13839 experiment if they wish.
13840
13841 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13842 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13843 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13844 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13845 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13846 suitable setting is:
13847 .code
13848 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13849 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13850 .endd
13851 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13852 .code
13853 dns_check_names_pattern =
13854 .endd
13855 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13856
13857
13858 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13859 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13860 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13861 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13862 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13863 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13864 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13865 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13866 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13867 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13868 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13869
13870 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13871 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13872 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13873 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13874 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13875 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13876
13877 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13878 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13879 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13880 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13881 .code
13882 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13883 .endd
13884 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13885 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13886 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13887 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13888
13889
13890 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13891 .cindex "thawing messages"
13892 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13893 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13894 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13895 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13896 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13897 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13898
13899 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13900 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13901 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13902
13903
13904 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13905 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13906 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13907 .code
13908 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13909 .endd
13910 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13911 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13912
13913
13914 .option bi_command main string unset
13915 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13916 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13917 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13918 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13919 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13920
13921
13922 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13923 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13924 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13925 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13926 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13927 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13928
13929
13930 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13931 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13932 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13933 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13934
13935 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13936 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13937 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13938 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13939 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13940 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13941 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13942 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13943 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13944 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13945
13946 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13947 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13948 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13949 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13950
13951
13952 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13953 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13954 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13955 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13956 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13957 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13958 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13959 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13960 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13961
13962 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13963 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13964 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13965 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13966 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13967 messages.
13968
13969 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13970 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13971 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13972 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13973 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13974 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13975 connection. A typical setting might be:
13976 .code
13977 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13978 .endd
13979 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13980 .code
13981 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13982 .endd
13983 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13984 address.
13985
13986 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13987 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13988 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13989 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13990 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13991 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13992
13993
13994 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13995 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13996 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13997 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13998
13999
14000 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14001 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14002 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14003 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14004
14005
14006 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14007 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14008 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14009 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14010
14011
14012 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14013 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14014 callout verification. The default value is
14015 .code
14016 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14017 .endd
14018 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14019
14020
14021 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
14022 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14023
14024
14025 .option check_log_space main integer 0
14026 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14027
14028 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14029 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14030 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14031 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14032 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14033 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14034 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14035 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14036 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14037 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14038
14039
14040 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14041 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14042
14043
14044 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
14045 .cindex "checking disk space"
14046 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14047 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14048 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14049 message is accepted.
14050
14051 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14052 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14053 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14054 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14055 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14056 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14057 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14058 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14059
14060
14061 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14062 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14063 .code
14064 check_spool_space = 10M
14065 check_spool_inodes = 100
14066 .endd
14067 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14068 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14069 transit.
14070
14071 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14072 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14073 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14074
14075 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14076 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14077 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14078 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14079 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14080 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14081
14082 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14083 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14084
14085 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14086 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14087 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14088
14089 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14090 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14091 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14092 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14093 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14094 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14095
14096 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14097 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14098 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14099 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14100 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14101 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14102 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14103
14104 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14105 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14106
14107 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14108 .cindex "warning of delay"
14109 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14110 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14111 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14112 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14113 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14114 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14115 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14116 with
14117 .code
14118 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14119 .endd
14120 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14121 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14122 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14123 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14124 .code
14125 delay_warning = 6h
14126 .endd
14127 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14128 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14129 .code
14130 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14131 .endd
14132 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14133 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14134 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14135
14136 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14137 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14138 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14139 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14140 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14141 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14142 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14143 not sent. The default is:
14144 .code
14145 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14146 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14147 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14148 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14149 } {no}{yes}}
14150 .endd
14151 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14152 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14153 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14154 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14155
14156 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14157 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14158 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14159 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14160 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14161 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14162 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14163 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14164
14165 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14166 .cindex "load average"
14167 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14168 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14169 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14170 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14171 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14172
14173
14174 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14175 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14176 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14177 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14178 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14179 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14180 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14181 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14182
14183 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14184 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14185 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14186 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14187 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14188 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14189 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14190 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14191
14192 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14193 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14194 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14195 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14196
14197
14198 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14199 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14200 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14201 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14202 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14203 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14204 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14205
14206
14207 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14208 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14209 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14210 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14211 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14212 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14213
14214
14215 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14216 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14217 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14218 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14219 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14220 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14221 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14222 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14223 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14224 by a setting such as this:
14225 .code
14226 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14227 .endd
14228 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14229 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14230 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14231 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14232 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14233 options are applied after this global option.
14234
14235 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14236 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14237 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14238 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14239 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14240 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14241 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14242 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14243 value of this option. The default pattern is
14244 .code
14245 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14246 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14247 .endd
14248 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14249 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14250 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14251 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14252 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14253 empty string.
14254
14255 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14256 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14257 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14258
14259 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14260 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14261 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14262 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14263
14264
14265 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14266 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14267 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14268 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14269 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14270 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14271
14272 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14273
14274
14275 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14276 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14277 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14278 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14279 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14280 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14281 domain matches this list.
14282
14283 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14284 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14285 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14286
14287
14288 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14289 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14290 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14291 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14292 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14293 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14294 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14295 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14296 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14297 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14298 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14299 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14300 to set in them.
14301 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14302
14303
14304 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14305 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14306
14307
14308 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14309 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14310 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14311 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14312 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14313 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14314 match with this expanded domain list.
14315
14316 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14317 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14318 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14319 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14320 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14321 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14322
14323 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14324 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14325 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14326
14327 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14328 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14329 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14330 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14331 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14332
14333 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14334 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14335 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14336 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14337 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14338 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14339 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14340 on.
14341
14342 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14343
14344
14345 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14346 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14347 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14348 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14349
14350 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14351 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14352 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14353 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14354 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14355 and accepted from, these hosts.
14356 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14357 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14358 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14359 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14360 are sent.
14361
14362 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14363 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14364 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14365 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14366 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14367 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14368 .code
14369 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14370 .endd
14371 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14372 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14373
14374 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14375 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14376 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14377 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14378 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14379 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14380 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14381 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14382 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14383
14384
14385 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14386 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14387 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14388 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14389 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14390 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14391 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14392 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14393 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14394
14395 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14396 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14397 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14398 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14399 are examined. For example:
14400 .code
14401 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14402 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14403 postmaster@mydomain.example
14404 .endd
14405 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14406 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14407 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14408 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14409 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14410 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14411 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14412
14413
14414 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14415 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14416 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14417 .display
14418 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14419 .endd
14420 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14421 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14422 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14423 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14424 overrides the default.
14425
14426 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14427 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14428 and warning messages. For example:
14429 .code
14430 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14431 .endd
14432 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14433 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14434 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14435 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14436 not used.
14437
14438
14439 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14440 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14441 .cindex "Exim group"
14442 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14443 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14444 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14445 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14446 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14447 security issues.
14448
14449
14450 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14451 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14452 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14453 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14454 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14455 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14456 other place.
14457 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14458 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14459 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14460 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14461
14462
14463 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14464 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14465 .cindex "Exim user"
14466 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14467 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14468 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14469 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14470
14471 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14472 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14473 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14474 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14475
14476
14477 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14478 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14479 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14480 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14481
14482
14483 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14484 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14485
14486 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14487 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14488 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14489 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14490 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14491 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14492 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14493 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14494 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14495 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14496 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14497 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14498 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14499 addresses.
14500
14501
14502 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14503 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14504 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14505 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14506 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14507 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14508 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14509 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14510 retries.
14511
14512 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14513 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14514 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14515 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14516
14517
14518
14519 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14520 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14521 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14522 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14523 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14524 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14525 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14526 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14527 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14528 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14529 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14530 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14531 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14532 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14533 logging that you require.
14534
14535
14536 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14537 .cindex "HP-UX"
14538 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14539 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14540 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14541 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14542 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14543 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14544 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14545 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14546
14547 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14548 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14549 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14550 user's name.
14551
14552 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14553 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14554 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14555 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14556 .code
14557 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14558 gecos_name = $1
14559 .endd
14560
14561 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14562 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14563
14564
14565 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14566 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14567 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14568 implementations of TLS.
14569
14570
14571 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14572 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14573 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14574
14575 See
14576 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14577 for documentation.
14578
14579
14580
14581 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14582 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14583 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14584 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14585 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14586 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14587
14588
14589
14590 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14591 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14592 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14593 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14594 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14595 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14596 sections are rejected.
14597
14598
14599 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14600 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14601 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14602 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14603 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14604 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14605 zero means &"no limit"&.
14606
14607
14608
14609
14610 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14611 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14612 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14613 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14614 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14615 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14616 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14617 if you want to do semantic checking.
14618 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14619 set.
14620
14621
14622 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14623 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14624 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14625 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14626 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14627 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14628 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14629 .code
14630 helo_allow_chars = _
14631 .endd
14632 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14633
14634
14635 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14636 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14637 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14638 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14639 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14640 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14641 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14642 do.
14643
14644
14645 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14646 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14647 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14648 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14649 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14650 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14651 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14652 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14653 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14654 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14655 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14656 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14657
14658 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14659 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14660 EHLO command either:
14661
14662 .ilist
14663 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14664 .next
14665 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14666 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14667 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14668 calling host address, or
14669 .next
14670 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14671 .endlist
14672
14673 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14674 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14675 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14676
14677 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14678 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14679 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14680
14681 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14682 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14683 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14684 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14685 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14686 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14687 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14688 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14689 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14690 error.
14691
14692 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14693 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14694 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14695 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14696 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14697 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14698 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14699 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14700 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14701
14702 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14703 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14704 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14705 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14706 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14707
14708 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14709 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14710 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14711 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14712
14713
14714 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14715 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14716 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14717 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14718 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14719 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14720 default configuration file contains
14721 .code
14722 host_lookup = *
14723 .endd
14724 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14725 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14726
14727 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14728 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14729 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14730
14731 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14732 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14733 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14734 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14735 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14736 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14737
14738
14739 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14740 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14741 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14742 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14743 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14744 if you want.
14745
14746 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14747 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14748 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14749 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14750
14751
14752
14753 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14754 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14755 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14756 as soon as the connection is made.
14757 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14758 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14759 connections immediately.
14760
14761 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14762 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14763 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14764 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14765 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14766
14767
14768 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14769 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14770 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14771 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14772 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14773 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14774 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14775 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14776 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14777 .code
14778 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14779 .endd
14780 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14781
14782
14783
14784 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14785 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14786 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14787 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14788 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14789 records
14790 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14791 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14792
14793 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14794 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14795 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14796 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14797 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14798 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14799 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14800
14801
14802 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14803 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14804 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14805 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14806 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14807
14808
14809
14810 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14811 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14812 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14813 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14814 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14815 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14816
14817 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14818 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14819 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14820 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14821 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14822 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14823 for frozen messages. For example,
14824 .code
14825 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14826 .endd
14827 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14828 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14829 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14830 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14831 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14832 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14833
14834
14835 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14836 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14837 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14838 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14839 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14840 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14841 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14842 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14843 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14844 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14845
14846
14847 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14848 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14849
14850
14851 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14852 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14853 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14854 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14855 logged.
14856
14857
14858 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14859 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14860 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14861 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14862 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14863 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14864 and constrained to be a directory.
14865
14866
14867 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14868 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14869 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14870 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14871 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14872 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14873 and constrained to be a file.
14874
14875
14876 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14877 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14878 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14879 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14880 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14881
14882
14883 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14884 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14885 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14886 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14887 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14888 identity to be proven.
14889
14890
14891 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14892 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14893 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14894 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14895 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14896
14897
14898 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14899 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14900 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14901 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14902 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14903 with LDAP support.
14904
14905
14906 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14907 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14908 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14909 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14910 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14911 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14912 to hard/demand.
14913
14914
14915 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14916 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14917 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14918 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14919 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14920 of SSL-on-connect.
14921 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14922 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14923
14924
14925 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14926 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14927 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14928 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14929 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14930 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14931 has been built with LDAP support.
14932
14933
14934
14935 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14936 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14937 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14938 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14939 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14940 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14941 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14942
14943 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14944 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14945 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14946
14947 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14948 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14949 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14950 and the default qualify domain.
14951
14952 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14953 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14954 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14955 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14956
14957 .cindex "envelope sender"
14958 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14959 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14960 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14961
14962 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14963 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14964 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14965
14966
14967
14968
14969 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14970 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14971 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14972 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14973 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14974 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14975 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14976 example, if
14977 .code
14978 local_from_prefix = *-
14979 .endd
14980 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14981 .code
14982 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14983 .endd
14984 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14985 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14986 qualify domain.
14987
14988
14989 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14990 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14991
14992
14993 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14994 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14995 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14996 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14997 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14998 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14999 &%local_interfaces%& is
15000 .code
15001 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15002 .endd
15003 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15004 .code
15005 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15006 .endd
15007
15008 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15009 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15010 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15011 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15012 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15013 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15014 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15015 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15016
15017
15018
15019 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15020 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15021 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15022 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15023 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15024 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15025 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15026 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15027
15028
15029
15030
15031 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15032 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15033 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15034 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15035 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15036 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15037 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15038 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15039 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15040 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15041 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15042 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15043 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15044 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15045 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15046
15047
15048
15049 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15050 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15051 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15052 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15053 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15054 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15055 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15056 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15057 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15058 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15059 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15060 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15061 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15062 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15063 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15064
15065
15066 .option log_selector main string unset
15067 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15068 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15069 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15070 minus characters. For example:
15071 .code
15072 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15073 .endd
15074 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15075 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15076
15077
15078 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15079 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15080 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15081 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15082 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15083 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15084 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15085 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15086 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15087 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15088 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15089 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15090 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15091
15092
15093 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15094 .cindex "too many open files"
15095 .cindex "open files, too many"
15096 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15097 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15098 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15099 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15100 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15101 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15102 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15103 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15104 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15105 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15106 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15107 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15108
15109
15110 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15111 .cindex "length of login name"
15112 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15113 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15114 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15115 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15116 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15117 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15118
15119
15120 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15121 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15122 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15123 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15124 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15125 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15126 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15127 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15128
15129
15130 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15131 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15132 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15133 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15134 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15135 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15136 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15137
15138
15139 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15140 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15141 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15142 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15143 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15144 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15145 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15146 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15147 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15148 empty string, the option is ignored.
15149
15150
15151 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15152 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15153 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15154 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15155 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15156 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15157 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15158 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15159 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15160 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15161 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15162 colons will become hyphens.
15163
15164
15165 .option message_logs main boolean true
15166 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15167 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15168 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15169 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15170 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15171 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15172 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15173 which is not affected by this option.
15174
15175
15176 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15177 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15178 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15179 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15180 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15181 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15182 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15183 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15184 optionally followed by K or M.
15185
15186 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15187 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15188 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15189 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15190 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15191
15192 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15193 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15194 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15195 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15196 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15197 message that an individual transport can process.
15198
15199 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15200 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15201 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15202 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15203 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15204 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15205 some problems may result.
15206
15207 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15208 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15209 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15210
15211
15212 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15213 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15214 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15215 .code
15216 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15217 .endd
15218 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15219 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15220 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15221 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15222 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15223
15224
15225 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15226 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15227 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15228 contains a full description of this facility.
15229
15230
15231
15232 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15233 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15234 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15235 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15236 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15237
15238
15239 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15240 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15241 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15242 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15243 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15244 safety precaution.
15245
15246 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15247 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15248 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15249 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15250 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15251
15252 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15253 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15254 example is
15255 .code
15256 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15257 .endd
15258 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15259 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15260 transport driver.
15261
15262
15263 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15264 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15265 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15266 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15267 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15268
15269 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15270 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15271 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15272 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15273 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15274 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15275 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15276
15277 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15278 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15279 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15280 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15281 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15282
15283 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15284
15285 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15286 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15287 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15288 some now infamous attacks.
15289
15290 Examples:
15291 .code
15292 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15293 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15294 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15295
15296 # Disable older protocol versions:
15297 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15298 .endd
15299
15300 Possible options may include:
15301 .ilist
15302 &`all`&
15303 .next
15304 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15305 .next
15306 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15307 .next
15308 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15309 .next
15310 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15311 .next
15312 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15313 .next
15314 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15315 .next
15316 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15317 .next
15318 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15319 .next
15320 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15321 .next
15322 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15323 .next
15324 &`no_compression`&
15325 .next
15326 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15327 .next
15328 &`no_sslv2`&
15329 .next
15330 &`no_sslv3`&
15331 .next
15332 &`no_ticket`&
15333 .next
15334 &`no_tlsv1`&
15335 .next
15336 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15337 .next
15338 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15339 .next
15340 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15341 .next
15342 &`single_dh_use`&
15343 .next
15344 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15345 .next
15346 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15347 .next
15348 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15349 .next
15350 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15351 .next
15352 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15353 .next
15354 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15355 .endlist
15356
15357 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15358 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15359 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15360 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15361 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15362 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15363
15364
15365 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15366 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15367 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15368 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15369 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15370
15371
15372 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15373 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15374 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15375 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15376 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15377 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15378 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15379 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15380 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15381 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15382 an ACL.
15383
15384 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15385 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15386 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15387 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15388 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15389 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15390 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15391
15392
15393 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15394 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15395 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15396
15397
15398 .option perl_startup main string unset
15399 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15400 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15401
15402
15403 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15404 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15405 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15406 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15407 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15408 PostgreSQL support.
15409
15410
15411 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15412 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15413 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15414 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15415 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15416 to the host name:
15417 .code
15418 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15419 .endd
15420 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15421 spool directory.
15422 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15423 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15424 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15425
15426
15427 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15428 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15429 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15430 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15431 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15432 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15433 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15434 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15435 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15436
15437
15438 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15439 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15440 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15441 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15442 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15443 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15444 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15445 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15446
15447 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15448 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15449 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15450 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15451 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15452 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15453 volume of mail. Use with care!
15454
15455
15456 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15457 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15458 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15459 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15460 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15461 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15462 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15463 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15464 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15465 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15466
15467 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15468 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15469 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15470 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15471 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15472 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15473
15474
15475 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15476 .cindex "printing characters"
15477 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15478 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15479 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15480 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15481 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15482 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15483 characters.
15484
15485 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15486 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15487 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15488 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15489 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15490 standards.
15491
15492
15493 .option process_log_path main string unset
15494 .cindex "process log path"
15495 .cindex "log" "process log"
15496 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15497 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15498 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15499 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15500 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15501 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15502 different spool directories.
15503
15504
15505 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15506 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15507 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15508 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15509 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15510 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15511 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15512
15513
15514 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15515 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15516 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15517 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15518 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15519 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15520 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15521 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15522 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15523
15524 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15525 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15526 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15527 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15528 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15529 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15530 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15531
15532
15533 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15534 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15535 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15536
15537
15538
15539 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15540 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15541 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15542 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15543 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15544 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15545 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15546 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15547
15548
15549 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15550 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15551 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15552 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15553 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15554
15555
15556 .option queue_only main boolean false
15557 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15558 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15559 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15560 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15561 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15562 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15563
15564 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15565 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15566 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15567 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15568
15569
15570 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15571 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15572 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15573 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15574 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15575 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15576 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15577 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15578 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15579 .code
15580 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15581 .endd
15582 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15583 &_/some/file_& exists.
15584
15585
15586 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15587 .cindex "load average"
15588 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15589 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15590 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15591 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15592 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15593 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15594 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15595 false.
15596
15597 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15598 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15599 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15600 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15601
15602
15603 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15604 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15605 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15606 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15607 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15608 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15609 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15610 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15611 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15612 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15613 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15614 re-evaluated for each message.
15615
15616
15617 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15618 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15619 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15620 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15621 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15622 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15623
15624
15625 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15626 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15627 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15628 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15629 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15630 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15631 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15632 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15633 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15634 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15635 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15636 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15637 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15638
15639
15640
15641 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15642 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15643 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15644 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15645 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15646 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15647 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15648 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15649 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15650
15651 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15652 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15653 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15654 the daemon's command line.
15655
15656 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15657 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15658 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15659 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15660 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15661 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15662 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15663 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15664 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15665 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15666 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15667 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15668 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15669 &%queue_domains%&.
15670
15671
15672 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15673 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15674 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15675 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15676 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15677 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15678 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15679
15680 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15681 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15682 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15683 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15684 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15685 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15686 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15687 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15688 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15689 header lines. The default setting is:
15690
15691 .code
15692 received_header_text = Received: \
15693 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15694 {${if def:sender_ident \
15695 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15696 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15697 by $primary_hostname \
15698 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15699 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15700 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15701 ${if def:sender_address \
15702 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15703 id $message_exim_id\
15704 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15705 .endd
15706
15707 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15708 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15709 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15710 header lines such as the following:
15711 .code
15712 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15713 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15714 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15715 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15716 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15717 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15718 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15719 .endd
15720 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15721 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15722 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15723 message was accepted.
15724
15725
15726 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15727 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15728 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15729 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15730 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15731 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15732 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15733 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15734
15735
15736 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15737 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15738 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15739 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15740 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15741 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15742 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15743 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15744 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15745 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15746 option was not set.
15747
15748
15749 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15750 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15751 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15752 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15753 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15754 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15755 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15756 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15757 done.
15758
15759 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15760 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15761 RCPT commands in a single message.
15762
15763
15764 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15765 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15766 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15767 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15768 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15769 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15770 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15771
15772
15773 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15774 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15775 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15776 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15777 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15778 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15779 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15780 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15781 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15782 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15783 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15784 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15785 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15786 tagged with its process id.
15787
15788 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15789 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15790 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15791 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15792 is received.
15793
15794 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15795 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15796 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15797 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15798 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15799 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15800 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15801 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15802 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15803 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15804 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15805
15806 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15807 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15808 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15809 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15810
15811
15812 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15813 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15814 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15815 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15816 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15817 .code
15818 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15819 .endd
15820 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15821 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15822
15823
15824 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15825 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15826 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15827 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15828 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15829 past failures.
15830
15831
15832 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15833 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15834 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15835 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15836 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15837 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15838 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15839 the default value.
15840
15841
15842 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15843 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15844 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15845 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15846 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15847 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15848 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15849 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15850 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15851 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15852
15853
15854 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15855 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15856
15857
15858 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
15859 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15860 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15861 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
15862 an item in the list.
15863 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
15864 for the system.
15865
15866 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
15867 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15868 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15869 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15870 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15871
15872
15873 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15874 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15875 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15876 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15877 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15878 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15879 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15880 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15881 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15882 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15883
15884
15885 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
15886 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
15887 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
15888 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
15889 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
15890 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
15891 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
15892
15893
15894
15895 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15896 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15897 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15898 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15899 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15900 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15901 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15902 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15903 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15904 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15905 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15906
15907
15908
15909 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15910 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15911 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15912 .cindex "inetd"
15913 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15914 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15915 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15916 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15917 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15918 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15919
15920 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15921 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15922 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15923 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15924
15925
15926 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15927 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15928 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15929 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15930 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15931 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15932 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15933 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15934
15935 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15936 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15937 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15938 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15939 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15940 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15941 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15942 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15943
15944
15945 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15946 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15947 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15948 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15949 live with.
15950
15951
15952 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15953 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15954 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15955 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15956 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15957 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15958 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15959 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15960 . the option name to split.
15961
15962 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15963 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15964 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15965 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15966 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15967 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15968 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15969 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15970 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15971 seen).
15972
15973
15974 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15975 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15976 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15977 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15978 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15979 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15980 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15981 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15982 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15983 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15984 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15985
15986 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15987 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15988 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15989 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15990 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15991 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15992
15993
15994
15995 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15996 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15997 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15998 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15999 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16000 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16001 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16002 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16003 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16004 to all messages received in the same connection.
16005
16006 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16007 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16008 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16009 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16010
16011
16012 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16013
16014 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16015 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16016 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16017 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16018 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16019 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16020 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16021 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16022 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16023 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16024 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16025 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16026 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16027
16028
16029 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16030 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16031 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16032 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16033 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16034 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16035 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16036 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16037 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16038 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16039 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16040 individual host.
16041
16042 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16043 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16044 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16045 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16046
16047
16048 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16049 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16050 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16051 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16052 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16053 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16054 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16055 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16056 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16057
16058 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16059 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16060 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16061 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16062
16063 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16064 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16065 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16066 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16067 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16068 For example:
16069 .code
16070 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16071 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16072 .endd
16073
16074 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16075 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16076 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16077 &%helo_data%& value.
16078
16079 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16080 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16081 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16082 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16083 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16084 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16085 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16086 .code
16087 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16088 $version_number $tod_full
16089 .endd
16090 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16091 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16092 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16093 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16094 multiline response).
16095
16096
16097 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16098 .cindex "checking disk space"
16099 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16100 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16101 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16102 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16103 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16104 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16105 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16106
16107
16108 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16109 .cindex "connection backlog"
16110 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16111 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16112 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16113 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16114 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16115 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16116 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16117 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16118 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16119 attacks by SYN flooding.
16120
16121
16122 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16123 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16124 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16125 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16126 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16127 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16128 fewer, but they still exist.
16129
16130 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16131 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16132 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16133 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16134 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16135 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16136 does detect many instances.
16137
16138 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16139 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16140 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16141 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16142
16143
16144
16145 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16146 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16147 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16148 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16149 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16150 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16151 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16152 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16153 example:
16154 .code
16155 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16156 $sender_host_address
16157 .endd
16158 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16159 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16160 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16161 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16162 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16163 the command.
16164
16165
16166 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16167 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16168 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16169 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16170 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16171
16172
16173 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16174 .cindex "load average"
16175 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16176 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16177 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16178 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16179 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16180 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16181
16182
16183
16184 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16185 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16186 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16187 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16188 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16189 .code
16190 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16191 .endd
16192 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16193 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16194 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16195 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16196 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16197
16198 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16199 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16200 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16201 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16202 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16203 not count towards the limit.
16204
16205
16206
16207 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16208 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16209 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16210 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16211 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16212 that subvert web
16213 clients
16214 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16215 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16216
16217
16218
16219 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16220 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16221 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16222 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16223 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16224 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16225 recipients.
16226
16227 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16228 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16229 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16230 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16231
16232 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16233 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16234 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16235 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16236 values:
16237
16238 .ilist
16239 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16240 .next
16241 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16242 fractional parts are allowed here.
16243 .next
16244 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16245 .next
16246 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16247 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16248 .endlist
16249
16250 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16251 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16252 .code
16253 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16254 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16255 .endd
16256 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16257 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16258 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16259 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16260
16261
16262 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16263 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16264
16265
16266 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16267 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16268
16269
16270 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16271 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16272 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16273 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16274 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16275 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16276 the message is abandoned.
16277 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16278 .code
16279 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16280 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16281 .endd
16282 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16283 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16284
16285 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16286 expanded before use and may depend on
16287 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16288
16289
16290 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16291 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16292 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16293 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16294 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16295 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16296
16297
16298 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16299 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16300 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16301
16302
16303 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16304 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16305 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16306 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16307 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16308 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16309 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16310 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16311 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16312 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16313 .code
16314 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16315 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16316 .endd
16317
16318 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16319 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16320 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16321 The default value is
16322 .code
16323 127.0.0.1 783
16324 .endd
16325 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16326
16327
16328
16329 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16330 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16331 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16332 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16333 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16334 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16335 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16336 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16337 arrival of the message.
16338
16339 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16340 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16341 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16342 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16343 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16344
16345 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16346 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16347 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16348 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16349 automatically deleted.
16350
16351 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16352 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16353 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16354 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16355 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16356 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16357 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16358 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16359 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16360
16361
16362 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16363 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16364 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16365 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16366 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16367 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16368 &$primary_hostname$&.
16369
16370 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16371 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16372 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16373 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16374 as failures in the configuration file.
16375
16376 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16377 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16378
16379 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16380 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16381 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16382 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16383
16384 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16385 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16386 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16387 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16388 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16389 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16390
16391 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16392 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16393 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16394 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16395 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16396 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16397 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16398
16399
16400 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16401 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16402 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16403 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16404 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16405 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16406 domain causes a syntax error.
16407 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16408 syntax checking.
16409
16410
16411 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16412 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16413 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16414 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16415 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16416 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16417 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16418 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16419 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16420 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16421 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16422 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16423
16424
16425 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16426 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16427 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16428 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16429 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16430 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16431 details of Exim's logging.
16432
16433
16434
16435 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16436 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16437 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16438 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16439 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16440
16441
16442
16443 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16444 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16445 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16446 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16447 details of Exim's logging.
16448
16449
16450 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16451 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16452 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16453 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16454 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16455 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16456 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16457 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16458 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16459 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16460 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16461
16462
16463 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16464 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16465 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16466 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16467 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16468 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16469
16470
16471 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16472 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16473 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16474 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16475 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16476
16477 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16478 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16479 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16480 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16481 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16482
16483 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16484 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16485 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16486 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16487 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16488 contains the pipe command.
16489
16490
16491 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16492 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16493 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16494 is used in a system filter.
16495
16496
16497 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16498 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16499 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16500 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16501 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16502 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16503 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16504 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16505 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16506 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16507
16508 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16509 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16510 transport option overrides.
16511
16512
16513 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16514 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16515 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16516 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16517 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16518 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16519 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16520 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16521 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16522 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16523 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16524 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16525 TCP_NODELAY.
16526
16527
16528 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16529 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16530 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16531 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16532 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16533 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16534 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16535 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16536 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16537 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16538
16539 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16540 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16541 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16542
16543
16544 .option timezone main string unset
16545 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16546 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16547 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16548 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16549 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16550 .code
16551 timezone = UTC
16552 .endd
16553 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16554 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16555 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16556 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16557 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16558 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16559
16560
16561 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16562 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16563 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16564 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16565 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16566 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16567 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16568 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16569
16570
16571 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16572 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16573 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16574 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16575 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16576 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16577 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16578
16579 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16580 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16581 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16582 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16583
16584 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16585 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16586 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16587 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16588
16589 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16590 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16591 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16592 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16593 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16594
16595 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16596
16597
16598 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16599 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16600 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16601 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16602 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16603 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16604
16605 The value must be at least 1024.
16606
16607 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16608 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16609 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16610
16611 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16612 number.
16613
16614 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16615 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16616 larger prime than requested.
16617
16618
16619 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16620 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16621 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16622 to be used by Exim.
16623
16624 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16625 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16626 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16627 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16628 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16629 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16630 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16631
16632 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16633 loaded by Exim.
16634
16635 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16636 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16637 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16638 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16639
16640 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16641 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16642 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16643 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16644
16645 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16646 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16647 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16648 "ike23".
16649
16650 The available primes are:
16651 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16652 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16653 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16654
16655 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16656 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16657
16658 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16659 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16660 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16661 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16662 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16663 userbase.
16664
16665 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16666 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16667 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16668 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16669 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16670 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16671 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16672
16673
16674 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16675 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16676 If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16677 this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16678
16679 Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16680 For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16681 are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16682 which tell the library to choose.
16683
16684 If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16685
16686
16687 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16688 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
16689 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16690 This option
16691 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16692 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16693 Certificate Authority.
16694
16695 .new
16696 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
16697 .wen
16698
16699
16700 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16701 .cindex SSMTP
16702 .cindex SMTPS
16703 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16704 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16705 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16706 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16707
16708
16709
16710 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16711 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16712 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16713 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16714 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16715 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16716 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16717
16718 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16719
16720
16721 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16722 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16723 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16724 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16725 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16726 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16727 TLS session.
16728
16729
16730 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16731 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16732 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16733 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16734 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16735 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16736 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16737 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16738 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16739 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16740 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16741
16742
16743 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16744 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16745 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16746 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16747
16748
16749 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
16750 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16751 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16752 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
16753 word "system"
16754 or the absolute path to
16755 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
16756 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
16757
16758 The "system" value for the option will use a
16759 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
16760 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
16761 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
16762 must be specified.
16763
16764 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
16765 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
16766
16767 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16768 explicitly
16769 either by file or directory
16770 are added to those given by the system default location.
16771
16772 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16773 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16774 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16775 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16776 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16777 use the explicit directory version.
16778
16779 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16780
16781 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16782 being unset.
16783
16784
16785 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16786 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16787 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16788 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16789 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16790 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16791 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16792 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16793
16794 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16795 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16796 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16797 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16798 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16799 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16800 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16801
16802 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16803 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16804 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16805 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16806 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16807 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16808 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16809 certificate"&.
16810
16811 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16812 certificates.
16813
16814
16815 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16816 .cindex "trusted groups"
16817 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16818 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16819 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16820 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16821 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16822 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16823 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16824 are trusted.
16825
16826 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16827 .cindex "trusted users"
16828 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16829 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16830 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16831 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16832 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16833 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16834 Exim user are trusted.
16835
16836 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16837 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16838 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16839 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16840 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16841 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16842 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16843 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16844 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16845 &%-F%& option.
16846
16847 .option unknown_username main string unset
16848 See &%unknown_login%&.
16849
16850 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16851 .cindex "trusted users"
16852 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16853 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16854 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16855 .cindex "envelope sender"
16856 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16857 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16858 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16859 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16860 is used) is ignored.
16861
16862 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16863 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16864 .code
16865 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16866 .endd
16867 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16868 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16869 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16870 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16871 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16872 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16873 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16874 followed by a hyphen
16875 by a setting like this:
16876 .code
16877 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16878 .endd
16879 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16880 restriction, you can use
16881 .code
16882 untrusted_set_sender = *
16883 .endd
16884 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16885 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16886 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16887 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16888 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16889 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16890 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16891 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16892
16893 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16894 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16895 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16896 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16897 sender address.
16898
16899
16900 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16901 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16902 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16903 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16904 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16905 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16906 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16907 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16908 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16909 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16910 .code
16911 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16912 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16913 .endd
16914 The pattern can be seen by running
16915 .code
16916 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16917 .endd
16918 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16919 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16920 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16921 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16922 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16923 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16924
16925
16926 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16927 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16928
16929
16930 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16931 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16932 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16933 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16934 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16935 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16936 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16937 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16938
16939
16940 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16941 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16942 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16943 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16944 .ecindex IIDconfima
16945 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16946
16947
16948
16949
16950 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16951 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16952
16953 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16954 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16955 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16956 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16957 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16958
16959 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16960 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16961 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16962 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16963 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16964
16965
16966
16967 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16968 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16969 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16970 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16971 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16972 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16973 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16974
16975 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16976 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16977 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16978 routers, and the eventual transport.
16979
16980 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16981 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16982 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16983 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16984 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16985
16986 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16987 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16988 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16989 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16990 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16991
16992 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16993 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16994 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16995 .code
16996 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16997 .endd
16998 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16999 .code
17000 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17001 .endd
17002 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17003 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17004
17005 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17006 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17007 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17008 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17009 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17010 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17011 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17012
17013
17014
17015 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17016 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17017 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17018 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17019 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17020 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17021 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17022 routing.
17023
17024
17025
17026 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17027 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17028 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17029 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17030 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17031 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17032 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17033 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17034 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17035 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17036 you could put:
17037 .code
17038 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17039 .endd
17040 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17041 and
17042 .code
17043 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17044 .endd
17045 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17046 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17047 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17048 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17049
17050
17051 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17052 .cindex "case of local parts"
17053 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17054 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17055 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17056 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17057 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17058 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17059 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17060 more details.
17061
17062 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17063 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17064 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17065 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17066 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17067 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17068 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17069 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17070 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17071
17072 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17073 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17074 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17075 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17076
17077
17078
17079 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17080 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17081 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17082 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17083 .vindex "&$home$&"
17084 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17085 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17086 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17087 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17088 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17089 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17090 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17091 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17092 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17093 the router is skipped.
17094
17095 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17096 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17097 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17098 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17099 setting to achieve this. For example:
17100 .code
17101 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17102 .endd
17103 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17104 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17105 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17106
17107
17108
17109 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17110 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17111 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17112 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17113 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17114 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17115 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17116 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17117
17118 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17119 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17120
17121 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17122 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17123
17124 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17125 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17126 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17127 .code
17128 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17129 .endd
17130 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17131 .code
17132 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17133 .endd
17134
17135 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17136 .code
17137 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17138 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17139 condition = foobar
17140 .endd
17141
17142 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17143 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17144 be specified using &%condition%&.
17145
17146 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17147 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17148 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17149 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17150 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17151 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17152 Router rules processing behavior.
17153
17154 This is best illustrated in an example:
17155 .code
17156 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17157 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17158
17159 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17160 true {yes} {no}}
17161
17162 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17163 {yes} {no}}
17164 .endd
17165 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17166 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17167 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17168 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17169 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17170 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17171 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17172 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17173
17174 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17175 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17176 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17177 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17178 string characters.
17179
17180 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17181 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17182 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17183 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17184 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17185
17186
17187 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17188 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17189 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17190 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17191 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17192 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17193 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17194 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17195 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17196 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17197 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17198 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17199 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17200 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17201
17202
17203
17204 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17205 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17206 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17207 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17208 transport option of the same name.
17209
17210 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17211 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17212 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17213 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17214 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17215 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17216 the dnssec request bit set.
17217 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17218
17219 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17220 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17221 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17222 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17223 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17224 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17225 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17226 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17227 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17228
17229
17230 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17231 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17232 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17233 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17234 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17235 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17236 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17237 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17238
17239
17240
17241 .option driver routers string unset
17242 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17243 to be used.
17244
17245
17246 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17247 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17248 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17249 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17250 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17251 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17252 Not effective on redirect routers.
17253
17254
17255
17256 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17257 .cindex "envelope sender"
17258 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17259 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17260 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17261 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17262 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17263 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17264 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17265
17266 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17267 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17268 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17269 setting.
17270
17271 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17272 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17273 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17274 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17275
17276 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17277 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17278 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17279 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17280 settings:
17281 .code
17282 errors_to =
17283 errors_to = ""
17284 .endd
17285 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17286 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17287 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17288 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17289 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17290
17291 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17292 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17293 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17294 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17295 setting &%return_path%&.
17296
17297 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17298 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17299 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17300
17301
17302
17303 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17304 .cindex "address" "testing"
17305 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17306 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17307 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17308 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17309 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17310 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17311 on for the system alias file.
17312 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17313 are evaluated.
17314
17315 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17316 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17317 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17318
17319
17320
17321 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17322 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17323 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17324 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17325
17326
17327
17328 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17329 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17330 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17331
17332
17333
17334 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17335 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17336 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17337
17338
17339
17340 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17341 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17342 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17343 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17344 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17345 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17346 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17347 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17348 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17349
17350 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17351 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17352 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17353 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17354 transport for further details.
17355
17356
17357 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17358 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17359 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17360 .cindex "transport" "local"
17361 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17362 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17363 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17364 process.
17365 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17366 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17367 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17368 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17369 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17370
17371
17372
17373 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17374 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17375 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17376 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17377 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17378 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17379 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17380 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17381 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17382 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17383 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17384 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17385 &"see"& the added header lines.
17386
17387 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17388 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17389 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17390 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17391
17392 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17393 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17394
17395 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17396 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17397
17398 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17399 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17400 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17401 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17402 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17403 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17404 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17405 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17406 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17407 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17408
17409
17410
17411 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17412 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17413 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17414 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17415 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17416 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17417 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17418 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17419 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17420 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17421 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17422 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17423 &"see"& the original header lines.
17424
17425 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17426 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17427 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17428 errors.
17429
17430 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17431 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17432
17433 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17434 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17435
17436 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17437 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17438 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17439 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17440
17441 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17442 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17443 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17444
17445
17446
17447 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17448 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17449 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17450 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17451 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17452 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17453 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17454 like
17455 .code
17456 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17457 .endd
17458 by setting
17459 .code
17460 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17461 .endd
17462 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17463 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17464 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17465 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17466 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17467 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17468
17469 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17470 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17471 .code
17472 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17473 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17474 .endd
17475 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17476 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17477
17478 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17479 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17480 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17481 domain that is being routed.
17482
17483 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17484 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17485 checked.
17486
17487 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17488 .cindex "additional groups"
17489 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17490 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17491 .cindex "transport" "local"
17492 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17493 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17494 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17495 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17496 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17497
17498
17499
17500 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17501 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17502 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17503 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17504 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17505 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17506 evaluated.
17507
17508 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17509 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17510 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17511 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17512 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17513 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17514 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17515 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17516 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17517
17518 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17519 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17520 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17521 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17522 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17523 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17524 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17525 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17526 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17527 the relevant transport.
17528
17529 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17530 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17531 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17532 callout.
17533
17534 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17535 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17536 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17537 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17538 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17539 .code
17540 real_localuser:
17541 driver = accept
17542 local_part_prefix = real-
17543 check_local_user
17544 transport = local_delivery
17545 .endd
17546 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17547 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17548 .code
17549 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17550 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17551 .endd
17552
17553 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17554 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17555 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17556 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17557
17558
17559 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17560 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17561
17562
17563
17564 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17565 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17566 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17567 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17568 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17569 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17570 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17571 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17572 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17573 &%username-foo%&.
17574
17575
17576 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17577 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17578
17579
17580
17581 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17582 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17583 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17584 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17585 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17586 are evaluated, and
17587 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17588 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17589 example:
17590 .code
17591 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17592 .endd
17593 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17594 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17595 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17596 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17597 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17598 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17599 each virtual domain:
17600 .code
17601 postmaster:
17602 driver = redirect
17603 local_parts = postmaster
17604 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17605 .endd
17606
17607
17608 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17609 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17610 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17611 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17612 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17613 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17614 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17615 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17616 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17617 redirect addresses.
17618
17619
17620
17621 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17622 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17623 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17624 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17625 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17626 delivery to be deferred.
17627
17628 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17629 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17630 .oindex "&%self%&"
17631 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17632 means of the setting
17633 .code
17634 self = pass
17635 .endd
17636 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17637 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17638 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17639
17640 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17641 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17642 controls what happens next.
17643
17644
17645 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17646 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17647 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17648 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17649 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17650 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17651 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17652 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17653
17654 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17655 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17656 applies to all of them.
17657
17658
17659
17660 .option pass_router routers string unset
17661 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17662 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17663 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17664 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17665 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17666 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17667 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17668 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17669 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17670 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17671
17672
17673
17674 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17675 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17676 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17677 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17678 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17679 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17680
17681 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17682 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17683 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17684 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17685
17686
17687
17688 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17689 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17690 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17691 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17692 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17693 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17694 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17695
17696 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17697 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17698 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17699 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17700
17701 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17702 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17703 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17704 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17705 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17706
17707 .cindex "NFS"
17708 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17709 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17710 unavailable.
17711
17712 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17713 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17714 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17715 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17716 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17717 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17718 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17719 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17720
17721 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17722 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17723 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17724 operates as follows:
17725
17726 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17727 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17728 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17729 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17730 used. For example:
17731 .code
17732 require_files = mail:/some/file
17733 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17734 .endd
17735 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17736 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17737
17738 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17739 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17740 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17741 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17742
17743 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17744 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17745 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17746 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17747 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17748
17749 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17750 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17751 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17752 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17753 check again in that process.
17754
17755 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17756 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17757 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17758 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17759 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17760 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17761 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17762 .code
17763 require_files = +/some/file
17764 .endd
17765 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17766 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17767 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17768
17769
17770
17771 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17772 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17773 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17774 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17775 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17776 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17777 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17778 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17779 latter kind.
17780
17781 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17782 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17783 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17784 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17785 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17786 same name.
17787
17788 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17789 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17790 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17791
17792
17793
17794 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17795 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17796 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17797 .vindex "&$home$&"
17798 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17799 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17800 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17801 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17802 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17803 cause the router to defer.
17804
17805 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17806 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17807 place.
17808 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17809 are evaluated.)
17810 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17811 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17812
17813 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17814 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17815 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17816 of these values that is set:
17817
17818 .ilist
17819 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17820 .next
17821 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17822 .next
17823 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17824 .next
17825 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17826 .endlist
17827
17828 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17829 router, but not for the transport.
17830
17831
17832
17833 .option self routers string freeze
17834 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17835 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17836 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17837 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17838 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17839 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17840 of remote hosts.
17841 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17842 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17843 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17844 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17845 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17846
17847 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17848 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17849 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17850 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17851 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17852 cases:
17853
17854 .vlist
17855 .vitem &%defer%&
17856 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17857
17858 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17859 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17860 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17861 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17862
17863 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17864 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17865 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17866 rewritten.
17867
17868 .vitem &%pass%&
17869 .oindex "&%more%&"
17870 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17871 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17872 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17873 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17874 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17875 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17876 combination
17877 .code
17878 self = pass
17879 no_more
17880 .endd
17881 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17882 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17883 be passed to the next router.
17884
17885 .vitem &%fail%&
17886 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17887
17888 .vitem &%send%&
17889 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17890 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17891 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17892 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17893 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17894 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17895 .endlist
17896
17897
17898
17899 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17900 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17901 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17902 address matches something on the list.
17903 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17904 are evaluated.
17905
17906 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17907 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17908 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17909 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17910 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17911 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17912 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17913 matters.
17914
17915
17916 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17917 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17918 .cindex "packet radio"
17919 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17920 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17921 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17922 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17923 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17924 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17925 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17926 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17927
17928 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17929 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17930 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17931 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17932 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17933 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17934 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17935 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17936 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17937 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17938 .code
17939 translate_ip_address = \
17940 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17941 {$value}fail}}
17942 .endd
17943 The file would contain lines like
17944 .code
17945 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17946 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17947 .endd
17948 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17949 are doing.
17950
17951
17952
17953 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17954 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17955 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17956 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17957 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17958 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17959 delivery is deferred.
17960
17961 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17962 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17963 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17964
17965
17966
17967 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17968 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17969 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17970 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17971 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17972 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17973 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17974 overridden by a setting on the transport.
17975 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17976 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17977 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17978 environment.
17979
17980
17981
17982
17983 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17984 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17985 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17986 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17987 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17988 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17989 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17990 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17991 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17992 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17993
17994 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17995 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17996 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17997 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17998 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17999
18000 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18001 environment.
18002
18003
18004
18005
18006 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18007 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18008 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18009 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18010 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18011 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18012 delivery to be deferred.
18013
18014 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18015 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18016 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18017 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18018 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18019 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18020
18021 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18022 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18023 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18024 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18025 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18026 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18027 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18028 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18029
18030 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18031 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18032 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18033 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18034 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18035 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18036 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18037 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18038 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18039 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18040
18041 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18042 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18043 subsequent routers.
18044
18045
18046 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18047 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18048 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18049 .cindex "transport" "local"
18050 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18051 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18052 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18053 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18054 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18055 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18056 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18057 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18058 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18059 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18060 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18061 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18062
18063
18064
18065 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18066 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18067 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18068
18069
18070 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18071 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18072 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18073 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18074 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18075 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18076 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18077 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18078 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18079 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18080
18081 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18082 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18083 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18084 user or group.
18085
18086
18087 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18088 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18089 addresses,
18090 delivering in cutthrough mode
18091 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18092 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18093 are evaluated.
18094 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18095
18096
18097 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18098 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18099 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18100 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18101 are evaluated.
18102 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18103 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18104 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18105
18106
18107
18108
18109
18110
18111 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18112 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18113
18114 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18115 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18116 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18117 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18118 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18119 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18120 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18121 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18122 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18123 .code
18124 localusers:
18125 driver = accept
18126 domains = mydomain.example
18127 check_local_user
18128 transport = local_delivery
18129 .endd
18130 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18131 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18132 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18133 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18134
18135
18136
18137
18138
18139
18140 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18141 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18142
18143 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18144 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18145 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18146 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18147 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18148 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18149
18150 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18151 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18152 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18153 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18154 records.
18155
18156 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18157 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18158 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18159 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18160 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18161 generic option, the router declines.
18162
18163 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18164 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18165 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18166
18167 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18168 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18169 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18170 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18171 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18172 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18173
18174
18175 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18176 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18177 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18178 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18179 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18180 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18181
18182 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18183 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18184 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18185 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18186 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18187 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18188 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18189 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18190 case routing fails.
18191
18192
18193 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18194 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18195 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18196 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18197 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18198
18199 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18200 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18201
18202 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18203 .ilist
18204 The domain does not exist in DNS
18205 .next
18206 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18207 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18208 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18209 .next
18210 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18211 .next
18212 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18213 .next
18214 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18215 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18216 .next
18217 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18218 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18219 .next
18220 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18221 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18222 .next
18223 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18224 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18225 .endlist
18226
18227
18228
18229
18230 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18231 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18232 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18233
18234 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18235 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18236 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18237 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18238 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18239 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18240 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18241
18242
18243 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18244 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18245 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18246 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18247 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18248 required. For example,
18249 .code
18250 check_srv = smtp
18251 .endd
18252 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18253 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18254 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18255 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18256 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18257 normal way.
18258
18259 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18260 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18261 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18262 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18263 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18264 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18265
18266 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18267 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18268 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18269 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18270 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18271 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18272 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18273 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18274
18275 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18276 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18277
18278
18279
18280
18281 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18282 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18283 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18284 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18285 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18286 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18287 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18288 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18289 also being queued.
18290
18291
18292 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18293 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18294 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18295 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18296 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18297 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18298 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18299 setting:
18300 .code
18301 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18302 .endd
18303 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18304 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18305 the address record.
18306
18307
18308 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18309 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18310 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18311 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18312
18313
18314
18315
18316 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18317 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18318 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18319 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18320 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18321 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18322 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18323 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18324 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18325 &'resolv.conf'&.
18326
18327
18328
18329 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18330 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18331 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18332 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18333 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18334 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18335 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18336 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18337 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18338 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18339 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18340
18341 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18342 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18343 sense.
18344
18345 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18346 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18347 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18348 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18349 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18350 header rewriting.
18351
18352
18353 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18354 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18355 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18356 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18357 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18358 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18359 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18360 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18361
18362 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18363 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18364 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18365 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18366 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18367 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18368 without processing them independently,
18369 provided the following conditions are met:
18370
18371 .ilist
18372 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18373 &%headers_remove%&.
18374 .next
18375 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18376 the domain.
18377 .endlist
18378
18379
18380
18381
18382 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18383 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18384 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18385 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18386 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18387 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18388 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18389 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18390 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18391 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18392
18393 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18394 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18395 local wildcard.
18396
18397
18398
18399 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18400 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18401 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18402 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18403
18404
18405
18406
18407 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18408 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18409 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18410 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18411 if
18412 .code
18413 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18414 .endd
18415 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18416 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18417 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18418 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18419 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18420 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18421
18422
18423 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18424 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18425 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18426 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18427 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18428
18429 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18430 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18431 such as that implied by
18432 .code
18433 domains = @mx_any
18434 .endd
18435 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18436 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18437 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18438 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18439
18440
18441
18442
18443
18444
18445
18446
18447
18448 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18449 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18450
18451 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18452 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18453 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18454 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18455 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18456 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18457 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18458 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18459 router handles the address
18460 .code
18461 root@[192.168.1.1]
18462 .endd
18463 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18464 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18465 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18466 .code
18467 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18468 .endd
18469 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18470 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18471
18472 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18473 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18474 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18475 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18476
18477 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18478 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18479 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18480 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18481
18482
18483
18484 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18485 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18486
18487 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18488 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18489 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18490 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18491 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18492 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18493 must set
18494 .code
18495 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18496 .endd
18497 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18498
18499 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18500 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18501 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18502 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18503 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18504 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18505 must not be specified for it.
18506
18507 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18508 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18509 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18510 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18511 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18512 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18513 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18514
18515
18516 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18517 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18518 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18519 delivery to the address is deferred.
18520
18521
18522 .option port iplookup integer 0
18523 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18524 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18525 call.
18526
18527
18528 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18529 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18530 protocols is to be used.
18531
18532
18533 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18534 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18535 default value is:
18536 .code
18537 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18538 .endd
18539 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18540 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18541
18542
18543 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18544 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18545 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18546 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18547 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18548 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18549 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18550 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18551
18552
18553 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18554 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18555 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18556 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18557 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18558 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18559 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18560 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18561 following could be used:
18562 .code
18563 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18564 reroute = $local_part@$1
18565 .endd
18566
18567 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18568 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18569 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18570 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18571
18572
18573
18574
18575 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18576 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18577
18578 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18579 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18580 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18581 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18582 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18583 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18584 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18585 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18586 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18587 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18588
18589 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18590 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18591 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18592 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18593 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18594 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18595 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18596
18597 .vindex "&$host$&"
18598 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18599 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18600 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18601 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18602 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18603 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18604 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18605 text string.
18606
18607 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18608 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18609 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18610 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18611 below, following the list of private options.
18612
18613
18614 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18615
18616 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18617 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18618
18619 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18620 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18621
18622 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18623 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18624 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18625 of the following values:
18626 .code
18627 decline
18628 defer
18629 fail
18630 freeze
18631 ignore
18632 pass
18633 .endd
18634 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18635 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18636 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18637 &%pass_router%&),
18638 .oindex "&%more%&"
18639 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18640 router only if &%more%& is true.
18641
18642 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18643 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18644 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18645 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18646
18647 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18648 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18649 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18650
18651
18652 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18653 .cindex "randomized host list"
18654 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18655 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18656 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18657 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18658 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18659 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18660 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18661 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18662
18663 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18664 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18665 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18666 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18667 .code
18668 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18669 .endd
18670 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18671 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18672 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18673 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18674 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18675
18676
18677 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18678 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18679 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18680 example:
18681 .code
18682 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18683 .endd
18684 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18685 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18686 deferred.
18687
18688
18689 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18690 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18691 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18692 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18693
18694
18695 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18696 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18697 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18698 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18699 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18700 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18701 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18702 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18703
18704 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18705 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18706 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18707 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18708 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18709 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18710 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18711 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18712
18713
18714
18715
18716 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18717 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18718 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18719 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18720 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18721 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18722 .display
18723 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18724 .endd
18725 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18726 no options:
18727 .code
18728 route_list = \
18729 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18730 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18731 .endd
18732 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18733 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18734 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18735 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18736 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18737 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18738 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18739 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18740 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18741 in a &%route_list%&).
18742
18743 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18744 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18745 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18746 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18747
18748
18749
18750 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18751 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18752 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18753 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18754 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18755 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18756 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18757 like this:
18758 .code
18759 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18760 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18761 .endd
18762 This data can be accessed by setting
18763 .code
18764 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18765 .endd
18766 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18767 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18768 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18769 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18770 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18771
18772
18773
18774
18775 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18776 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18777 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18778 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18779 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18780 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18781 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18782
18783 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18784 variables are set during its expansion:
18785
18786 .ilist
18787 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18788 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18789 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18790 .code
18791 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18792 .endd
18793 .next
18794 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18795 .next
18796 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18797
18798 .next
18799 .vindex "&$value$&"
18800 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18801 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18802 .code
18803 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18804 .endd
18805 .endlist
18806
18807 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18808 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18809
18810
18811
18812 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18813 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18814 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18815 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18816 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18817 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18818
18819 .ilist
18820 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18821 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18822 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18823 .code
18824 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18825 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18826 .endd
18827 .next
18828 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18829 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18830 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18831 number follows. For example:
18832 .code
18833 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18834 .endd
18835 .endlist
18836
18837 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18838 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18839 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18840 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18841 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18842 transport.
18843
18844 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18845 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18846 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18847 records in the DNS. For example:
18848 .code
18849 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18850 .endd
18851 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18852 example:
18853 .code
18854 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18855 .endd
18856 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18857 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18858 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18859 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18860 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18861 happens is controlled by the
18862 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18863 &%self%& option of the router.
18864
18865 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18866 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18867 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18868 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18869 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18870 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18871 defined by MX preferences.
18872
18873 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18874 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18875 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18876
18877 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18878 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18879 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18880 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18881
18882 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18883 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18884 router.
18885
18886 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18887 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18888 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18889
18890 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18891 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18892
18893
18894
18895 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18896 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18897 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18898 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18899 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18900 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18901 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18902
18903 .ilist
18904 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18905 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18906 .next
18907 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18908 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18909 .next
18910 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18911 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18912 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18913 .next
18914 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18915 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18916 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18917 .endlist
18918
18919 For example:
18920 .code
18921 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18922 domain2 host4:host5
18923 .endd
18924 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18925 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18926 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18927 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18928 call.
18929
18930 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18931 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18932 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18933 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18934 function called.
18935
18936
18937
18938 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18939 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18940
18941 .vindex "&$host$&"
18942 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18943 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18944
18945
18946
18947 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18948 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18949 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18950
18951 .ilist
18952 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18953 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18954 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18955 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18956 .code
18957 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18958 .endd
18959 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18960 your first router something like this:
18961 .code
18962 smart_route:
18963 driver = manualroute
18964 domains = !+local_domains
18965 transport = remote_smtp
18966 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18967 .endd
18968 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18969 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18970 they are tried in order
18971 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18972 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18973 .code
18974 smart_route:
18975 driver = manualroute
18976 transport = remote_smtp
18977 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18978 .endd
18979 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18980 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18981 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18982 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18983 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18984 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18985 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18986 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18987
18988 .next
18989 .cindex "mail hub example"
18990 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18991 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18992 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18993 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18994 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18995 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18996 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18997 lookup is easier to manage.
18998
18999 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19000 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19001 example:
19002 .code
19003 hub_route:
19004 driver = manualroute
19005 transport = remote_smtp
19006 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19007 .endd
19008 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19009 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19010 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19011 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19012 domain can be used to find the host:
19013 .code
19014 through_firewall:
19015 driver = manualroute
19016 transport = remote_smtp
19017 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19018 .endd
19019 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19020 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19021 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19022 next router.
19023
19024 .next
19025 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19026 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19027 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19028 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19029 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19030 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19031 .code
19032 save_in_file:
19033 driver = manualroute
19034 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19035 route_list = saved.domain.example
19036 .endd
19037 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19038 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19039 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19040 .code
19041 save_in_file:
19042 driver = manualroute
19043 route_list = \
19044 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19045 *.saved.domain2.example \
19046 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19047 batch_pipe
19048 .endd
19049 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19050 .vindex "&$host$&"
19051 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19052 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19053 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19054 the address if the lookup fails.
19055
19056 .next
19057 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19058 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19059 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19060 one way it can be done:
19061 .code
19062 # Transport
19063 uucp:
19064 driver = pipe
19065 user = nobody
19066 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19067 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19068 return_fail_output = true
19069
19070 # Router
19071 uucphost:
19072 transport = uucp
19073 driver = manualroute
19074 route_data = \
19075 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19076 .endd
19077 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19078 .code
19079 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19080 .endd
19081 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19082 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19083 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19084 .endlist
19085 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19086 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19087
19088
19089
19090
19091
19092
19093
19094
19095 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19096 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19097
19098 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19099 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19100 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19101 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19102 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19103 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19104 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19105 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19106 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19107 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19108 options:
19109 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19110
19111 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19112 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19113 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19114 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19115 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19116
19117
19118 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19119 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19120 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19121 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19122 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19123 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19124
19125
19126 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19127 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19128 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19129 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19130 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19131 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19132 not set, a value for the gid also.
19133
19134 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19135 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19136 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19137 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19138 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19139 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19140 gid.
19141
19142
19143 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19144 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19145 before running the command.
19146
19147
19148 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19149 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19150 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19151 timeout.
19152
19153
19154 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19155 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19156 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19157 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19158 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19159
19160 .ilist
19161 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19162 below).
19163 .next
19164 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19165 &%no_more%& is set.
19166 .next
19167 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19168 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19169 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19170 included in the SMTP response.
19171 .next
19172 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19173 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19174 included in any SMTP response.
19175 .next
19176 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19177 .next
19178 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19179 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19180 .next
19181 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19182 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19183 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19184 .endlist
19185
19186 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19187 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19188 the page):
19189 .code
19190 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19191 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19192 .endd
19193 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19194 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19195 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19196 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19197
19198 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19199 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19200 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19201 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19202 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19203
19204 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19205 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19206 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19207 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19208 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19209
19210 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19211 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19212 variable. For example, this return line
19213 .code
19214 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19215 .endd
19216 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19217 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19218 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19219 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19220
19221
19222
19223
19224 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19225 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19226
19227 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19228 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19229 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19230 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19231 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19232 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19233 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19234 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19235 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19236 redirected in several different ways:
19237
19238 .ilist
19239 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19240 independently.
19241 .next
19242 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19243 .next
19244 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19245 .next
19246 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19247 .next
19248 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19249 .next
19250 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19251 .next
19252 It can be discarded.
19253 .endlist
19254
19255 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19256 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19257 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19258 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19259
19260 If success DSNs have been requested
19261 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19262 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19263 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19264
19265
19266
19267 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19268 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19269 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19270 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19271 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19272 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19273 .code
19274 system_aliases:
19275 driver = redirect
19276 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19277 .endd
19278 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19279 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19280 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19281 cause delivery to be deferred.
19282
19283 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19284 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19285 .code
19286 userforward:
19287 driver = redirect
19288 check_local_user
19289 file = $home/.forward
19290 no_verify
19291 .endd
19292 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19293 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19294 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19295 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19296 comments.
19297
19298
19299
19300 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19301 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19302 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19303 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19304
19305 .ilist
19306 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19307 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19308 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19309 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19310 .next
19311 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19312 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19313 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19314 saves some resources.
19315 .endlist
19316
19317
19318
19319
19320
19321
19322 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19323 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19324 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19325 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19326 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19327
19328 .ilist
19329 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19330 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19331 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19332 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19333 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19334 document is intended for use by end users.
19335 .next
19336 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19337 described in the next section.
19338 .endlist
19339
19340 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19341 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19342 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19343 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19344 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19345
19346
19347
19348 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19349 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19350 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19351 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19352 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19353 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19354 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19355 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19356 commas or newlines.
19357 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19358 quotes.
19359
19360 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19361 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19362 next newline character is ignored.
19363
19364 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19365 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19366 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19367 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19368 removed.
19369
19370 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19371 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19372 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19373 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19374 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19375 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19376 setting:
19377 .code
19378 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19379 .endd
19380
19381
19382 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19383 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19384 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19385 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19386 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19387 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19388 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19389 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19390 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19391 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19392 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19393
19394 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19395 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19396 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19397 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19398 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19399 .code
19400 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19401 .endd
19402 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19403 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19404 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19405 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19406 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19407 synonymously.
19408
19409 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19410 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19411 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19412 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19413 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19414
19415 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19416 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19417 contains:
19418 .code
19419 Sam.Reman: spqr
19420 .endd
19421 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19422 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19423 this forward file:
19424 .code
19425 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19426 .endd
19427 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19428 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19429 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19430 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19431 should really contain
19432 .code
19433 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19434 .endd
19435 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19436 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19437 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19438
19439
19440
19441 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19442 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19443 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19444
19445 .ilist
19446 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19447 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19448 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19449 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19450 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19451 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19452 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19453
19454 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19455 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19456 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19457 in double quotes, for example:
19458 .code
19459 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19460 .endd
19461 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19462 quote just the command. An item such as
19463 .code
19464 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19465 .endd
19466 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19467
19468 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19469 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19470 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19471 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19472 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19473 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19474 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19475 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19476 an &%accept%& router.
19477
19478 .next
19479 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19480 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19481 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19482 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19483 .code
19484 /home/world/minbari
19485 .endd
19486 is treated as a file name, but
19487 .code
19488 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19489 .endd
19490 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19491 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19492 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19493 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19494
19495 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19496 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19497
19498 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19499 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19500 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19501 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19502
19503 .next
19504 .cindex "included address list"
19505 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19506 If an item is of the form
19507 .code
19508 :include:<path name>
19509 .endd
19510 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19511 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19512 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19513 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19514 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19515 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19516 .code
19517 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19518 .endd
19519 It must be given as
19520 .code
19521 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19522 .endd
19523 .next
19524 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19525 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19526 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19527 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19528 .cindex "black hole"
19529 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19530 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19531 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
19532 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19533
19534 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19535 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19536 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19537 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19538 &_/dev/null_&.
19539
19540 .next
19541 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19542 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19543 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19544 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19545 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19546 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19547 redirection items of the form
19548 .code
19549 :defer:
19550 :fail:
19551 .endd
19552 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19553 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19554 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19555 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19556 .code
19557 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19558 .endd
19559 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19560 of a
19561 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19562 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19563 default.
19564 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19565 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19566 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19567
19568 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19569 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19570 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19571 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19572 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19573 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19574 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19575 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19576 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19577 ignored.
19578
19579 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19580 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19581 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19582 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19583
19584 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19585 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19586 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19587 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19588 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19589
19590 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19591 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19592 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19593 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19594 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19595 rules still apply.
19596
19597 .next
19598 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19599 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19600 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19601 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19602 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19603 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19604 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19605 .endlist
19606
19607
19608 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19609 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19610 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19611 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19612 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19613 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19614 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19615 aliasing scheme of the type
19616 .code
19617 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19618 localpart1: pipe
19619 localpart2: pipe
19620 .endd
19621 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19622 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19623 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19624 such as
19625 .code
19626 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19627 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19628 .endd
19629 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19630 the pipes are distinct.
19631
19632
19633
19634 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19635 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19636 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19637 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19638 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19639 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19640 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19641 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19642 can be used to avoid this.
19643
19644
19645 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19646 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19647 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19648 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19649 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19650 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19651 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19652
19653
19654
19655 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19656
19657 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19658 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19659
19660
19661 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19662 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19663 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19664
19665
19666 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19667 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19668 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19669 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19670
19671
19672 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19673 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19674 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19675 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19676 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19677 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19678 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19679
19680 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19681 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19682
19683
19684 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19685 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19686 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19687 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19688 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19689
19690
19691
19692 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19693 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19694 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19695 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19696 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19697 let ordinary users do.
19698
19699
19700
19701 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19702 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19703 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19704 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19705 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19706 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19707
19708 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19709 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19710 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19711 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19712 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19713 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19714 .code
19715 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19716 .endd
19717 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19718 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19719 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19720 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19721 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19722 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19723 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19724 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19725
19726
19727 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19728 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19729 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19730 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19731 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19732 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19733 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19734 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19735
19736
19737
19738 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19739 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19740 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19741 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19742 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19743 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19744
19745
19746 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19747 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19748 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19749 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19750 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19751 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19752
19753 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19754 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19755 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19756 .code
19757 data = #Exim filter\n\
19758 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19759 .endd
19760 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19761 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19762 choice into a newline.
19763
19764
19765 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19766 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19767 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19768 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19769 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19770
19771
19772 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19773 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19774 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19775 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19776 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19777 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19778 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19779 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19780
19781 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19782 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19783 runs a check on the containing directory,
19784 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19785 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19786 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19787 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19788 not, the router declines.
19789
19790
19791 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19792 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19793 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19794 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19795 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19796 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19797 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19798
19799
19800 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19801 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19802 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19803 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19804 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19805
19806
19807 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19808 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19809 redirection list.
19810
19811
19812 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19813 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19814 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19815
19816
19817
19818
19819 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19820 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19821 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19822 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19823 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19824 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19825 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19826 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19827 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19828
19829
19830 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19831 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19832 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19833 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19834 functions.
19835
19836 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19837 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19838 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19839 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19840
19841 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19842 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19843 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19844 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19845 &_.forward_& files).
19846
19847
19848 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19849 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19850 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19851
19852
19853 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19854 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19855 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19856 of the embedded Perl support.
19857
19858
19859 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19860 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19861 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19862
19863
19864 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19865 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19866 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19867
19868
19869 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19870 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19871 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19872 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19873 &%one_time%& is set.
19874
19875
19876 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19877 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19878 to make use of &%run%& items.
19879
19880
19881 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19882 If this option is true, items of the form
19883 .code
19884 :include:<path name>
19885 .endd
19886 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19887
19888
19889 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19890 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19891 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19892 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19893 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19894
19895
19896 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19897 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19898 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19899
19900
19901 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19902 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19903 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19904 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19905 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19906
19907
19908
19909
19910 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19911 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19912 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19913 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19914 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19915 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19916 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19917
19918
19919 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19920 .cindex "EACCES"
19921 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19922 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19923 file did not exist.
19924
19925
19926 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19927 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
19928 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19929 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19930 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19931
19932 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19933 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19934 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19935 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19936 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19937 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19938 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19939 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19940
19941
19942
19943 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19944 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19945 redirection list must start with this directory.
19946
19947
19948 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19949 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19950 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19951
19952
19953 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19954 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19955 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19956 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19957 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19958 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19959 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19960 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19961 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19962 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19963 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19964 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19965 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19966 before they subscribed.
19967
19968 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19969 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19970 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19971 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19972 attempt.
19973
19974 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19975 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19976 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19977 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19978
19979 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19980 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19981 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19982
19983 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19984 &%one_time%&.
19985
19986 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19987 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19988 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19989 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19990 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19991 expansion.
19992
19993
19994 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
19995 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19996 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19997 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19998 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19999 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20000 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20001 See &%check_owner%& above.
20002
20003
20004 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20005 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20006 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20007 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20008
20009
20010 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20011 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20012 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20013 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20014 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20015 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20016 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20017
20018
20019 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20020 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20021 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20022 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20023 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20024 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20025 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20026 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20027
20028 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20029 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20030 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20031 addresses.
20032
20033 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20034 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20035 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20036 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20037 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20038 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20039 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20040 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20041 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20042 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20043
20044
20045 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20046 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20047 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20048 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20049 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20050 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20051
20052
20053 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20054 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20055 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20056 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20057 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20058 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20059
20060
20061 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20062 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20063 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20064 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20065 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20066
20067
20068 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20069 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20070 :subaddress part of an address.
20071
20072 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20073 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20074 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20075 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20076
20077
20078 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20079 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20080 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20081 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20082 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20083 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20084 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20085
20086
20087
20088 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20089 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20090 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20091 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20092 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20093 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20094 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20095 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20096 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20097 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20098 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20099 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20100 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20101 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20102 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20103 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20104
20105 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20106 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20107 the following routers.
20108
20109 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20110 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20111 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20112 so it is passed to the following routers.
20113
20114 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20115 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20116 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20117 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20118
20119 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20120 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20121 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20122 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20123 .code
20124 userforward:
20125 driver = redirect
20126 allow_filter
20127 check_local_user
20128 file = $home/.forward
20129 file_transport = address_file
20130 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20131 reply_transport = address_reply
20132 no_verify
20133 skip_syntax_errors
20134 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20135 syntax_errors_text = \
20136 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20137 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20138 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20139 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20140 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20141 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20142 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20143 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20144 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20145 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20146 .endd
20147 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20148 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20149 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20150 .code
20151 real_localuser:
20152 driver = accept
20153 check_local_user
20154 local_part_prefix = real-
20155 transport = local_delivery
20156 .endd
20157 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20158 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20159 .code
20160 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20161 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20162 .endd
20163
20164
20165 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20166 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20167
20168
20169 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20170 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20171 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20172 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20173
20174
20175
20176
20177
20178
20179 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20181
20182 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20183 "Environment for local transports"
20184 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20185 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20186 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20187 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20188 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20189 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20190 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20191
20192 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20193 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20194 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20195 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20196
20197 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20198 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20199 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20200 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20201 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20202
20203
20204
20205 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20206 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20207 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20208 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20209 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20210 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20211 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20212 time.
20213
20214 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20215 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20216 .code
20217 my_transport:
20218 driver = pipe
20219 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20220 .endd
20221 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20222 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20223 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20224 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20225
20226
20227
20228
20229 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20230 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20231 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20232 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20233 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20234 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20235 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20236 group (set by the transport). For example:
20237 .code
20238 # Routers ...
20239 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20240 local_users:
20241 driver = accept
20242 check_local_user
20243 transport = group_delivery
20244
20245 # Transports ...
20246 # This transport overrides the group
20247 group_delivery:
20248 driver = appendfile
20249 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20250 group = mail
20251 .endd
20252 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20253 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20254 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20255 set.
20256
20257 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20258 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20259 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20260 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20261 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20262 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20263
20264 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20265 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20266 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20267 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20268 original gid is also used.
20269
20270 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20271 following that is set is used:
20272
20273 .ilist
20274 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20275 .next
20276 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20277 .next
20278 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20279 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20280 .next
20281 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20282 .next
20283 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20284 the uid is the creator's uid;
20285 .next
20286 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20287 .endlist
20288
20289 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20290 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20291 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20292 The first of the following that is set is used:
20293
20294 .ilist
20295 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20296 .next
20297 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20298 .next
20299 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20300 .next
20301 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20302 .next
20303 The Exim uid.
20304 .endlist
20305
20306 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20307 &%never_users%& list.
20308
20309
20310
20311
20312
20313 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20314 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20315 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20316 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20317 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20318 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20319 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20320 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20321 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20322 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20323
20324 .ilist
20325 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20326 .next
20327 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20328 .next
20329 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20330 .next
20331 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20332 .endlist
20333
20334 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20335
20336 .ilist
20337 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20338 .next
20339 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20340 .endlist
20341
20342
20343 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20344 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20345 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20346
20347
20348
20349 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20350 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20351 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20352 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20353 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20354 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20355 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20356 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20357 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20358 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20359 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20360 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20361 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20362 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20363
20364
20365
20366
20367
20368
20369
20370 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20371 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20372
20373 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20374 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20375 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20376 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20377 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20378
20379
20380 .option body_only transports boolean false
20381 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20382 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20383 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20384 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20385 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20386 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20387 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20388 automatically suppress them.
20389
20390
20391 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20392 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20393 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20394 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20395 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20396 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20397
20398
20399 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20400 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20401 deliveries by the transport or for any
20402 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20403 what you are doing.
20404
20405
20406 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20407 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20408 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20409 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20410 transport is run.
20411 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20412 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20413 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20414 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20415 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20416 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20417 one.
20418 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20419 transport and the router that called it.
20420
20421 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20422 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20423 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20424 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20425 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20426 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20427 safely be resent to other recipients.
20428
20429
20430 .option driver transports string unset
20431 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20432 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20433
20434
20435 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20436 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20437 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20438 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20439 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20440 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20441 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20442 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20443 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20444 resent to other recipients.
20445
20446
20447 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20448 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20449 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20450 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20451 &%user%& (see below).
20452
20453
20454 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20455 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20456 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20457 This option specifies a list of text headers,
20458 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20459 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20460 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20461 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20462 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20463 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20464 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20465
20466 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20467 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20468
20469
20470 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20471 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20472 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20473 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20474 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20475 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20476 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20477 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20478
20479
20480 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20481 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20482 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20483 This option specifies a list of header names,
20484 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20485 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20486 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20487 routers.
20488 Each list item is separately expanded.
20489 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20490 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20491 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20492
20493 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20494 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20495
20496 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
20497 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
20498 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
20499
20500
20501
20502 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20503 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20504 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20505 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20506 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20507 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20508 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20509 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20510 example,
20511 .code
20512 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20513 x@y w@z
20514 .endd
20515 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20516 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20517 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20518 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20519 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20520 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20521 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20522 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20523 change envelope recipients at this time.
20524
20525
20526 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20527 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20528 .vindex "&$home$&"
20529 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20530 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20531 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20532 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20533 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20534 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20535 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20536 deferred.
20537
20538
20539 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20540 .cindex "additional groups"
20541 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20542 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20543 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20544 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20545 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20546
20547
20548 .new
20549 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
20550 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
20551 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
20552 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
20553 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
20554 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
20555 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
20556 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
20557
20558 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
20559 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
20560 incremented whenever a transport process is beaing created. The record
20561 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
20562 Obviously there is scope for
20563 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
20564 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
20565
20566 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
20567 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
20568 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
20569 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
20570 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
20571 .wen
20572
20573
20574 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20575 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20576 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20577 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20578 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20579 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20580 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20581 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20582 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20583 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20584 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20585 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20586 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20587 delivered.
20588
20589
20590
20591 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20592 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20593 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20594 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20595 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20596 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20597 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20598 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20599 that contains
20600 .code
20601 local_part_prefix = *-
20602 .endd
20603 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20604 is delivered with
20605 .code
20606 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20607 .endd
20608 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20609 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20610 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20611 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20612 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20613
20614
20615 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20616 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20617 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20618 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20619 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20620 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20621 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20622 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20623 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20624
20625 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20626 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20627 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20628 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20629
20630 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20631 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20632 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20633
20634
20635 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20636 .cindex "envelope sender"
20637 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20638 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20639 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20640 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20641 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20642 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20643 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20644 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20645 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20646
20647 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20648 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20649
20650 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20651 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20652 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20653 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20654 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20655 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20656 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20657
20658 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20659 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20660 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20661 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20662 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20663
20664
20665
20666 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20667 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20668 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20669 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20670 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20671 have easy access to it.
20672
20673 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20674 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20675 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20676 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20677 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20678 recipients.
20679
20680
20681 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20682 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20683
20684
20685 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20686 .cindex "shadow transport"
20687 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20688 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20689 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20690
20691 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20692 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20693 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20694 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20695 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20696 cause a log line to be written.
20697
20698 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20699 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20700 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20701 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20702 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20703 of the form
20704 .code
20705 ST=<shadow transport name>
20706 .endd
20707 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20708 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20709 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20710 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20711 headers that some sites insist on.
20712
20713
20714 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20715 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20716 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20717 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20718 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20719 individual users or via a system filter.
20720 .new
20721 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
20722 .wen
20723
20724 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20725 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20726 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20727 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20728 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20729
20730 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20731 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20732 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20733 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20734 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20735 &(pipe)& transports.
20736
20737 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20738 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20739 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20740 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20741 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20742
20743 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20744 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20745 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20746 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20747
20748 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20749 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20750 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20751 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20752 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20753 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20754
20755 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20756 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20757 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20758 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20759 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20760 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20761 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20762 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20763
20764 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20765 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20766 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20767 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20768 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20769 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20770 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20771 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20772 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20773 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20774
20775 .vindex "&$host$&"
20776 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20777 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20778 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20779 which the message is being sent. For example:
20780 .code
20781 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20782 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20783 .endd
20784
20785 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20786 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20787 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20788 .ilist
20789 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20790 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20791 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20792 example:
20793 .code
20794 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20795 .endd
20796 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20797 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20798 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20799 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20800 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20801 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20802 .next
20803 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20804 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20805 arguments. Consider this example:
20806 .code
20807 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20808 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20809 .endd
20810 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20811 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20812 .code
20813 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20814 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20815 .endd
20816 .endlist
20817
20818 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20819 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20820 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20821 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20822 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20823 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20824 bounced from a transport filter.
20825
20826 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20827 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20828 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20829
20830
20831 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20832 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20833 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20834 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20835 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20836 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20837 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20838 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20839 becomes a temporary error.
20840
20841
20842 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20843 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20844 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20845 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20846 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20847 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20848 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20849 option is not set.
20850
20851 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20852 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20853 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20854
20855 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20856 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20857 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20858 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20859 retry data.
20860 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20861 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20862 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20863
20864
20865
20866
20867
20868
20869 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20870 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20871
20872 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20873 "Address batching"
20874 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20875 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20876 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20877 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20878 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20879 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20880 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20881
20882 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20883 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20884 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20885 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20886 local transport, for example:
20887
20888 .ilist
20889 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20890 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20891 recipients saves space.
20892 .next
20893 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20894 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20895 .next
20896 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20897 to a scanner program or
20898 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20899 acceptable.
20900 .endlist
20901
20902 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20903 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20904 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20905
20906 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20907 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20908 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20909 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20910 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20911 to certain conditions:
20912
20913 .ilist
20914 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20915 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20916 batching is possible.
20917 .next
20918 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20919 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20920 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20921 .next
20922 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20923 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20924 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20925 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20926 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20927 from taking place.
20928 .next
20929 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20930 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20931 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20932 be the same.
20933 .endlist
20934
20935 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20936 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20937 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20938 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20939 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20940 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20941 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20942 .code
20943 check_string = "."
20944 escape_string = ".."
20945 .endd
20946 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20947 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20948 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20949
20950 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20951 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20952 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20953 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20954 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20955 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20956
20957 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20958 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20959 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20960 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20961 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20962 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20963 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20964 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20965 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20966
20967
20968
20969
20970 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20971 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20972
20973 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20974 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20975 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20976 .cindex "directory creation"
20977 .cindex "creating directories"
20978 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20979 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20980 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20981 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20982 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20983 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20984 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20985 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20986 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20987 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20988
20989 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20990 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20991 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20992 included.
20993
20994 .cindex "quota" "system"
20995 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20996 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20997 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20998
20999 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21000 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21001 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21002 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21003
21004 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21005 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21006 private options.
21007
21008 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21009 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21010 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21011 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21012 option).
21013
21014
21015
21016 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21017 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21018 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21019 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21020 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21021
21022 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21023 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21024 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21025 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21026 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21027 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21028 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21029 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21030 operation. There are two cases:
21031
21032 .ilist
21033 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21034 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21035 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21036 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21037 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21038 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21039 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21040 .next
21041 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21042 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21043 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21044 .endlist
21045
21046
21047 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21048 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21049 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21050 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21051 form:
21052 .code
21053 save folder23
21054 .endd
21055 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21056 .code
21057 require "fileinto";
21058 fileinto "folder23";
21059 .endd
21060 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21061 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21062 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21063 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21064 way of handling this requirement:
21065 .code
21066 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21067 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21068 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21069 {$address_file} \
21070 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21071 }} \
21072 }
21073 .endd
21074 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21075 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21076 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21077
21078 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21079 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21080 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21081 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21082 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21083 path to the transport.
21084
21085 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21086 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21087
21088
21089
21090
21091 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21092 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21093
21094
21095
21096 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21097 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21098 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21099 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21100 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21101 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21102 delivery is deferred.
21103
21104
21105 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21106 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21107 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21108 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21109 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21110 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21111 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21112 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21113
21114
21115 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21116 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21117 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21118 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21119 file.
21120
21121
21122 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21123 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21124
21125
21126 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21127 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21128 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21129 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21130 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21131
21132
21133 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21134 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21135 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21136 process is running.
21137
21138
21139 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21140 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21141 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21142 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21143 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21144 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21145 contains is significant.
21146
21147 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21148 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21149 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21150 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21151 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21152
21153 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21154 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21155 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21156 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21157 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21158 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21159 .code
21160 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21161 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21162 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21163 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21164 .endd
21165 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21166 .cindex "directory creation"
21167 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21168 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21169 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21170
21171 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21172 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21173 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21174 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21175 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21176
21177
21178
21179 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21180 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21181 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21182 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21183 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21184 beneath.
21185
21186 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21187 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21188 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21189 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21190 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21191 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21192 &%file_must_exist%&.
21193
21194
21195 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21196 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21197 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21198 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21199
21200 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21201 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21202 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21203 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21204 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21205
21206
21207 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21208 .cindex "base62"
21209 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21210 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21211 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21212 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21213 .code
21214 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21215 .endd
21216 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21217 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21218 option.
21219
21220
21221 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21222 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21223 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21224
21225
21226 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21227 See &%check_string%& above.
21228
21229
21230 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21231 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21232 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21233 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21234 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21235 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21236 &%file%&.
21237
21238 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21239 .cindex "locking files"
21240 .cindex "lock files"
21241 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21242 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21243
21244 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21245 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21246 examples:
21247 .code
21248 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21249 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21250 file = $home/inbox
21251 .endd
21252 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21253 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21254 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21255 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21256 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21257 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21258
21259
21260
21261 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21262 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21263 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21264 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21265 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21266 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21267 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21268 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21269 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21270 this added to it:
21271 .code
21272 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21273 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21274 .endd
21275 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21276 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21277 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21278 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21279 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21280 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21281 delivery is deferred.
21282
21283
21284 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21285 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21286 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21287 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21288
21289
21290 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21291 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21292 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21293 .cindex "locking files"
21294 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21295 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21296 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21297 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21298 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21299 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21300 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21301 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21302
21303 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21304 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21305 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21306 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21307
21308 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21309 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21310 retries is
21311 .code
21312 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21313 .endd
21314 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21315 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21316 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21317
21318 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21319 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21320 .code
21321 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21322 .endd
21323
21324 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21325 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21326 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21327 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21328
21329
21330 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21331 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21332 for details of locking.
21333
21334
21335 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21336 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21337 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21338
21339
21340 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21341 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21342 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21343
21344
21345 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21346 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21347 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21348 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21349 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21350
21351
21352 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21353 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21354 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21355 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21356 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21357 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21358 external source that maintains the data.
21359
21360
21361 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21362 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21363 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21364 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21365 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21366 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21367 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21368 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21369
21370
21371
21372 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21373 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21374 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21375 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21376 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21377 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21378 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21379 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21380 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21381 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21382
21383
21384 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21385 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21386 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21387 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21388 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21389 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21390 calculation. The default value is:
21391 .code
21392 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21393 .endd
21394 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21395 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21396 &_Trash_&
21397 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21398 .code
21399 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21400 .endd
21401 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21402 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21403 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21404 directly into that directory.
21405
21406
21407 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21408 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21409 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21410
21411
21412 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21413 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21414 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21415
21416
21417 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21418 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21419 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21420 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21421 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21422 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21423 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21424 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21425
21426 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21427 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21428 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21429 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21430 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21431 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21432 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21433 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21434 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21435 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21436
21437
21438 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21439 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21440 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21441 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21442 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21443 below for further details.
21444
21445
21446 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21447 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21448 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21449
21450
21451 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21452 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21453 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21454
21455
21456 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21457 .cindex "locking files"
21458 .cindex "file" "locking"
21459 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21460 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21461 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21462 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21463 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21464 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21465 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21466
21467 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21468 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21469 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21470 combination:
21471 .code
21472 mbx_format = true
21473 message_prefix =
21474 message_suffix =
21475 .endd
21476 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21477 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21478 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21479 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21480 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21481 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21482 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21483 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21484
21485 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21486 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21487 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21488 append messages to it.
21489
21490
21491 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21492 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21493 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21494 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21495 in which case it is:
21496 .code
21497 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21498 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21499 .endd
21500 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21501 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21502
21503 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21504 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21505 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21506 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21507 setting
21508 .code
21509 message_suffix =
21510 .endd
21511 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21512 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21513
21514 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21515 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21516 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21517 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21518 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21519 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21520 value, and this option is ignored.
21521
21522
21523 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21524 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21525 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21526 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21527 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21528
21529
21530 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21531 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21532 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21533 on users about incoming mail.
21534
21535
21536 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21537 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21538 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21539 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21540 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21541 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21542 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21543 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21544 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21545
21546 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21547 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21548 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21549
21550 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21551 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21552 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21553 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21554 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21555 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21556
21557 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21558 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21559 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21560 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21561 be handled.
21562
21563 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21564
21565 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21566 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21567 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21568 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21569 system quota failures.
21570
21571 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21572 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21573 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21574 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21575 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21576 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21577 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21578 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21579 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21580 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21581
21582
21583 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21584 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21585 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21586 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21587 delivery directory.
21588
21589
21590 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21591 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21592 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21593 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21594 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21595 &"no quota"&.
21596
21597
21598 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21599 See &%quota%& above.
21600
21601
21602 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21603 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21604 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21605 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21606 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21607 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21608 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21609
21610 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21611 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21612 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21613 the file length to the file name. For example:
21614 .code
21615 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21616 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21617 .endd
21618 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21619 number of lines in the message.
21620
21621 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21622 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21623 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21624
21625 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21626
21627
21628 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21629 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21630 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21631 .code
21632 quota_warn_message = "\
21633 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21634 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21635 This message is automatically created \
21636 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21637 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21638 a warning threshold that is\n\
21639 set by the system administrator.\n"
21640 .endd
21641
21642
21643 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21644 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21645 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21646 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21647 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21648 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21649 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21650 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21651 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21652 sign. For example:
21653 .code
21654 quota = 10M
21655 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21656 .endd
21657 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21658 percent sign is ignored.
21659
21660 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21661 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21662 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21663 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21664 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21665 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21666 .code
21667 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21668 .endd
21669 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21670 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21671 option.
21672
21673 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21674 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21675 percentage.
21676
21677
21678 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21679 .cindex "envelope sender"
21680 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21681 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21682 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21683 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21684 for details of batch SMTP.
21685
21686
21687 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21688 .cindex "carriage return"
21689 .cindex "linefeed"
21690 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21691 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21692 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21693 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21694
21695 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21696 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21697 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21698 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21699 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21700 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21701
21702
21703 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21704 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21705 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21706 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21707 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21708 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21709
21710
21711 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21712 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21713 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21714 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21715 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21716
21717 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21718 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21719 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21720 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21721
21722 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21723 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21724 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21725 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21726 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21727 error.
21728
21729 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21730 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21731
21732
21733 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21734 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21735 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21736 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21737 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21738 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21739 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21740
21741 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21742 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21743 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21744 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21745 file corruption.
21746
21747 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21748 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21749 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21750
21751
21752 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21753 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21754 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21755 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21756 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21757 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21758 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21759 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21760 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21761
21762 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21763 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21764 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21765 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21766
21767
21768
21769
21770 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21771 .cindex "appending to a file"
21772 .cindex "file" "appending"
21773 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21774
21775 .ilist
21776 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21777 return is given.
21778
21779 .next
21780 .cindex "directory creation"
21781 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21782 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21783 &%directory_mode%& option.
21784
21785 .next
21786 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21787 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21788 transport.
21789
21790 .next
21791 .cindex "file" "locking"
21792 .cindex "locking files"
21793 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21794 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21795 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21796
21797 .olist
21798 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21799 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21800 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21801 .next
21802 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21803 .next
21804 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21805 Unlink the hitching post name.
21806 .next
21807 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21808 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21809 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21810 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21811 .next
21812 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21813 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21814 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21815 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21816 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21817 it before trying again.
21818 .endlist olist
21819
21820 .next
21821 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21822 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21823 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21824
21825 .next
21826 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21827 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21828 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21829 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21830 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21831 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21832 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21833 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21834 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21835 checked.
21836
21837 .next
21838 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21839 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21840 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21841 delivery is deferred.
21842
21843 .next
21844 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21845 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21846 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21847 permissions.
21848
21849 .next
21850 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21851 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21852 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21853
21854 .next
21855 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21856 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21857 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21858
21859 .next
21860 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21861 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21862 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21863 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21864 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21865 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21866 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21867 that prevents link following.
21868
21869 .next
21870 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21871 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21872 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21873 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21874 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21875
21876 .next
21877 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21878
21879 .next
21880 .cindex "file" "locking"
21881 .cindex "locking files"
21882 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21883 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21884 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21885 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21886 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21887 .code
21888 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21889 .endd
21890 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21891 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21892 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21893
21894 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21895 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21896 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21897
21898 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21899 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21900 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21901 delivery is deferred.
21902
21903 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21904 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21905 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21906 immediately. It retries up to
21907 .code
21908 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21909 .endd
21910 times (rounded up).
21911 .endlist
21912
21913 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21914 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21915
21916
21917 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21918 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21919 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21920 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21921 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21922 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21923 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21924 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21925 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21926 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21927
21928 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21929 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21930 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21931 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21932 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21933 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21934 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21935
21936 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21937 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21938 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21939 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21940
21941
21942 .cindex "maildir format"
21943 .cindex "mailstore format"
21944 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21945 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21946 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21947 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21948 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21949
21950 .cindex "directory creation"
21951 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21952 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21953 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21954 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21955 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21956 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21957 deferred.
21958
21959
21960
21961 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21962 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21963 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21964 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21965 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21966 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21967 &_new_& subdirectory.
21968
21969 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21970 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21971 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21972 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21973 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21974 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21975 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21976
21977 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21978 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21979 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21980 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21981 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21982 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21983 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21984 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21985
21986 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21987 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21988 folders. Consider this example:
21989 .code
21990 maildir_format = true
21991 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21992 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21993 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21994 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21995 .endd
21996 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21997 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21998 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21999 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22000 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22001 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22002
22003 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22004 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22005 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22006 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22007 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22008
22009 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22010 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22011 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22012
22013 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22014 .cindex "maildir++"
22015 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22016 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22017 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22018 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22019 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22020 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22021 amount of space used.
22022
22023 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22024 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22025 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22026 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22027 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22028 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22029
22030
22031
22032
22033 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22034 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22035 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22036 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22037 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22038 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22039
22040
22041 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22042 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22043 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22044 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22045 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22046 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22047 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22048 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22049 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22050 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22051 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22052 backwards compatibility).
22053
22054 For one common implementation, you might set:
22055 .code
22056 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22057 .endd
22058 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22059
22060 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22061 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22062 &[stat()]& each message file.
22063
22064
22065 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22066 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22067 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22068 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22069 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22070 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22071 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22072 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22073 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22074
22075 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22076 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22077 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22078 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22079 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22080 need to know the quota.
22081
22082 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22083 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22084
22085 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22086 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22087 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22088 details.
22089
22090
22091 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22092 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22093 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22094 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22095 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22096 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22097 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22098 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22099
22100 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22101 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22102 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22103 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22104 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22105 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22106
22107 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22108 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22109 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22110 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22111 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22112 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22113
22114 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22115 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22116 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22117 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22118
22119
22120 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22121 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22122 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22123 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22124 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22125 .code
22126 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22127 .endd
22128 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22129 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22130 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22131 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22132 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22133
22134
22135
22136
22137
22138
22139 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22140 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22141
22142 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22143 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22144 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22145 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22146 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22147 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22148 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22149 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22150
22151 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22152 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22153 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22154 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22155 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22156
22157
22158 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22159 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22160 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22161 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22162 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22163
22164 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22165 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22166 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22167 transport is run as a consequence of a
22168 &%mail%&
22169 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22170 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22171 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22172 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22173 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22174 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22175
22176 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22177 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22178 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22179 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22180
22181 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22182 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22183 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22184 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22185 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22186 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22187 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22188
22189 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22190 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22191 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22192 the transport defers.
22193 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22194 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22195
22196 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22197 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22198 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22199 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22200
22201 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22202 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22203 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22204 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22205 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22206 problems. They are just discarded.
22207
22208
22209
22210 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22211 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22212
22213 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22214 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22215 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22216
22217
22218 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22219 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22220 when the message is specified by the transport.
22221
22222
22223 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22224 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22225 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22226 string comes first.
22227
22228
22229 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22230 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22231 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22232
22233
22234 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22235 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22236 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22237
22238
22239 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22240 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22241 specified by the transport.
22242
22243
22244 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22245 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22246 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22247 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22248
22249
22250 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22251 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22252 the message is specified by the transport.
22253
22254
22255 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22256 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22257 used.
22258
22259
22260 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22261 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22262 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22263 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22264 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22265
22266
22267
22268 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22269 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22270 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22271 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22272
22273 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22274 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22275 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22276 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22277 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22278 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22279 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22280 infinity.
22281
22282 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22283 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22284 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22285 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22286 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22287
22288 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22289 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22290 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22291 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22292 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22293 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22294
22295
22296 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22297 See &%once%& above.
22298
22299
22300 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22301 See &%once%& above.
22302 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22303
22304
22305 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22306 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22307 specified by the transport.
22308
22309
22310 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22311 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22312 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22313 configuration option.
22314
22315
22316 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22317 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22318 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22319 automatic responses. For example:
22320 .code
22321 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22322 .endd
22323 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22324 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22325 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22326 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22327 small.
22328
22329
22330
22331 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22332 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22333 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22334 the text comes first.
22335
22336
22337 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22338 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22339 when the message is specified by the transport.
22340 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22341 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22342
22343
22344
22345
22346 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22347 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22348
22349 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22350 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22351 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22352 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22353 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22354 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22355 specified command
22356 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22357 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22358 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22359 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22360 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22361 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22362 .code
22363 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22364 .endd
22365 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22366 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22367 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22368 as follows:
22369
22370 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22371 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22372
22373
22374 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22375 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22376 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22377 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22378 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22379
22380
22381 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22382 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22383 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22384 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22385 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22386 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22387 LMTP protocol.
22388
22389 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22390 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22391 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22392 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22393 in its response to the LHLO command.
22394
22395 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22396 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22397 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22398 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22399
22400
22401 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22402 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22403 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22404 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22405 LMTP transport:
22406 .code
22407 lmtp:
22408 driver = lmtp
22409 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22410 batch_max = 20
22411 user = exim
22412 .endd
22413 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22414 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22415
22416
22417
22418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22420
22421 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22422 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22423 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22424 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22425 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22426 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22427 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22428 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22429 following ways:
22430
22431 .ilist
22432 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22433 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22434 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22435 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22436 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22437 .next
22438 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22439 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22440 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22441 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22442 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22443 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22444 that are routed to the transport.
22445 .next
22446 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22447 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22448 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22449 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22450 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22451 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22452 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22453 .endlist
22454
22455
22456 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22457 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22458 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22459
22460 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22461 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22462 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22463 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22464 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22465 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22466 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22467
22468
22469 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22470 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22471 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22472 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22473 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22474 .new
22475 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
22476 of "1" to enforce serialization.
22477 .wen
22478
22479
22480
22481
22482 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22483 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22484 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22485 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22486 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22487 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22488 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22489 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22490 &"local delivery failed"&.
22491
22492 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22493 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22494 will be sent as normal.
22495
22496 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22497 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22498 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22499 apply in this case.
22500
22501 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22502 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22503 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22504 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22505
22506 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22507 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22508 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22509 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22510 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22511 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22512 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22513 &%temp_errors%&.
22514
22515
22516
22517 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22518 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22519 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22520 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22521 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22522 run.
22523
22524 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22525 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22526 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22527 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22528
22529 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22530 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22531 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22532 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22533 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22534 .code
22535 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22536 .endd
22537 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22538 arguments. You have to write
22539 .code
22540 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22541 .endd
22542 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22543 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22544 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22545 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22546 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22547 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22548 example:
22549 .code
22550 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22551 .endd
22552
22553 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22554 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22555 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22556 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22557 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22558 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22559 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22560 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22561 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22562 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22563
22564 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22565 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22566 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22567 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22568 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22569 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22570 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22571 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22572
22573 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22574 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22575 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22576 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22577 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22578 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22579 control what is done with it.
22580
22581 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22582 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22583 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22584 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22585 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22586 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22587 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22588 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22589 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22590 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22591 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22592
22593
22594
22595 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22596 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22597 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22598 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22599 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22600 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22601 environment.
22602 .display
22603 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22604 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22605 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22606 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22607 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22608 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22609 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22610 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22611 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22612 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22613 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22614 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22615 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22616 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22617 &`USER `& see below
22618 .endd
22619 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22620 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22621 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22622 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22623 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22624 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22625 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22626
22627 .cindex "HOST"
22628 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22629 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22630 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22631 the router.
22632
22633 .cindex "HOME"
22634 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22635 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22636 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22637 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22638
22639
22640 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22641 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22642
22643
22644
22645 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22646 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22647 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22648 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22649 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22650 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22651 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22652 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22653 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22654 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22655 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22656 example, if
22657 .code
22658 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22659 .endd
22660 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22661 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22662 &%use_shell%& is set.
22663
22664
22665 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22666 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22667
22668
22669 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22670 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22671 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22672
22673
22674 .option check_string pipe string unset
22675 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22676 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22677 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22678 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22679 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22680 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22681 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22682 ignored.
22683
22684
22685 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22686 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22687 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22688 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22689 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22690 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22691 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22692
22693
22694 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22695 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22696 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22697 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22698 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22699 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22700 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22701
22702
22703 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22704 See &%check_string%& above.
22705
22706
22707 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22708 .cindex "exec failure"
22709 .cindex "failure of exec"
22710 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22711 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22712 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22713 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22714 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22715
22716
22717 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22718 .cindex "signal exit"
22719 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22720 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22721 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22722 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22723
22724
22725 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22726 .cindex "force command"
22727 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22728 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22729 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22730 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22731 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22732 command. For example:
22733 .code
22734 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22735 force_command
22736 .endd
22737
22738 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22739 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22740 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22741
22742
22743 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22744 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22745 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22746 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22747 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22748 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22749
22750 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22751 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22752
22753
22754 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22755 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22756 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22757 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22758 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
22759 written to the main log.
22760
22761
22762 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22763 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
22764 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
22765 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
22766 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
22767 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
22768 be set.
22769
22770
22771 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22772 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
22773 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
22774 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
22775 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22776
22777
22778 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22779 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22780 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22781 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22782 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22783 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22784 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22785 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22786
22787
22788 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22789 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22790 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22791 .code
22792 message_prefix = \
22793 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22794 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22795 .endd
22796 .cindex "Cyrus"
22797 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22798 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22799 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22800 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22801 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22802 setting
22803 .code
22804 message_prefix =
22805 .endd
22806 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22807 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22808
22809
22810 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22811 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22812 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22813 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22814 .code
22815 message_suffix =
22816 .endd
22817 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22818 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22819
22820
22821 .option path pipe string "see below"
22822 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22823 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22824 .code
22825 /bin:/usr/bin
22826 .endd
22827 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22828 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22829 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22830
22831
22832 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22833 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22834 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22835 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22836 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22837 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22838 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22839 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22840 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22841
22842
22843 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22844 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22845 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22846 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22847 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22848 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22849 accept the message is used.
22850
22851
22852 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22853 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22854 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22855 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22856 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22857 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22858
22859
22860 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22861 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22862 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22863 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22864 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22865 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22866 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22867
22868
22869
22870 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22871 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22872 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22873 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22874 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22875 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22876 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22877 of them may be set.
22878
22879
22880
22881 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22882 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22883 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22884 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22885 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22886 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22887 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22888 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22889 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22890 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22891 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22892 and 73, respectively.
22893
22894
22895 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22896 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22897 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22898 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22899 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22900 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22901 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22902
22903 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22904 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22905 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22906 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22907 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22908 delivery to be deferred.
22909
22910 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22911 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22912
22913
22914 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22915 .cindex "envelope sender"
22916 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22917 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22918 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22919 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22920 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22921
22922 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22923 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22924 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22925 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22926 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22927 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22928 class database.
22929
22930
22931 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22932 .cindex "carriage return"
22933 .cindex "linefeed"
22934 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22935 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22936 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22937 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22938
22939 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22940 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22941 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22942 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22943 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22944
22945
22946 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22947 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22948 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22949 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22950 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22951 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22952 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22953 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22954 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22955 its &%-c%& option.
22956
22957
22958
22959 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22960 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22961 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22962 .cindex "external local delivery"
22963 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22964 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22965 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22966 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22967 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22968 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22969 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22970 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22971 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22972 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22973 .code
22974 # transport
22975 procmail_pipe:
22976 driver = pipe
22977 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22978 return_path_add
22979 delivery_date_add
22980 envelope_to_add
22981 check_string = "From "
22982 escape_string = ">From "
22983 umask = 077
22984 user = $local_part
22985 group = mail
22986
22987 # router
22988 procmail:
22989 driver = accept
22990 check_local_user
22991 transport = procmail_pipe
22992 .endd
22993 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22994 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22995 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22996 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22997 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22998 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22999
23000 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23001 .code
23002 IFS=" "
23003 .endd
23004 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23005 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23006
23007 .cindex "Cyrus"
23008 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23009 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23010 .code
23011 # transport
23012 local_delivery_cyrus:
23013 driver = pipe
23014 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23015 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23016 user = cyrus
23017 group = mail
23018 return_output
23019 log_output
23020 message_prefix =
23021 message_suffix =
23022
23023 # router
23024 local_user_cyrus:
23025 driver = accept
23026 check_local_user
23027 local_part_suffix = .*
23028 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23029 .endd
23030 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23031 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23032 sender.
23033 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23034 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23035
23036
23037 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23038 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23039
23040 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23041 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23042 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23043 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23044 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23045 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23046 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23047 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23048
23049
23050 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23051 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23052 two ways:
23053
23054 .ilist
23055 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23056 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23057 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23058 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23059 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23060 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23061 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23062 .next
23063 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23064 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23065 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23066 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23067 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23068 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23069 process.
23070 .endlist
23071
23072
23073 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23074 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23075 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23076
23077
23078
23079 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23080 .vindex "&$host$&"
23081 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23082 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23083 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23084 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23085 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23086 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23087 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23088 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23089
23090
23091 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23092 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23093 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23094 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23095 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23096 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23097 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23098 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23099 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23100 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23101 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23102 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23103 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23104 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23105
23106 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23107 and will be removed in a future release.
23108
23109
23110 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23111 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23112 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23113
23114
23115 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23116 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23117 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23118 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23119 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23120 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23121 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23122 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23123
23124 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23125 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23126 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23127 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23128 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23129 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23130 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23131 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23132 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23133
23134
23135 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23136 .cindex "Cyrus"
23137 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23138 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23139 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23140 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23141 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23142 ignored.
23143
23144 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23145 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23146 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23147 particular connection.
23148
23149 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23150 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23151 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23152 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23153
23154 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23155 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23156 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23157 .code
23158 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23159 .endd
23160 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23161 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23162
23163 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23164 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23165 value.
23166
23167
23168 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23169 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23170 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23171 authenticated as a client.
23172
23173
23174 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23175 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23176 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23177 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23178
23179
23180 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23181 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23182 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23183 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23184 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23185 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23186 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23187
23188
23189 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23190 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23191 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23192 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23193 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23194 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23195 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23196 option.
23197
23198
23199 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23200 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23201 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23202 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23203
23204
23205 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23206 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23207 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23208 cutoff times.
23209
23210 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23211 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23212 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23213 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23214 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23215 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23216
23217 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23218 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23219 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23220 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23221 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23222 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23223 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23224 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23225 to them.
23226
23227
23228 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23229 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23230 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23231 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23232 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23233
23234
23235 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23236 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23237 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23238 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23239 details.
23240
23241
23242 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23243 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23244 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23245 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23246 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23247 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23248 the dnssec request bit set.
23249 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23250
23251
23252
23253 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23254 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23255 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23256 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23257 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23258 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23259 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23260 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23261 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23262
23263
23264
23265 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23266 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23267 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23268 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23269 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23270 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23271 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23272
23273 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23274 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23275 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23276 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23277 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23278
23279
23280 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23281 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23282 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23283 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23284 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23285 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23286 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23287 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23288
23289 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23290 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23291 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23292 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23293 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23294 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23295
23296 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23297 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23298 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23299 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23300 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23301
23302 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23303 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23304 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23305 copy of the message is sent.
23306
23307 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23308 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23309 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23310 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23311 fails"& facility.
23312
23313
23314 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23315 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23316 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23317 zero.
23318
23319 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23320 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23321 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23322 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23323 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23324 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23325
23326 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23327 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23328 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23329 implementations of TLS.
23330
23331 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23332 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23333 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23334 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23335 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23336 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23337 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23338 option is:
23339 .code
23340 $primary_hostname
23341 .endd
23342 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23343 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23344 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23345 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23346 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23347 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23348 interface address, you could use this:
23349 .code
23350 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23351 {$primary_hostname}}
23352 .endd
23353 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23354 callouts.
23355
23356 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23357 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23358 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23359 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23360 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23361 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23362
23363 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23364 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23365 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23366 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23367
23368 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23369 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23370 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23371 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23372 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23373 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23374 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23375
23376 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23377 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23378 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23379 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23380 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23381 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23382 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23383 address are used.
23384
23385 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23386 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23387
23388
23389 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23390 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23391 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23392 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23393 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23394 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23395 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23396 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23397 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23398 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23399
23400
23401 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23402 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23403 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23404 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23405
23406
23407 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23408 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23409 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23410 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23411
23412 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23413 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23414 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23415 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23416 to any host that matches this list.
23417
23418
23419 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23420 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23421 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23422 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23423 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23424 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23425 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23426 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23427
23428
23429 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23430 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23431 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23432 why it exists.
23433
23434
23435
23436 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23437 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23438 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23439 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23440 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23441 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23442 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23443 explanation of when this might be needed.
23444
23445
23446 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23447 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23448 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23449 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23450 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23451
23452
23453 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23454 .cindex "randomized host list"
23455 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23456 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23457 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23458 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23459 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23460 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23461 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23462 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23463
23464 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23465 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23466 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23467 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23468 .code
23469 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23470 .endd
23471 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23472 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23473 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23474
23475 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23476 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23477 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23478 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23479 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23480 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23481 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23482 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23483 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23484
23485
23486 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23487 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23488 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23489 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23490 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23491
23492 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23493 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23494 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23495 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23496 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23497
23498 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23499 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23500 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23501 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23502 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23503 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23504
23505 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23506 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23507 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23508 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23509 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23510 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23511 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23512
23513 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23514 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23515 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23516 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23517 for multi-recipient messages.
23518 The option can usually be left as default.
23519
23520 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23521 .cindex "bind IP address"
23522 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23523 .vindex "&$host$&"
23524 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23525 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23526 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23527 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23528 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23529 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23530 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23531 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23532 unknown.
23533
23534 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23535 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23536 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23537 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23538 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23539 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23540 .code
23541 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23542 .endd
23543 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23544 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23545 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23546 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23547
23548
23549 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23550 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23551 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23552 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23553 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23554 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23555 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23556 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23557 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23558 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23559 unreachable hosts.
23560
23561
23562 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23563 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23564 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23565 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23566 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23567
23568 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23569 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23570 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23571 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23572 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23573 permits this.
23574
23575
23576 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23577 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23578 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23579 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23580 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23581 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23582 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23583 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23584
23585 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23586 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23587 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23588
23589 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23590 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23591 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23592 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23593 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23594 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23595 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23596 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23597
23598 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23599 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23600 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23601 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23602 is deferred.
23603
23604
23605
23606 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23607 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23608 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23609 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23610 .vindex "&$port$&"
23611 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23612 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23613 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23614 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23615 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23616
23617 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
23618 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23619 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23620 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23621
23622
23623 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23624 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23625 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23626 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23627 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23628 addresses is not affected.
23629
23630 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23631 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23632 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23633 Exim to use only the host name.
23634 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23635
23636
23637 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23638 .cindex "serializing connections"
23639 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23640 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23641 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23642 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23643 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23644 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23645 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23646
23647 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23648 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23649 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23650 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23651 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23652 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23653
23654 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23655 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23656 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23657 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23658 are used for ETRN serialization.
23659
23660 .new
23661 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
23662 .wen
23663
23664
23665 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23666 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23667 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23668 .cindex "size" "of message"
23669 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23670 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23671 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23672 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23673 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23674 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23675 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23676 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23677
23678 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23679 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23680
23681
23682 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23683 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23684 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23685 .vindex "&$host$&"
23686 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23687 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23688 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23689 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23690 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23691 details of TLS.
23692
23693 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23694 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23695 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23696 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23697 client.
23698
23699
23700 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23701 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23702 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23703 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23704 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23705
23706
23707 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23708 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23709 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23710 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23711 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23712 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23713 will fail.
23714
23715 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23716
23717
23718 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23719 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23720 .vindex "&$host$&"
23721 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23722 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23723 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23724 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23725 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23726 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23727 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23728 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23729
23730
23731 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23732 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23733 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23734 .vindex "&$host$&"
23735 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23736 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23737 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23738 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23739 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23740 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23741 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23742 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23743 ciphers is a preference order.
23744
23745
23746
23747 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23748 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23749 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23750 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23751 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23752 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23753 certificate and private key for the session.
23754
23755 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23756
23757 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23758 TLS extensions.
23759
23760
23761
23762
23763 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23764 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23765 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23766 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23767 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23768 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23769 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23770 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23771 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23772 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23773 in clear.
23774
23775
23776 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
23777 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23778 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23779 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23780 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23781 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23782 Note that unless the host is in this list
23783 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23784 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23785 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23786 certificate verification succeeds.
23787
23788
23789 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
23790 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
23791 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23792 This option give a list of hosts for which,
23793 while verifying the server certificate,
23794 checks will be included on the host name
23795 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
23796 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
23797 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
23798
23799 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
23800
23801
23802 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
23803 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23804 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23805 .vindex "&$host$&"
23806 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23807 The value of this option must be either the
23808 word "system"
23809 or the absolute path to
23810 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
23811 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23812
23813 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
23814 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
23815 is taken as empty and an explicit location
23816 must be specified.
23817
23818 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
23819 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
23820
23821 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
23822 explicitly
23823 either by file or directory
23824 are added to those given by the system default location.
23825
23826 The values of &$host$& and
23827 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23828 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23829
23830 For back-compatibility,
23831 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23832 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
23833 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23834
23835
23836 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23837 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23838 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23839 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23840 certificate verification must succeed.
23841 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23842 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23843 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23844
23845
23846
23847
23848 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23849 "SECTvalhosmax"
23850 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23851 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23852 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23853 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23854 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23855
23856
23857 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23858 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23859 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23860 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23861 retrying.
23862
23863 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23864 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23865 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23866
23867 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23868 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23869 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23870 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23871 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23872
23873 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23874 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23875 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23876 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23877 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23878 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23879 see below for an exception).
23880
23881 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23882 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23883 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23884 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23885 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23886
23887 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23888 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23889 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23890 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23891 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23892 reached their retry times.
23893
23894 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23895 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23896 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23897 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23898 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23899 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23900 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23901 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23902 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23903 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23904 reached.
23905
23906 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23907 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23908 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23909 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23910 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23911 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23912
23913 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23914 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23915 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23916 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23917 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23918 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23919
23920
23921
23922
23923
23924 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23925 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23926
23927 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23928 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23929 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23930 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23931 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23932 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23933
23934 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23935 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23936 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23937 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23938 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23939 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23940 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23941
23942 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23943 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23944 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23945 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23946
23947
23948 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23949 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23950 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23951 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23952
23953 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23954 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23955 facility; you do not have to use it.
23956
23957 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23958 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23959 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23960 address to which it applies.
23961
23962 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23963 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23964 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23965 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23966 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23967 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23968 rules.
23969
23970 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23971 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23972 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23973 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
23974
23975
23976 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
23977 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
23978 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
23979 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
23980 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
23981 discouraged.
23982
23983 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
23984 illustrated by these examples:
23985
23986 .ilist
23987 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
23988 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
23989 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
23990 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
23991 .next
23992 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
23993 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
23994 .endlist
23995
23996
23997
23998 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
23999 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24000 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24001 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24002 message's processing.
24003
24004 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24005 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24006 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24007 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24008 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24009 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24010 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24011 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24012 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24013
24014 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24015 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24016 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24017 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24018 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24019 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24020 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24021 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24022 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24023 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24024
24025 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24026 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24027 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24028 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24029 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24030 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24031
24032 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24033 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24034 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24035
24036 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24037 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24038 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24039 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24040 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24041 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24042 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24043 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24044 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24045
24046 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24047 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24048 transport time.
24049
24050
24051
24052
24053 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24054 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24055 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24056 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24057 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24058 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24059 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24060 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24061 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24062 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24063 .code
24064 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24065 .endd
24066 might produce the output
24067 .code
24068 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24069 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24070 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24071 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24072 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24073 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24074 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24075 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24076 .endd
24077 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24078 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24079 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24080 set for a particular transport.
24081
24082
24083 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24084 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24085 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24086 rules in the form
24087 .display
24088 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24089 .endd
24090 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24091 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24092 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24093 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24094
24095 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24096 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24097 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24098 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24099 ignored.
24100
24101 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24102 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24103 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24104
24105 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24106 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24107 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24108 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24109 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24110 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24111 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24112
24113 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24114 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24115 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24116 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24117 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24118 .code
24119 *@* ${lookup ...
24120 .endd
24121 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24122 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24123
24124
24125 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24126 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24127 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24128 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24129 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24130 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24131 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24132 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24133 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24134
24135 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24136 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24137 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24138
24139 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24140 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24141 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24142 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24143 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24144 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24145 of pattern they are set as follows:
24146
24147 .ilist
24148 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24149 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24150 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24151 pattern
24152 .code
24153 *queen@*.fict.example
24154 .endd
24155 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24156 .code
24157 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24158 $1 = hearts-
24159 $2 = wonderland
24160 .endd
24161 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24162 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24163
24164 .next
24165 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24166 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24167 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24168 rewriting rule of the form
24169 .display
24170 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24171 .endd
24172 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24173 .code
24174 $1 = foo
24175 $2 = bar
24176 $3 = baz.example
24177 .endd
24178 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24179 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24180 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24181 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24182 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24183 .endlist
24184
24185
24186 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24187 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24188 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24189 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24190 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24191 .code
24192 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24193 .endd
24194 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24195 &'From:'& headers.
24196
24197 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24198 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24199 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24200 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24201 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24202 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24203 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24204 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24205 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24206 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24207 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24208 entry written to the panic log.
24209
24210
24211
24212 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24213 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24214
24215 .ilist
24216 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24217 c, f, h, r, s, t.
24218 .next
24219 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24220 .next
24221 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24222 .endlist
24223
24224 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24225 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24226
24227
24228
24229 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24230 "SECID154"
24231 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24232 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24233 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24234 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24235 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24236 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24237 .display
24238 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24239 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24240 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24241 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24242 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24243 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24244 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24245 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24246 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24247 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24248 .endd
24249 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24250 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24251 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24252
24253 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24254 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24255
24256
24257 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24258 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24259 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24260 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24261 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24262 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24263 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24264 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24265 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24266
24267 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24268 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24269 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24270 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24271 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24272 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24273 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24274 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24275
24276
24277 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24278 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24279 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24280 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24281
24282 .ilist
24283 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24284 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24285 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24286 .next
24287 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24288 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24289 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24290 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24291 .next
24292 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24293 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24294 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24295 .next
24296 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24297 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24298 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24299 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24300 .code
24301 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24302 .endd
24303 into
24304 .code
24305 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24306 .endd
24307 .cindex "RFC 2047"
24308 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24309 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24310 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24311 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24312 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24313 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24314 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24315 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
24316
24317 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24318 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24319 .endlist
24320
24321
24322 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24323 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24324 .code
24325 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24326 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24327 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24328 .endd
24329 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24330 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24331 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24332 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24333 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24334 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24335 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24336 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24337
24338 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24339 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24340 .code
24341 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24342 .endd
24343 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24344 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24345
24346 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24347 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24348 messages that originate outside the local host:
24349 .code
24350 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24351 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24352 .endd
24353 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24354 space.
24355
24356 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24357 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24358 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24359 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24360 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24361 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24362 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24363 components. For example, the rule
24364 .code
24365 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24366 .endd
24367 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24368 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24369 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24370 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24371 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24372 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24373 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24374 .ecindex IIDaddrew
24375
24376
24377
24378
24379
24380 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24381 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24382
24383 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24384 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24385 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24386 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24387 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24388 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24389 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24390 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24391 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24392 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24393 address, domain and error.
24394
24395 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24396 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24397 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24398 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24399 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24400 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24401 log selector is set, the message
24402 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24403 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24404 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24405 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24406
24407 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24408 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24409 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24410 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24411 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24412 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24413 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24414 domain are maintained independently.
24415
24416 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24417 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24418 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24419 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24420 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24421 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24422 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24423 the local address is reached.
24424
24425 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24426 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24427 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24428 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24429 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24430
24431 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24432 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24433 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24434 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24435 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24436 messages that it should now be retaining.
24437
24438
24439
24440 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24441 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24442 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24443 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24444 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24445 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24446 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24447 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24448 message's sender, respectively.
24449
24450
24451 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24452 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24453 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24454 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24455 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24456 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24457 example,
24458 .code
24459 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24460 .endd
24461 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24462 whereas
24463 .code
24464 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24465 .endd
24466 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24467 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24468 part.
24469
24470 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24471 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24472 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24473 expressions work in address lists.
24474 .display
24475 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24476 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24477 .endd
24478
24479
24480 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24481 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24482 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24483 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24484 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24485 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24486 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24487 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24488 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24489
24490 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24491 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24492 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24493 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24494 local transports).
24495
24496 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24497 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24498 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24499 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24500 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24501 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24502 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24503 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24504 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24505 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24506 commands.
24507
24508
24509
24510 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24511 "SECID160"
24512 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24513 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24514 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24515 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24516 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24517 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24518 .code
24519 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24520 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24521 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24522 .endd
24523 and the retry rules are
24524 .code
24525 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24526 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24527 .endd
24528 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24529 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24530 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24531 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24532 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24533 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24534
24535 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24536 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24537 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24538 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24539
24540 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24541 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24542 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24543 .code
24544 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24545 .endd
24546 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24547 textual form of the IP address.
24548
24549 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24550 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24551 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24552 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24553
24554 .vlist
24555 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24556 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24557 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24558
24559 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24560 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24561 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24562
24563 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24564 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24565
24566 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24567 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24568 .endlist
24569
24570 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24571 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24572 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24573 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24574 retry rule of this form:
24575 .code
24576 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24577 .endd
24578 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24579 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24580
24581 .vlist
24582 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24583 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24584 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24585 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24586
24587 .vitem &%lookup%&
24588 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24589 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24590 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24591 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24592 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24593
24594 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24595 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24596
24597 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24598 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24599
24600 .vitem &%refused%&
24601 A connection was refused.
24602
24603 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24604 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24605
24606 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24607 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24608
24609 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24610 A connection attempt timed out.
24611
24612 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24613 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24614 obtained from an MX record.
24615
24616 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24617 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24618 obtained from an MX record.
24619
24620 .vitem &%timeout%&
24621 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24622
24623 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24624 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24625 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24626 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24627
24628 .vitem &%quota%&
24629 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24630 transport.
24631
24632 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24633 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24634 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24635 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24636 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24637 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24638 for four days.
24639 .endlist
24640
24641 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24642 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24643 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24644 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24645 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24646 heuristic rules:
24647
24648 .ilist
24649 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24650 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24651 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24652 .next
24653 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24654 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24655 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24656 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24657 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24658 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24659 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24660 .next
24661 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24662 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24663 .endlist
24664
24665 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24666 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24667 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24668 error).
24669
24670
24671
24672 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24673 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24674 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24675 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24676 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24677 form:
24678 .display
24679 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24680 .endd
24681 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24682 .code
24683 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24684 .endd
24685 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24686 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24687 For example:
24688 .code
24689 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24690 .endd
24691 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24692 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24693 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24694 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24695 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24696
24697 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24698 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24699 .code
24700 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24701 .endd
24702 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24703 list is never matched.
24704
24705
24706
24707
24708
24709 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24710 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24711 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24712 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24713 .display
24714 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24715 .endd
24716 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24717 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24718 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24719 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24720 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24721
24722 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24723 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24724 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24725 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24726 The available algorithms are:
24727
24728 .ilist
24729 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24730 the interval.
24731 .next
24732 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24733 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24734 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24735 .next
24736 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24737 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24738 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24739 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24740 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24741 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24742 queue processing times.
24743 .endlist
24744
24745 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24746 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24747 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24748 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24749 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24750 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24751 interval is found. The main configuration variable
24752 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24753 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24754 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24755 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24756 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24757
24758 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24759 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24760 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24761 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24762 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24763 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24764 time.
24765
24766 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24767 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24768 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24769 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24770 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24771 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24772 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24773 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24774 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24775 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24776 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24777 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24778
24779 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24780 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24781 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24782 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24783 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24784 deliveries that have been deferred.
24785
24786
24787 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24788 Here are some example retry rules:
24789 .code
24790 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24791 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24792 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24793 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24794 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24795 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24796 .endd
24797 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24798 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24799 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24800 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24801 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24802 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24803 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24804 days.
24805
24806 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24807 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24808 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24809 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24810 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24811
24812 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24813 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24814 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24815 were not obtained from an MX record.
24816
24817 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24818 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24819 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24820 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24821 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24822
24823
24824
24825 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24826 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24827 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24828 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24829 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24830 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24831 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24832 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24833 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24834 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24835 failing for the first time.
24836
24837 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24838 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24839 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24840 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24841
24842 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24843 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24844 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24845
24846
24847
24848
24849 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24850 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24851 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24852 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24853 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24854 default retry rule:
24855 .code
24856 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24857 .endd
24858 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24859 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24860 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24861
24862 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24863 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24864 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24865 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24866 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24867
24868 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24869 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24870 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24871
24872 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24873 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24874 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24875 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24876 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24877 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24878 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24879 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24880
24881 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24882 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24883 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24884 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24885 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24886 notice.
24887
24888 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24889 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24890 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24891 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24892 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24893 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24894 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24895 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24896 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24897 true.
24898
24899 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24900 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24901 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24902 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24903 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24904 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24905 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24906 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24907 reached.
24908
24909 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24910 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24911 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24912 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24913 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24914 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24915 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24916 time out the address.
24917
24918 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24919 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24920 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24921 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24922 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24923 considered immediately.
24924 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24925 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24926
24927
24928
24929
24930
24931
24932 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24933 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24934
24935 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24936 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24937 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24938 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24939 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24940 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24941 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24942 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24943 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24944 other.
24945
24946 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24947 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24948
24949 .ilist
24950 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24951 the client's EHLO command.
24952 .next
24953 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24954 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24955 .next
24956 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24957 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24958 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24959 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24960 with the AUTH command.
24961 .next
24962 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24963 .next
24964 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24965 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24966 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24967 connection.
24968 .next
24969 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24970 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24971 unauthenticated connection.
24972 .endlist
24973
24974 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
24975 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
24976 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
24977 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
24978 .display
24979 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
24980 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
24981 &`Connected to server.example.`&
24982 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
24983 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
24984 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
24985 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
24986 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
24987 &`250-PIPELINING`&
24988 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
24989 &`250 HELP`&
24990 .endd
24991 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
24992 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
24993 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
24994 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
24995 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
24996 included by setting
24997 .code
24998 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
24999 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25000 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25001 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25002 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25003 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25004 AUTH_SPA=yes
25005 AUTH_TLS=yes
25006 .endd
25007 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25008 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25009 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25010 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25011 work via a socket interface.
25012 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25013 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25014 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25015 supporting setting a server keytab.
25016 The sixth can be configured to support
25017 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25018 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25019 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25020 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25021 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25022
25023 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25024 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25025 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25026 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25027 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25028 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25029 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25030
25031 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25032 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25033 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25034 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25035 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25036 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25037 .code
25038 cram:
25039 driver = cram_md5
25040 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25041 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25042 client_name = ph10
25043 client_secret = secret2
25044 .endd
25045 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25046 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25047
25048 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25049 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25050 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25051 in Exim.
25052
25053 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25054 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25055 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25056 authenticating data.
25057
25058 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25059 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25060 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25061 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25062 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25063 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25064 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25065 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25066 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25067 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25068 choose to honour.
25069
25070 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25071 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25072 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25073 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25074
25075
25076
25077 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25078 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25079 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25080
25081 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25082 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25083 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25084 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25085 encrypted by a setting such as:
25086 .code
25087 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25088 .endd
25089
25090
25091 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25092 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25093 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25094 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25095
25096
25097 .option driver authenticators string unset
25098 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25099 authenticators is to be used.
25100
25101
25102 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25103 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25104 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25105 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25106 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25107 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25108
25109
25110 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25111 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25112 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25113 mechanism is not advertised.
25114 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25115 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25116 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25117
25118
25119 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25120 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25121 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25122 for details.
25123
25124 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25125 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25126
25127 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25128 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25129 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25130 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25131 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25132 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25133 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25134 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25135 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25136 the error text.
25137
25138
25139 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25140 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25141 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25142 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25143 out the values of variables.
25144 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25145 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25146
25147
25148 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25149 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25150 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25151 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25152 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25153 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25154 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25155 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25156 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25157
25158
25159 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25160 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25161 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25162 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25163 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25164 remembered for later use.
25165 How it is used is described in the following section.
25166
25167
25168
25169
25170
25171 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25172 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25173 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25174 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25175 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25176 message:
25177
25178 .ilist
25179 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25180 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25181 .next
25182 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25183 .next
25184 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25185 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25186 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25187 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25188 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25189 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25190 given for the MAIL command.
25191 .next
25192 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25193 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25194 authenticated.
25195 .next
25196 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25197 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25198 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25199 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25200 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25201 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25202 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25203 message.
25204 .endlist
25205
25206
25207 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25208 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25209 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25210 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25211
25212 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25213 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25214 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25215 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25216 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25217 ACL is run.
25218
25219
25220
25221 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25222 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25223 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25224 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25225 conditions:
25226
25227 .ilist
25228 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25229 .next
25230 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25231 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25232 .endlist
25233
25234 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25235 the mechanisms are advertised.
25236
25237 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25238 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25239 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25240 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25241 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25242 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25243 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25244 .code
25245 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25246 .endd
25247 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25248
25249 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25250 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25251 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25252 such as:
25253 .code
25254 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25255 .endd
25256 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25257 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25258 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25259
25260 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25261 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25262 command. This is the case if
25263
25264 .ilist
25265 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25266 .next
25267 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25268 .next
25269 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25270 server authenticators.
25271 .endlist
25272
25273
25274 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25275 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25276 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25277
25278 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25279 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25280 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25281 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25282 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25283 rejected with a 504 error.
25284
25285 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25286 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25287 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25288 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25289 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25290 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25291 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25292 no successful authentication.
25293
25294
25295
25296
25297 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25298 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25299 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25300 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25301 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25302 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25303 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25304 script:
25305 .code
25306 use MIME::Base64;
25307 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25308 .endd
25309 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25310 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25311 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25312 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25313 command line to run this script on such data might be
25314 .code
25315 encode '\0user\0password'
25316 .endd
25317 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25318 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25319 whose code value is zero.
25320
25321 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25322 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25323 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25324 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25325
25326 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25327 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25328 example, a command such as
25329 .code
25330 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25331 .endd
25332 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25333
25334 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25335 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25336 .code
25337 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25338 .endd
25339 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25340 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25341 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25342 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25343
25344
25345
25346 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25347 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25348 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25349 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25350 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25351 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25352
25353 .ilist
25354 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25355 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25356 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25357 of the authenticator.
25358 .next
25359 .vindex "&$host$&"
25360 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25361 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25362 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25363 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25364 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25365 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25366 delivery to be deferred.
25367 .next
25368 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25369 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25370 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25371 usual way.
25372 .next
25373 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25374 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25375 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25376 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25377 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25378 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25379 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25380 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25381 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25382 .endlist
25383
25384 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25385 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25386 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25387 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25388 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25389 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25390 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25391 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25392 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25393 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25394 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25395 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25396 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25397
25398
25399
25400
25401
25402
25403 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25404 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25405
25406 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25407 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25408 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25409 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25410 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25411 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25412 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25413 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25414 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25415 connections as you do for login accounts.
25416
25417 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25418 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25419 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25420
25421 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25422 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25423 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25424
25425 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25426 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25427 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25428 given.
25429
25430 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25431 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25432 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25433 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25434 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25435 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25436 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25437
25438 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25439 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25440 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25441 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25442 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25443 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25444 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25445
25446 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25447 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25448 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25449 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25450
25451 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25452 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25453 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25454
25455 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25456 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25457 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25458 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25459 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25460 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25461 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25462 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25463 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25464 string as the error text
25465
25466 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25467 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25468 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25469
25470
25471
25472 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25473 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25474 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25475 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25476 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25477 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25478 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25479 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25480
25481 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25482 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25483 configured as follows:
25484 .code
25485 fixed_plain:
25486 driver = plaintext
25487 public_name = PLAIN
25488 server_prompts = :
25489 server_condition = \
25490 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25491 server_set_id = $auth2
25492 .endd
25493 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25494 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25495 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25496 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25497
25498 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25499 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25500 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25501 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25502 .code
25503 250-AUTH PLAIN
25504 .endd
25505 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25506 .code
25507 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25508 .endd
25509 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25510 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25511 .code
25512 AUTH PLAIN
25513 .endd
25514 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25515 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25516
25517 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25518 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25519 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25520 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25521 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25522
25523 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25524 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25525 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25526
25527 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25528 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25529 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25530 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25531 This is an incorrect example:
25532 .code
25533 server_condition = \
25534 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25535 .endd
25536 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25537 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25538 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25539 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25540 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25541 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25542 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25543 .code
25544 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25545 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25546 .endd
25547 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25548 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25549 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25550 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25551 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25552
25553
25554 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25555 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25556 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25557 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25558 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25559 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25560 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25561 .code
25562 fixed_login:
25563 driver = plaintext
25564 public_name = LOGIN
25565 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25566 server_condition = \
25567 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25568 server_set_id = $auth1
25569 .endd
25570 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25571 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25572 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25573 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25574
25575 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25576 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25577 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25578 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25579 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25580 .code
25581 login:
25582 driver = plaintext
25583 public_name = LOGIN
25584 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25585 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25586 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25587 ldapauth{\
25588 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25589 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25590 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25591 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25592 .endd
25593 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25594 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25595 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25596 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25597 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25598 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25599 uninterpreted string.
25600
25601
25602 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25603 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25604 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25605 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25606 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25607 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25608
25609
25610
25611
25612 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25613 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25614 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25615
25616 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25617 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25618 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25619 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25620 usual.
25621
25622 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25623 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25624 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25625 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25626 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25627 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25628 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25629 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25630 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25631 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25632 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25633 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25634
25635 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25636 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25637
25638 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25639 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25640 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25641 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25642 the string.
25643
25644 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25645 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25646 .code
25647 fixed_plain:
25648 driver = plaintext
25649 public_name = PLAIN
25650 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25651 .endd
25652 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25653 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25654 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25655 .code
25656 fixed_login:
25657 driver = plaintext
25658 public_name = LOGIN
25659 client_send = : username : mysecret
25660 .endd
25661 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25662 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25663 prompts.
25664 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25665 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25666
25667
25668
25669
25670 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25672
25673 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25674 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25675 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25676 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25677 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25678 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25679 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25680 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25681 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25682 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25683 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25684 available in plain text at either end.
25685
25686
25687 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25688 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25689 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25690 authenticator as a server:
25691
25692 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25693 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25694 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25695 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25696 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25697 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25698 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25699 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25700 returned to the client.
25701
25702 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25703 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25704 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25705 numeric variables for other things.
25706
25707 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25708 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25709 user name, authentication fails.
25710 .code
25711 fixed_cram:
25712 driver = cram_md5
25713 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25714 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25715 server_set_id = $auth1
25716 .endd
25717 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25718 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25719 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25720 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25721 .code
25722 lookup_cram:
25723 driver = cram_md5
25724 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25725 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25726 {$value}fail}
25727 server_set_id = $auth1
25728 .endd
25729 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25730 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25731
25732 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25733 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25734 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25735 realm, with:
25736 .code
25737 cyrusless_crammd5:
25738 driver = cram_md5
25739 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25740 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25741 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25742 server_set_id = $auth1
25743 .endd
25744
25745 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25746 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25747 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25748
25749
25750
25751 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25752 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25753 computing the response to the server's challenge.
25754
25755
25756 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25757 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25758 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25759
25760
25761 .vindex "&$host$&"
25762 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25763 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25764 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25765 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25766 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25767 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25768 send the message to the current server.
25769
25770 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25771 strings, is:
25772 .code
25773 fixed_cram:
25774 driver = cram_md5
25775 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25776 client_name = ph10
25777 client_secret = secret
25778 .endd
25779 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
25780 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25781
25782
25783
25784 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25785 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25786
25787 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25788 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25789 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25790 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25791 .cindex "Kerberos"
25792 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25793 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25794
25795 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25796 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25797 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25798 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25799 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25800
25801 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25802 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25803 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25804 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25805
25806 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25807 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25808 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25809 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25810 depending on the driver you are using.
25811
25812 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25813 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25814 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25815 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25816 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25817 implementation.
25818
25819 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25820 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25821 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25822 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25823 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25824 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25825 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25826 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25827
25828
25829 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25830 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25831 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25832 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25833 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25834 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25835 things.
25836
25837
25838 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25839 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25840 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25841 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25842
25843
25844 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25845 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25846 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25847 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25848 example:
25849 .code
25850 sasl:
25851 driver = cyrus_sasl
25852 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25853 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25854 server_set_id = $auth1
25855 .endd
25856
25857 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25858 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25859
25860
25861 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25862 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25863
25864
25865 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25866 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25867 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25868 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25869 .code
25870 sasl_cram_md5:
25871 driver = cyrus_sasl
25872 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25873 server_set_id = $auth1
25874
25875 sasl_plain:
25876 driver = cyrus_sasl
25877 public_name = PLAIN
25878 server_set_id = $auth2
25879 .endd
25880 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25881 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25882 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25883 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25884 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25885
25886
25887
25888
25889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25891 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25892 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25893 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25894 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25895 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25896 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25897 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25898 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25899 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25900
25901 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25902
25903 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25904 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25905 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25906 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25907 .code
25908 dovecot_plain:
25909 driver = dovecot
25910 public_name = PLAIN
25911 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25912 server_set_id = $auth1
25913
25914 dovecot_ntlm:
25915 driver = dovecot
25916 public_name = NTLM
25917 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25918 server_set_id = $auth1
25919 .endd
25920 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25921 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25922 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25923 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25924 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25925 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25926 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25927 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25928
25929
25930 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25931 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25932 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25933 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25934 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25935 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25936 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25937 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25938 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25939 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25940 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25941 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25942 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25943 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25944 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25945 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25946 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25947 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25948 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25949 without code changes in Exim.
25950
25951
25952 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25953 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25954 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25955 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25956 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25957 context.
25958
25959 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25960 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25961 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25962
25963 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25964 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25965 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25966
25967 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25968 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25969 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25970
25971
25972 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
25973 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25974 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25975 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25976
25977
25978 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
25979 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25980 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25981 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25982 example:
25983 .code
25984 sasl:
25985 driver = gsasl
25986 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25987 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25988 server_set_id = $auth1
25989 .endd
25990
25991
25992 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
25993 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
25994 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
25995 the password itself.
25996
25997 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
25998 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
25999 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26000 if available, else the empty string.
26001 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26002 else the empty string.
26003
26004 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26005
26006 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26007 option to be simply "true".
26008
26009
26010 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26011 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26012 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26013
26014
26015 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26016 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26017 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26018 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26019
26020
26021 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26022 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26023 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26024 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26025
26026
26027 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26028 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26029 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26030
26031
26032 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26033 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26034 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26035 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26036
26037 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26038 meanings for these variables:
26039
26040 .ilist
26041 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26042 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26043 .next
26044 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26045 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26046 .next
26047 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26048 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26049 .endlist
26050
26051 On a per-mechanism basis:
26052
26053 .ilist
26054 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26055 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26056 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26057 .next
26058 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26059 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26060 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26061 .next
26062 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26063 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26064 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26065 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26066 .endlist
26067
26068 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26069 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26070 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26071
26072
26073 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26074 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26075 .code
26076 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26077 driver = gsasl
26078 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26079 server_realm = imap.example.org
26080 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26081 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26082 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26083 server_condition = yes
26084 .endd
26085
26086
26087 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26088 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26089
26090 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26091 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26092 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26093 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26094 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26095 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26096 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26097 reliably.
26098
26099 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26100 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26101 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26102 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26103
26104 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26105 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26106 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26107 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26108
26109 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26110 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26111 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26112 from the keytab.
26113
26114
26115 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26116 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26117 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26118 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26119
26120 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26121 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26122 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26123 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26124
26125 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26126 .ilist
26127 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26128 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26129 .next
26130 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26131 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26132 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26133 GSS Display Name.
26134 .endlist
26135
26136
26137 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26138 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26139
26140 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26141 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26142 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26143 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26144 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26145 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26146 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26147 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26148 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26149 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26150 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26151 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26152 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26153 follows:
26154
26155 .ilist
26156 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26157 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26158 .next
26159 The server sends back a challenge.
26160 .next
26161 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26162 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26163 .endlist
26164
26165 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26166
26167
26168
26169 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26170 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26171 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26172
26173 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26174 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26175 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26176 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26177 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26178 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26179 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26180 for other things. For example:
26181 .code
26182 spa:
26183 driver = spa
26184 public_name = NTLM
26185 server_password = \
26186 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26187 .endd
26188 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26189 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26190
26191
26192
26193
26194
26195 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26196 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26197 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26198
26199
26200
26201 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26202 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26203
26204
26205 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26206 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26207
26208
26209 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26210 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26211 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26212 &'msn.com'&:
26213 .code
26214 msn:
26215 driver = spa
26216 public_name = MSN
26217 client_username = msn/msn_username
26218 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26219 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26220 .endd
26221 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26222 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26223
26224
26225
26226
26227
26228 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26229 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26230
26231 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26232 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26233 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26234 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26235 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26236 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26237 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26238 authentication based on client certificates.
26239
26240 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26241 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26242 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26243 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26244 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26245 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26246
26247 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26248 for which it must have been requested via the
26249 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26250 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26251
26252 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26253 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26254 and can authenticate the connection.
26255 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26256
26257 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26258
26259
26260 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26261 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26262
26263 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26264 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26265 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26266 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26267 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26268 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26269
26270 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26271 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26272 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26273
26274 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26275
26276
26277 Example:
26278 .code
26279 tls:
26280 driver = tls
26281 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26282 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26283 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26284 {!= {0} \
26285 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26286 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26287 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26288 } } } }
26289 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26290 .endd
26291 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26292 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26293
26294
26295 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26296 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26297 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26298
26299
26300
26301 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26302 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26303
26304 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26305 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26306 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26307 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26308 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26309 .cindex "OpenSSL"
26310 .cindex "GnuTLS"
26311 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26312 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26313 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26314 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26315 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26316 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26317 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26318 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26319 certificates are used.
26320
26321 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26322 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26323 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26324 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26325 between them is encrypted.
26326
26327 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26328 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26329 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26330 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26331 encryption state.
26332
26333 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26334 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26335 in order to get TLS to work.
26336
26337
26338
26339 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26340 "SECID284"
26341 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26342 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26343 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26344 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26345 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26346 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26347 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26348 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26349 allocated for this purpose.
26350
26351 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26352 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26353 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26354 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26355 .code
26356 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26357 .endd
26358 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26359 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26360 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26361 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26362 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26363 defined elsewhere.
26364
26365 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26366 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26367
26368
26369
26370
26371
26372
26373 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26374 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26375 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26376 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26377 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26378 .code
26379 USE_GNUTLS=yes
26380 .endd
26381 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26382 .code
26383 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26384 .endd
26385 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26386 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26387
26388 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26389
26390 .ilist
26391 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26392 cannot be the path of a directory
26393 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26394 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26395 .next
26396 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26397 .next
26398 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26399 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26400 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26401 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26402 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26403 .next
26404 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26405 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26406 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26407 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26408 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26409 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26410 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26411 option).
26412 .next
26413 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26414 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26415 .next
26416 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26417 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26418 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26419 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26420 .next
26421 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26422 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26423 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26424 implementation, then patches are welcome.
26425 .endlist
26426
26427
26428 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26429 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26430 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26431 but not the chosen filename.
26432 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26433 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26434
26435 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26436 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26437 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26438 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26439 of bits requested.
26440 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26441 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26442 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26443 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26444 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26445 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26446 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26447
26448 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26449 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26450 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26451 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26452 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26453
26454 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26455 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26456 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26457 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26458 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26459 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26460
26461 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26462 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26463 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26464
26465 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26466 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26467 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26468 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26469 .code
26470 # ls
26471 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26472 # rm -f new-params
26473 # touch new-params
26474 # chown exim:exim new-params
26475 # chmod 0600 new-params
26476 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26477 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26478 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26479 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26480 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26481 # chmod 0400 new-params
26482 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26483 .endd
26484 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26485 stalling is removed.
26486
26487 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26488 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26489 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26490 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26491 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26492 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26493 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26494 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26495 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26496 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26497 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26498
26499 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26500 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26501 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26502 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26503
26504 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26505 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26506 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26507 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26508 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26509
26510
26511 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26512 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26513 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26514 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26515 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26516 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26517 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26518 directly to this function call.
26519 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26520 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26521 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26522 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26523
26524 .ilist
26525 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26526 .next
26527 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26528 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26529 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26530 SSL v3 algorithms.
26531 .next
26532 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26533 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26534 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26535 algorithms.
26536 .endlist
26537
26538 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26539 &`-`& or &`+`&.
26540 .ilist
26541 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26542 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26543 stated.
26544 .next
26545 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26546 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26547 .next
26548 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26549 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26550 .endlist
26551
26552 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26553 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26554 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26555 not be moved to the end of the list.
26556 .endlist
26557
26558 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26559 string:
26560 .code
26561 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26562 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26563 .endd
26564
26565 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26566 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26567 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26568 choice of clients used:
26569 .code
26570 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26571 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26572 {DEFAULT}\
26573 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26574 .endd
26575
26576
26577
26578 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26579 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26580 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26581 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26582 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26583 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26584 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26585 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26586 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26587 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26588 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26589 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26590
26591 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26592 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26593
26594 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26595 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26596 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26597 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26598 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26599 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26600
26601 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26602 "Priority strings". This is online as
26603 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26604 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26605 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26606 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26607 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26608
26609 For example:
26610 .code
26611 # Disable older versions of protocols
26612 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26613 .endd
26614
26615 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26616 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26617 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26618
26619 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26620 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26621 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26622 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26623 used:
26624 .code
26625 # GnuTLS variant
26626 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26627 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26628 {SECURE128}}
26629 .endd
26630
26631
26632 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26633 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26634 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26635 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26636 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26637 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26638 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26639 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26640
26641 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26642 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26643 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26644 with the error
26645 .code
26646 554 Security failure
26647 .endd
26648 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26649 rejected with a 554 error code.
26650
26651 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26652 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26653 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26654 without some further configuration at the server end.
26655
26656 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26657 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26658 .code
26659 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26660 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26661 .endd
26662 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26663 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26664 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26665 that goes with it. These files need to be
26666 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26667 always be given as full path names.
26668 The key must not be password-protected.
26669 They can be the same file if both the
26670 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26671 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26672 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26673 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26674 the server's certificate.
26675
26676 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26677 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26678 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26679
26680 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26681 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26682 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26683 transport.
26684
26685 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26686 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26687 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26688 .code
26689 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26690 .endd
26691 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26692 with the parameters contained in the file.
26693 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26694 available:
26695 .code
26696 tls_dhparam = none
26697 .endd
26698 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26699 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26700 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26701 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26702
26703 See the command
26704 .code
26705 openssl dhparam
26706 .endd
26707 for a way of generating file data.
26708
26709 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26710 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26711 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26712 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26713 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26714
26715 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26716 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26717 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26718 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26719 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26720 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26721 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26722 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26723 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26724
26725 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26726 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26727 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26728 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26729 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26730 documentation for more details.
26731
26732 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26733 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26734
26735
26736 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26737 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26738 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26739 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26740 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26741 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26742 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26743 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26744 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26745 expected certificates.
26746 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26747 an explicit file or,
26748 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
26749 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26750
26751 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26752 directory is used
26753 (OpenSSL only),
26754 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26755 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26756 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26757 .code
26758 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26759 .endd
26760 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26761
26762 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26763 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26764 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26765 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26766 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26767 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26768 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26769 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26770 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26771 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26772
26773 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26774 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26775 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26776 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26777
26778 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26779 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26780 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26781 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26782 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26783 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26784
26785
26786 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26787 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26788 .cindex "revocation list"
26789 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26790 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26791 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26792 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26793 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26794 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26795 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26796 CRL in PEM format.
26797 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26798 file from every certificate authority they know of.
26799
26800 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26801 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26802 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26803 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26804 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26805 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26806
26807 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26808 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26809 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26810 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26811
26812 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26813 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26814 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26815 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26816 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26817 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26818 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26819 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26820
26821 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26822 .new
26823 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
26824 .wen
26825 support for OCSP stapling is included.
26826
26827 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26828 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26829 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26830 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26831 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26832
26833 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26834 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26835 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26836 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26837 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26838 next connection.
26839
26840 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26841 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26842 ignored.
26843
26844 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26845 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26846 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26847 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26848 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26849 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26850
26851 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26852 not any of the chain from CA to it.
26853
26854 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26855
26856 .code
26857 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26858 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26859 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26860
26861 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26862 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26863 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26864 .endd
26865
26866
26867
26868
26869 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26870 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26871 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26872 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26873 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26874 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26875 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26876 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26877 within the &(smtp)& transport.
26878
26879 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26880 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26881 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26882 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26883 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26884
26885 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26886 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26887 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26888 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26889 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26890 usual way.
26891
26892 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26893 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26894 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26895 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26896 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26897 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26898 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26899 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26900 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26901 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26902 unencrypted.
26903
26904 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26905 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26906 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26907 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26908
26909 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26910 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
26911 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26912 a file or,
26913 depending on library version, a directory,
26914 must name a file or,
26915 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
26916 The client verifies the server's certificate
26917 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26918 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26919 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26920 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26921
26922 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26923 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26924 or need not succeed respectively.
26925
26926 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26927 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26928 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26929 value is empty.
26930 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26931 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26932 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26933 otherwise.
26934
26935 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26936 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26937 for OCSP to be relevant.
26938
26939 If
26940 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26941 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26942 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26943 alternative hosts, if any.
26944
26945 &*Note*&:
26946 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26947 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26948 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26949 client.
26950
26951 .vindex "&$host$&"
26952 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26953 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26954 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26955 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26956 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26957
26958 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26959 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26960 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26961 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26962 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26963 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26964 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26965 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
26966 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
26967 outgoing connection.
26968
26969
26970
26971 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
26972 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26973 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
26974 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
26975 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
26976 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
26977 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
26978 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
26979 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
26980 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
26981 for this session.
26982
26983 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
26984 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
26985 address.
26986
26987 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
26988 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
26989 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
26990 be of limited use in that environment.
26991
26992 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
26993 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
26994 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
26995 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
26996 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
26997
26998 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
26999 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27000 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27001 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27002 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27003
27004 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27005 received from a client.
27006 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27007
27008 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27009 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27010 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27011
27012 .ilist
27013 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27014 &%tls_certificate%&
27015 .next
27016 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27017 &%tls_crl%&
27018 .next
27019 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27020 &%tls_privatekey%&
27021 .next
27022 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27023 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27024 .next
27025 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27026 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27027 .endlist
27028
27029 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27030 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27031 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
27032 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27033
27034 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27035 are re-expanded.
27036
27037 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27038 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27039 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27040 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27041
27042 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27043 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27044 built, then you have SNI support).
27045
27046
27047
27048 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27049 "SECTmulmessam"
27050 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27051 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27052 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27053 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27054 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27055 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27056 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27057 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
27058 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27059 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27060 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27061
27062 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27063 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27064 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27065 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27066 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27067 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27068 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27069 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27070 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27071
27072 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27073 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27074 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27075 information is recorded.
27076
27077 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27078 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27079 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27080
27081
27082
27083
27084 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27085 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27086 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27087 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27088 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27089 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27090 to Apache, currently at
27091 .display
27092 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27093 .endd
27094 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27095 links to further files.
27096 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27097 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27098 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27099 .display
27100 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27101 .endd
27102
27103
27104 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27105 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27106 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27107 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27108 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27109 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27110 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27111 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27112 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27113 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27114 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27115 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27116 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27117
27118 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27119 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27120 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27121 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27122
27123
27124
27125 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27126 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27127 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27128 with OpenSSL, like this:
27129 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27130 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27131 .code
27132 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27133 -days 9999 -nodes
27134 .endd
27135 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27136 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27137 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27138 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27139 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27140 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27141 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27142
27143 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27144 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27145 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27146 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27147 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27148 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27149 . ==== -pdp, 2012
27150 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27151 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27152 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27153 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27154 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27155 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27156 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27157 be a sensible resolution).
27158
27159 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27160 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27161 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27162
27163 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27164 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27165 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27166 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27167 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27168 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27169
27170 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27171 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27172 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27173 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27174 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27175 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27176
27177
27178
27179 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27181
27182 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27183 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27184 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27185 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27186 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27187 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27188 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27189 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27190 one very small ACL:
27191 .code
27192 begin acl
27193 small_acl:
27194 accept hosts = one.host.only
27195 .endd
27196 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27197 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27198
27199 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27200 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27201 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27202 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27203 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27204 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27205 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27206 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27207
27208
27209 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27210 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27211 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27212 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
27213 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
27214
27215
27216
27217 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27218 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27219 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27220 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27221 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27222 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27223 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27224 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27225 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27226 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27227 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27228 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27229 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27230 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27231 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27232 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27233 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27234 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27235 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27236 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27237
27238 .table2 140pt
27239 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27240 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27241 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27242 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27243 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27244 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27245 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27246 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27247 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27248 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27249 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27250 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27251 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27252 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27253 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27254 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27255 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27256 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27257 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27258 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27259 .endtable
27260
27261 For example, if you set
27262 .code
27263 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27264 .endd
27265 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27266 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27267 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27268 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27269 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27270 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27271 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27272
27273
27274 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27275 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27276 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27277 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27278 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27279 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27280 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27281 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27282 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27283 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27284 in any of these ACLs.
27285
27286 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27287 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27288 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27289 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27290 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27291 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27292 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27293 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27294 .code
27295 control = suppress_local_fixups
27296 .endd
27297 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27298 run, it is too late.
27299
27300 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27301 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27302
27303 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27304 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27305 temporary error for these kinds of message.
27306
27307
27308 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27309 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27310 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27311 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27312 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27313 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27314 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27315 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27316 &%smtp_banner%& option.
27317
27318
27319 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27320 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27321 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27322 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27323 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27324 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27325 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27326 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27327 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27328
27329 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27330 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27331 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27332 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27333 an EHLO response.
27334
27335
27336 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27337 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27338 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27339 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27340 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27341 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27342 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27343 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27344 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27345 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27346
27347 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27348 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27349 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27350 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27351 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27352 associated with the DATA command.
27353
27354 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27355 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27356 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27357 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27358 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27359 your resources.
27360
27361 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27362 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27363 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27364 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27365
27366 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27367 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27368 enabled (which is the default).
27369
27370 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27371 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27372 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27373
27374 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27375
27376 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27377
27378
27379 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27380 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27381 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27382
27383 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27384
27385
27386 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27387 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27388 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27389 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27390 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27391 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27392 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27393 has been accepted.
27394
27395 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27396 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27397 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27398 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
27399 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27400 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27401 for some or all recipients.
27402
27403 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27404 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27405 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27406 .new
27407 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
27408 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
27409 is &"yes"&.
27410 .wen
27411 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27412 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27413 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
27414
27415 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27416 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27417
27418 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27419 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27420 the feature was not requested by the client.
27421
27422 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27423 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27424 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27425 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27426 does not in fact control any access.
27427 For this reason, it may only accept
27428 or warn as its final result.
27429
27430 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27431 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27432 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27433 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27434
27435 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27436 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27437
27438 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27439 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27440 response to QUIT.
27441
27442 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27443 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27444 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27445 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27446 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27447
27448
27449 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27450 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27451 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27452 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27453 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27454 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27455 situation even worse.
27456
27457 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27458 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27459 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27460 and &%warn%&.
27461
27462 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27463 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27464 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27465 connection. The possible values are:
27466 .table2
27467 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27468 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27469 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27470 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27471 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27472 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27473 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27474 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27475 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27476 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27477 .endtable
27478 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27479 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27480 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27481 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27482 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27483 used.
27484
27485
27486 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27487 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27488 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27489 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27490 .code
27491 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27492 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27493 .endd
27494 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27495 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27496 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27497 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27498 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27499
27500 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27501 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27502 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27503
27504 .ilist
27505 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27506 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27507 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27508 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27509 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27510 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27511 .code
27512 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27513 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27514 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27515 .endd
27516 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27517 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27518 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27519 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27520 .next
27521 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27522 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27523 matches the string.
27524 .next
27525 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27526 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27527 want to have something like
27528 .code
27529 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27530 .endd
27531 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27532 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27533 .endlist
27534
27535
27536
27537
27538 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27539 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27540 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27541 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27542 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27543 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27544 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27545 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27546 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27547
27548 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27549 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27550 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27551
27552
27553 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27554 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27555 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27556 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27557
27558 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27559 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27560 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27561 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27562 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27563 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27564 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27565
27566
27567 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27568 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27569 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27570
27571
27572
27573 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27574 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27575 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27576 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27577 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27578 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27579
27580 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27581 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27582 used to accept or reject anything.
27583
27584 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27585 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27586 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27587 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27588
27589 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27590 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27591 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27592 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27593 configuration file.
27594
27595
27596
27597
27598 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27599 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27600 .vindex &$domain$&
27601 .vindex &$local_part$&
27602 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27603 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27604 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27605 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27606 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27607 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27608 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27609 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27610 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27611
27612 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27613 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27614 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27615 how it is used.
27616
27617 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27618 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27619 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27620 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27621 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27622 received).
27623
27624 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27625 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27626 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27627 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27628 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27629 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27630 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27631 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27632
27633
27634
27635
27636
27637 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27638 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27639 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27640 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27641 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27642 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27643 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27644 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27645 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27646 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27647 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27648 unencrypted connections.
27649 .code
27650 acl_check_auth:
27651 accept encrypted = *
27652 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27653 {CRAM-MD5}}
27654 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27655 .endd
27656 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27657 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27658 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27659 option to do this.)
27660
27661
27662
27663 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27664 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27665 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27666 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27667 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27668 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27669 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27670
27671 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27672 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27673 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27674 example:
27675 .code
27676 deny dnslists = list1.example
27677 dnslists = list2.example
27678 .endd
27679 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27680 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27681 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27682 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27683 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27684
27685
27686 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27687 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27688
27689 .ilist
27690 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27691 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27692 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27693 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27694 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27695 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27696 check a RCPT command:
27697 .code
27698 accept domains = +local_domains
27699 endpass
27700 verify = recipient
27701 .endd
27702 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27703 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27704 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27705 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27706 &%endpass%&.
27707
27708 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27709 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27710 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27711 configuration.
27712
27713 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27714 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27715 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27716 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27717 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27718 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27719 .display
27720 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27721 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27722 .endd
27723 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27724 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27725 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27726
27727 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27728 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27729 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27730 of &%endpass%&.
27731
27732
27733 .next
27734 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27735 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27736 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27737 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27738 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27739 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27740 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27741
27742
27743 .next
27744 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27745 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27746 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27747 example,
27748 .code
27749 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27750 .endd
27751 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27752
27753
27754 .next
27755 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27756 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27757 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27758 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27759 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27760 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27761 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27762 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27763 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27764
27765 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27766 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27767 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27768
27769
27770 .next
27771 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27772 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27773 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27774 .code
27775 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27776 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27777 .endd
27778 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27779 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27780
27781 .next
27782 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27783 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27784 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27785 example, when checking a RCPT command,
27786 .code
27787 require message = Sender did not verify
27788 verify = sender
27789 .endd
27790 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27791 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27792 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27793 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27794
27795 .next
27796 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27797 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27798 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27799 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27800 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27801 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27802 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27803
27804 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27805 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27806 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27807 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27808 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27809
27810 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27811 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27812 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27813 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27814 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27815 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27816 onwards.
27817
27818
27819 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27820 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27821 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27822 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27823 .code
27824 warn !verify = sender
27825 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27826 .endd
27827 .endlist
27828
27829 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27830
27831 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27832 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27833 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27834 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27835 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27836
27837
27838
27839 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27840 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27841 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27842 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27843 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27844 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27845 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27846 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27847 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27848 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27849 .ilist
27850 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27851 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27852 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27853 on the same SMTP connection.
27854 .next
27855 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27856 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27857 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27858 .endlist
27859
27860 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27861 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27862 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27863 .code
27864 accept hosts = whatever
27865 set acl_m4 = some value
27866 accept authenticated = *
27867 set acl_c_auth = yes
27868 .endd
27869 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27870 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27871 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27872
27873 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27874 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27875 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27876 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27877 error is generated.
27878
27879 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27880 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27881
27882
27883 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27884 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27885 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27886 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27887 .code
27888 deny domains = *.dom.example
27889 !verify = recipient
27890 .endd
27891 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27892 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27893 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27894 two statements are equivalent:
27895 .code
27896 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27897 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27898 .endd
27899 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27900 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27901
27902 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27903 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27904 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27905 .code
27906 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27907 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27908 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27909 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27910 .endd
27911 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27912 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27913 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27914 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27915 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27916 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27917 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27918
27919 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27920 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27921 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27922 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27923 message is handled.
27924
27925 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27926 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27927 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27928 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27929 .code
27930 require message = Can't verify sender
27931 verify = sender
27932 message = Can't verify recipient
27933 verify = recipient
27934 message = This message cannot be used
27935 .endd
27936 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27937 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27938 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27939 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27940 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27941 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27942
27943 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27944 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27945 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27946 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27947 .code
27948 deny hosts = ...
27949 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27950 message = Invalid sender from client host
27951 .endd
27952 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27953 by which time Exim has set up the message.
27954
27955
27956
27957 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27958 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27959 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27960
27961 .vlist
27962 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27963 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
27964 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
27965 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27966
27967 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27968 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
27969 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
27970 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
27971 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
27972 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
27973 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
27974 write rather ugly lines like this:
27975 .display
27976 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
27977 .endd
27978 Instead, all you need is
27979 .display
27980 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
27981 .endd
27982
27983 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27984 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27985 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
27986 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
27987 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
27988 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
27989 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
27990 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
27991
27992 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
27993 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
27994 in several different ways. For example:
27995
27996 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
27997 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
27998 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
27999 . ==== way.
28000
28001 .ilist
28002 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28003 .code
28004 accept ...some conditions
28005 control = queue_only
28006 .endd
28007 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28008 other words, when the conditions are all true.
28009
28010 .next
28011 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28012 .code
28013 accept ...some conditions...
28014 control = queue_only
28015 ...some more conditions...
28016 .endd
28017 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28018 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28019 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28020 to be relevant.
28021
28022 .next
28023 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28024 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28025 example:
28026 .code
28027 warn ...some conditions...
28028 control = freeze
28029 accept ...
28030 .endd
28031 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28032 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28033 log entry.
28034
28035 .next
28036 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28037 &%require%& verb. For example:
28038 .code
28039 require control = no_multiline_responses
28040 .endd
28041 .endlist
28042
28043 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28044 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28045 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
28046 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28047 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28048 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28049 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28050 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28051 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28052
28053 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28054 example:
28055 .code
28056 deny ...some conditions...
28057 delay = 30s
28058 .endd
28059 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28060 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
28061 .code
28062 deny delay = 30s
28063 ...some conditions...
28064 .endd
28065 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28066 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28067 .code
28068 warn ...some conditions...
28069 delay = 2m
28070 control = freeze
28071 accept ...
28072 .endd
28073
28074 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28075 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28076 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28077 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28078 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28079 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28080 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28081
28082
28083 .vitem &*endpass*&
28084 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28085 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28086 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28087 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28088 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28089 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28090 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28091
28092
28093 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28094 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28095 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28096 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28097 .code
28098 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28099 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28100 .endd
28101 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28102 example:
28103 .display
28104 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28105 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28106 .endd
28107 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28108 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28109 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28110 message.
28111
28112 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28113 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28114 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28115 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28116 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28117 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28118 ignored.
28119
28120 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28121 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28122 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28123 error message.
28124
28125 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28126 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28127 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28128 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28129 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28130 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28131
28132 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28133 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28134 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28135 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28136 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28137 logging rejections.
28138
28139
28140 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28141 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28142 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28143 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28144 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28145 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28146 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28147 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28148 .display
28149 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28150 &` log_reject_target =`&
28151 .endd
28152 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28153 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28154 current ACL.
28155
28156
28157 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28158 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28159 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28160 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28161 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28162 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28163 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28164 ACLs. For example:
28165 .display
28166 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28167 &` control = freeze`&
28168 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28169 .endd
28170 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28171 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28172 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28173 example:
28174 .code
28175 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28176 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28177 .endd
28178
28179
28180 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28181 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28182 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28183 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28184 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28185 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28186 &%accept%& for details.)
28187
28188 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28189 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28190 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28191 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28192 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28193 .code
28194 require message = Host not recognized
28195 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28196 .endd
28197 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28198 processed.)
28199
28200 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28201 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28202 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28203 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28204 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28205 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28206 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28207 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28208 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28209 EHLO options.
28210
28211 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28212 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28213 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28214 .code
28215 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28216 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28217 .endd
28218 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28219 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28220 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28221 2&'xx'&.
28222
28223 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28224 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28225
28226 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28227 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28228 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28229 response.
28230
28231 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28232 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28233 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28234
28235 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28236 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28237 However, the original message is available in the variable
28238 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28239 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28240 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28241 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28242
28243 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28244 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28245 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28246 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28247 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28248 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28249 effect.
28250
28251
28252 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28253 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28254 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28255 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28256
28257
28258 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28259 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28260 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28261 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28262
28263
28264 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28265 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28266 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28267 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28268 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28269 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28270 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28271 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28272 when:
28273 .code
28274 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28275 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28276 .endd
28277 .endlist
28278
28279
28280
28281
28282 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28283 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28284 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28285
28286 .vlist
28287 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28288 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28289 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28290 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28291 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28292 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28293 not work without it. For example:
28294 .code
28295 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28296 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28297 .endd
28298 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28299 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28300 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28301 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28302 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28303
28304
28305 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28306 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28307 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28308 .cindex "case of local parts"
28309 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
28310 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28311 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28312 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28313 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28314 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28315 is encountered.
28316
28317 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28318 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28319 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28320 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28321 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28322
28323 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28324 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28325 spam score:
28326 .code
28327 warn control = caseful_local_part
28328 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28329 $acl_m4 + \
28330 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28331 }
28332 control = caselower_local_part
28333 .endd
28334 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28335 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28336
28337
28338 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28339 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28340 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28341 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28342
28343 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28344 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28345 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28346 is used for all recipients of the message,
28347 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28348 and data is copied from one to the other.
28349
28350 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28351 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28352 If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28353 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28354 any subsequent recipients and the data,
28355 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28356
28357 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28358 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28359 Note also that headers cannot be
28360 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28361 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28362
28363 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28364 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28365 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28366 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28367
28368 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28369 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28370 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28371 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28372 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28373 before the acceptance "<=" line.
28374
28375 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28376 (possibly faked)
28377 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28378
28379
28380 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28381 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28382 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28383 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28384 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28385 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28386 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28387 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28388 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28389 contexts):
28390 .code
28391 control = debug
28392 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28393 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28394 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28395 .endd
28396
28397
28398 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28399 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28400 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28401 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28402 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28403
28404
28405 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28406 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28407 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28408 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28409 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28410 strings or to numeric value.
28411 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28412 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28413 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28414
28415 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28416 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28417 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28418 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28419 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28420
28421
28422 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28423 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28424 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28425 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28426 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28427 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28428 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28429 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28430
28431 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28432 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28433 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28434 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28435 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28436 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28437 work with.
28438
28439
28440 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28441 .cindex "fake defer"
28442 .cindex "defer, fake"
28443 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28444 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28445 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28446 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28447 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28448
28449 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28450 .cindex "fake rejection"
28451 .cindex "rejection, fake"
28452 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28453 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28454 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28455 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28456 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28457 the same SMTP connection.
28458
28459 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28460 message is supplied, the following is used:
28461 .code
28462 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28463 550-kept for evaluation.
28464 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28465 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28466 .endd
28467 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28468
28469 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28470 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28471 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28472 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28473 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28474 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28475 SMTP connection.
28476
28477 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28478 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28479 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28480 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28481
28482 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28483 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28484 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28485 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28486 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28487 disables such output flushing.
28488
28489 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28490 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28491 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28492 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28493 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28494 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28495
28496 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28497 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28498 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28499 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28500 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28501 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28502 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28503 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28504 to be useful in production.
28505
28506 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28507 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28508 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28509 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28510 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28511
28512 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28513 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28514 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28515 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28516 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28517 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28518
28519 .ilist
28520 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28521 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28522 verification failed"&) is sent.
28523 .next
28524 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28525 line is output.
28526 .endlist
28527
28528 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28529 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28530
28531 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28532 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28533 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28534 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28535 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28536 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28537 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28538
28539 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28540 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28541 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28542 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28543 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28544 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28545 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28546 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28547 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28548 same SMTP connection.
28549
28550 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28551 .cindex "message" "submission"
28552 .cindex "submission mode"
28553 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28554 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28555 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28556 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28557 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28558 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28559 late (the message has already been created).
28560
28561 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28562 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28563 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28564 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28565 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28566
28567 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28568 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28569 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28570 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28571 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28572
28573 .ilist
28574 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28575 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28576 .next
28577 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28578 .next
28579 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28580 .endlist ilist
28581
28582 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28583 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28584 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28585 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28586 data is read.
28587
28588 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28589 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28590 .endlist vlist
28591
28592
28593 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28594 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28595
28596 .ilist
28597 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28598 .next
28599 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28600 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28601 .next
28602 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28603 .next
28604 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28605 .endlist
28606
28607
28608
28609 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28610 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28611 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28612 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28613 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28614 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28615 .code
28616 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28617 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28618 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28619 .endd
28620 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28621 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28622 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28623 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28624 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28625 RCPT ACL).
28626
28627 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28628 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28629
28630 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28631 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28632 contains one or more newlines that
28633 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28634 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28635 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28636
28637 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28638 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28639 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28640 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28641 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28642 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28643 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28644 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28645 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28646 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28647 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28648
28649 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28650 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28651 of message headers
28652 until they are added to the
28653 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28654 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28655 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28656 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28657 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28658 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28659 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28660
28661 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28662
28663 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28664 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28665 .display
28666 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28667 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28668
28669 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28670 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28671 .endd
28672 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28673 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28674 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28675 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28676 honoured.
28677
28678 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28679 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28680 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28681 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28682 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28683 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28684 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28685 specifications.
28686
28687 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28688 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28689 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28690 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28691 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28692
28693 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28694 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28695 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28696 to be a header name first.) For example:
28697 .code
28698 warn add_header = \
28699 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28700 .endd
28701 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28702 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28703 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28704 up in reverse order.
28705
28706 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28707 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28708 system filter or in a router or transport.
28709
28710
28711
28712 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28713 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28714 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28715 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28716 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28717 from an incoming message, as in this example:
28718 .code
28719 warn message = Remove internal headers
28720 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28721 .endd
28722 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28723 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28724 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28725 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28726 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28727 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28728
28729 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28730 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28731
28732 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28733 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28734 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28735 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28736 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28737 .code
28738 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28739 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28740 warn message = Remove internal headers
28741 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28742 .endd
28743 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28744 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28745 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28746 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28747 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28748 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28749 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28750 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28751 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28752 would have been removed.
28753
28754 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28755 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28756 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28757 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28758 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28759 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28760 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28761 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28762 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28763
28764 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28765 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28766 .display
28767 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28768 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28769
28770 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28771 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28772 .endd
28773 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28774 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28775 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28776 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28777 are honoured.
28778
28779 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28780 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28781 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28782
28783
28784
28785
28786 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28787 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28788 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28789 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28790 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28791 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28792
28793 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28794 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28795 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28796 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28797 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28798 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28799 The conditions are as follows:
28800
28801
28802 .vlist
28803 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28804 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28805 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28806 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28807 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28808 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28809 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28810 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28811 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28812 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28813 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28814 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28815
28816 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28817 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28818 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28819 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28820 The name and values are expanded separately.
28821 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28822 will act as argument separators.
28823
28824 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28825 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28826 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28827 conditions are tested.
28828
28829 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28830 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28831 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28832 for different local users or different local domains.
28833
28834 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28835 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28836 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28837 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28838 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28839 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28840 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28841 .code
28842 authenticated = *
28843 .endd
28844
28845 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28846 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28847 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28848 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28849 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28850 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28851 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28852 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28853 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28854 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28855 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28856 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28857 negative.
28858
28859 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28860 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28861 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28862 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28863 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28864 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28865 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28866 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28867
28868 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28869 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28870 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28871 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28872 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28873
28874 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28875 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28876 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28877 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28878 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28879 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28880 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28881 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28882 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28883 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28884
28885 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28886 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28887 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28888 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28889 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28890 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28891 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28892 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28893 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28894 &%domains%& test.
28895
28896 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28897 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28898
28899
28900 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28901 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28902 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28903 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28904 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28905 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28906 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28907 .code
28908 encrypted = *
28909 .endd
28910
28911
28912 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28913 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28914 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28915 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28916 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28917 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28918 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28919 .code
28920 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28921 .endd
28922 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28923 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28924 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28925
28926 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28927 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28928 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28929 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28930 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28931 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28932
28933 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28934 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28935 .code
28936 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28937 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28938 .endd
28939 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28940 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28941 statement can then check the IP address.
28942
28943 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
28944 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28945 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28946 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28947 .code
28948 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28949 message = $host_data
28950 .endd
28951 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28952
28953 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28954 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28955 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28956 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28957 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28958 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
28959 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
28960 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
28961 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
28962 the next &%local_parts%& test.
28963
28964 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
28965 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
28966 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
28967 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
28968 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28969 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
28970 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28971
28972 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28973 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
28974 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28975 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28976 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28977 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
28978 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
28979 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28980
28981 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
28982 .cindex "rate limiting"
28983 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
28984 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
28985
28986 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28987 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
28988 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
28989 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
28990 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
28991 recipient address against a list of recipients.
28992
28993 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28994 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
28995 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28996 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28997 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
28998 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
28999 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29000
29001 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29002 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29003 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29004 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29005 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29006 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29007 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29008 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29009 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29010 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29011 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29012 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29013 influence the sender checking.
29014
29015 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29016 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29017
29018 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29019 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29020 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29021 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29022 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29023 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29024 .code
29025 senders = :
29026 .endd
29027 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29028 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29029
29030 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29031 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29032 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29033 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29034 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29035 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29036
29037 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29038 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29039 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29040 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29041 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29042 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29043 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29044 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29045 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29046 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29047
29048 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29049 .cindex "CSA verification"
29050 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29051 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29052 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29053
29054 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29055 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29056 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29057 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29058 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29059 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29060 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29061 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29062 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29063 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29064
29065 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29066 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29067 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29068
29069 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29070 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29071 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29072 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29073 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29074 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29075 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29076 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29077 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29078 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29079 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29080 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29081 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29082 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29083 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29084
29085 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29086 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29087 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29088 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29089 .code
29090 deny senders = :
29091 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29092 !verify = header_sender
29093 .endd
29094
29095 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29096 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29097 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29098 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29099 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29100 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29101 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29102 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29103 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29104 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29105 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29106 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29107 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29108 appropriate.
29109
29110 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29111 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29112 .code
29113 To: @
29114 .endd
29115 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29116 common as they used to be.
29117
29118 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29119 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29120 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29121 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29122 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29123 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29124 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29125 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29126 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29127 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29128 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29129 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29130 independently of this condition.
29131
29132 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29133 option), this condition is always true.
29134
29135
29136 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29137 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29138 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29139 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29140 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29141 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29142 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29143 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29144 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29145
29146 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29147 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29148
29149
29150 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29151 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29152 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29153 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29154 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29155 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29156 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29157 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29158 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29159 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29160 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29161 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29162 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29163 value for the child address.
29164
29165 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29166 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29167 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29168 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29169 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29170 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29171 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29172 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29173 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29174 original IP address.
29175
29176 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29177 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29178
29179 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29180 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29181
29182 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29183 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29184 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29185 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29186 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29187 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29188 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29189 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29190 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29191
29192 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29193 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29194 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29195 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29196 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29197 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29198 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29199
29200 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29201 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29202 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29203
29204 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29205 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29206 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29207 verified as a sender.
29208 .endlist
29209
29210
29211
29212 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29213 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29214 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29215 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29216 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29217 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29218 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29219 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29220 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29221 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29222 .code
29223 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29224 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29225 .endd
29226 the following records are looked up:
29227 .code
29228 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29229 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29230 .endd
29231 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29232 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29233 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29234 use two separate conditions:
29235 .code
29236 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29237 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29238 .endd
29239 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29240 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29241 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29242 processed.
29243
29244 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29245 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29246 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29247 following special items in the list:
29248 .display
29249 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29250 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29251 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29252 .endd
29253 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29254 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29255 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29256 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29257 .code
29258 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29259 .endd
29260 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29261 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29262 .code
29263 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29264 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29265 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29266 .endd
29267 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
29268 .cindex DNS TTL
29269 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
29270 .new
29271 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
29272 .wen
29273 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29274 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
29275 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29276 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29277
29278
29279
29280 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29281 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29282 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29283 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29284 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29285 .code
29286 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29287 .endd
29288 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29289 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29290 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29291 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29292
29293
29294
29295
29296 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29297 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29298 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29299 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29300 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29301 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29302 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29303 .code
29304 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29305 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29306 .endd
29307 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29308 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29309 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29310 up by this example is
29311 .code
29312 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29313 .endd
29314 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29315 addresses. For example:
29316 .code
29317 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29318 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29319 .endd
29320 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29321 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29322
29323
29324
29325
29326 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29327 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29328 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29329 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29330 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29331 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29332 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29333 either to double the separators like this:
29334 .code
29335 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29336 .endd
29337 or to change the separator character, like this:
29338 .code
29339 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29340 .endd
29341 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29342 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29343 occurs. Consider this condition:
29344 .code
29345 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29346 .endd
29347 The DNS lookups that occur are:
29348 .code
29349 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29350 a.domain.black.list.tld
29351 .endd
29352 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29353 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29354 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29355 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29356 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29357 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29358 error for a previous item.
29359
29360 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29361 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29362 .code
29363 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29364 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29365 .endd
29366 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29367 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29368 .code
29369 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29370 $sender_address_domain \
29371 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29372 see $dnslist_text.
29373 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29374 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29375 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29376 .endd
29377 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29378 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29379 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29380 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29381 .code
29382 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29383 .endd
29384 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29385 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29386
29387 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29388 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29389
29390
29391
29392
29393 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29394 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29395 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29396 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29397 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29398 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29399 .display
29400 127.1.0.1 RBL
29401 127.1.0.2 DUL
29402 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29403 127.1.0.4 RSS
29404 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29405 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29406 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29407 .endd
29408 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29409 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29410 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29411
29412
29413 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29414 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29415 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29416 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29417 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29418 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29419 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29420 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29421 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29422 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29423 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29424 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29425 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29426 cases, for example:
29427 .code
29428 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29429 .endd
29430 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29431 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29432 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29433 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29434 .code
29435 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29436 .endd
29437 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29438 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29439
29440 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29441 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29442 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29443 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29444 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29445 information.
29446
29447 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29448 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29449 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29450 .code
29451 deny hosts = !+local_networks
29452 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29453 at $dnslist_domain
29454 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29455 .endd
29456
29457
29458
29459 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29460 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29461 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29462 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29463 For example,
29464 .code
29465 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29466 .endd
29467 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29468 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29469 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29470 describes how multiple records are handled.
29471
29472 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29473 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29474 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29475 .code
29476 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29477 .endd
29478 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29479 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29480 first. For example:
29481 .code
29482 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29483 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29484 .endd
29485
29486 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29487 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29488 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29489 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29490 tested. For example:
29491 .code
29492 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29493 .endd
29494 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29495 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29496 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29497 .code
29498 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29499 .endd
29500 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29501 an odd number.
29502
29503
29504
29505 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29506 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29507 condition. Whereas
29508 .code
29509 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29510 .endd
29511 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29512 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29513 .code
29514 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29515 .endd
29516 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29517 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29518 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29519 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29520
29521 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29522 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29523
29524 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29525 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29526 .code
29527 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29528 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29529 .endd
29530 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29531 Consider this example:
29532 .code
29533 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29534 list.dsbl.org : \
29535 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29536 relays.ordb.org
29537 .endd
29538 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29539 .code
29540 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29541 list.dsbl.org
29542 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29543 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29544 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29545 .endd
29546 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29547
29548
29549
29550
29551 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29552 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29553 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29554 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29555 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29556 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29557 .code
29558 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29559 .endd
29560 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29561 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29562 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29563 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29564 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29565 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29566
29567 .ilist
29568 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29569 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29570 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29571 .next
29572 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29573 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29574 changed to:
29575 .code
29576 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29577 .endd
29578 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29579 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29580 .code
29581 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29582 .endd
29583 for the condition to be true.
29584 .endlist
29585
29586 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29587 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29588 .ilist
29589 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29590 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29591 .code
29592 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29593 .endd
29594 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29595 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29596 .next
29597 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29598 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29599 .code
29600 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29601 .endd
29602 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29603 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29604 .code
29605 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29606 .endd
29607 for the condition to be false.
29608 .endlist
29609 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29610 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29611
29612
29613
29614
29615 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29616 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29617 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29618 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29619 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29620 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29621 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29622 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29623 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29624 lists.
29625
29626 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29627 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29628 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29629 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29630 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29631 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29632 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29633 .code
29634 reject message = \
29635 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29636 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29637 dnslists = \
29638 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29639 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29640 .endd
29641 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29642 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29643 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29644 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29645 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29646 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29647
29648 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29649 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29650 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29651 .code
29652 reject dnslists = \
29653 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29654 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29655 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29656 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29657 .endd
29658 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29659 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29660 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29661
29662
29663
29664 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29665 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29666 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29667 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29668 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29669 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29670 .code
29671 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29672 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29673 .endd
29674 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29675 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29676 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29677 .code
29678 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29679 .endd
29680 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29681 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29682
29683 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29684 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29685 .code
29686 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29687 dnslists = some.list.example
29688 .endd
29689
29690 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29691 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29692 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29693 .code
29694 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29695 .endd
29696
29697 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29698 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29699 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29700 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29701 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29702 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29703 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29704 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29705 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29706 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29707 .display
29708 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29709 .endd
29710 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29711 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29712
29713 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29714 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29715 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29716 of &'p'&.
29717
29718 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29719 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29720 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29721 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29722 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29723 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29724 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29725 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29726 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29727
29728 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29729 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29730 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29731 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29732
29733 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29734 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29735 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29736 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29737 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29738 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29739 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29740 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29741 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29742 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29743
29744 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29745 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29746 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29747 ACL.
29748
29749 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29750 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29751 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29752 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29753 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29754 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29755
29756 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29757 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29758 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29759 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29760 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29761 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29762 the &%count=%& option.
29763
29764
29765 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29766 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29767 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29768 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29769 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29770
29771 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29772 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29773 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29774 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29775
29776 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29777 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29778 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29779 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29780 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29781 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29782 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29783
29784 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29785 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29786 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29787 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29788 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
29789 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29790 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29791
29792 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29793 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29794 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29795 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29796 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
29797
29798 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29799 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29800 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29801 multiple different commands.
29802
29803 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29804 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29805 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29806 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29807 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29808
29809 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29810
29811
29812 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29813 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29814 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29815 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29816 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29817
29818 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29819 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29820
29821 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29822 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29823 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29824 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29825 new rate.
29826 .code
29827 acl_check_connect:
29828 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29829 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29830 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29831 # ...
29832 acl_check_mail:
29833 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29834 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29835 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29836 .endd
29837
29838 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29839 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29840 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29841 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29842 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29843 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29844 checks.
29845
29846 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29847 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29848 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29849 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29850 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29851
29852
29853 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29854 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29855 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29856 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29857 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29858 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29859 rest of the ACL.
29860
29861 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29862 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29863 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29864 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29865 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29866 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29867 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29868 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29869 from getting any email through.
29870
29871 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29872 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29873 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29874 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29875 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29876 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29877 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29878 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29879 .code
29880 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29881 .endd
29882
29883
29884 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29885 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29886 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29887 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29888 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29889 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29890 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29891 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29892 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29893
29894 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29895 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29896 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29897 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29898 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29899 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29900
29901 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29902 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29903 rate.
29904
29905 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29906 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29907 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29908 required increases with larger limits.
29909
29910 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29911 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29912 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29913 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29914 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29915 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29916 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29917 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29918 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29919 as intended.
29920
29921
29922 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29923 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29924 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29925 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29926 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29927 message. For example:
29928 .code
29929 # Log all senders' rates
29930 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29931 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29932
29933 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29934 # at the decimal point.
29935 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29936 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29937 $sender_rate_limit }s
29938
29939 # Keep authenticated users under control
29940 deny authenticated = *
29941 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29942
29943 # System-wide rate limit
29944 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29945 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29946
29947 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29948 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29949 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29950 messages per $sender_rate_period
29951 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29952 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29953 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29954 .endd
29955 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29956 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29957 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29958 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29959 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29960 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
29961 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
29962
29963
29964
29965 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
29966 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
29967 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
29968 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
29969 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
29970 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
29971 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
29972 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
29973 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
29974 .code
29975 verify = sender/callout
29976 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
29977 .endd
29978 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
29979 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
29980 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
29981 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
29982 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
29983 The available options are as follows:
29984
29985 .ilist
29986 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
29987 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
29988 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
29989 .next
29990 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
29991 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
29992 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
29993 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
29994 .next
29995 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
29996 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
29997 .next
29998 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
29999 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30000 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30001 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30002 .endlist
30003
30004 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30005 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30006 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30007 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30008 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30009 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30010 coding like this:
30011 .code
30012 warn !verify = sender
30013 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30014 .endd
30015 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30016 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30017 verification failure.
30018
30019 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30020 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30021
30022 .ilist
30023 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30024 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30025 .next
30026 &%route%&: Routing failed.
30027 .next
30028 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30029 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30030 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30031 .next
30032 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30033 .next
30034 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30035 .endlist
30036
30037 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30038 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30039
30040
30041
30042
30043 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30044 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30045 .cindex "callout" "verification"
30046 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30047 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30048 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30049 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30050 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30051 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30052 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30053 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30054 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30055 sender's domain.
30056
30057 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30058 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30059 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30060 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30061 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30062 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30063
30064 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30065 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30066 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30067 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30068 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30069
30070 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30071 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30072 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30073 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30074 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30075 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30076 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30077 supplies a host list.
30078 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30079
30080 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30081 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30082 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30083 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30084 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30085 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30086 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30087
30088 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30089 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30090 following SMTP commands are sent:
30091 .display
30092 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30093 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30094 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30095 &`QUIT`&
30096 .endd
30097 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30098 set to &"lmtp"&.
30099
30100 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30101 settings.
30102
30103 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30104 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30105 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30106 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30107 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30108 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30109
30110 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30111 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30112 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30113 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30114 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30115
30116 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30117 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30118 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30119 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30120 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30121
30122
30123
30124
30125 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30126 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30127 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30128 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30129 .code
30130 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30131 .endd
30132 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30133 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30134 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30135
30136
30137 .vlist
30138 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30139 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30140 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30141 For example:
30142 .code
30143 verify = sender/callout=5s
30144 .endd
30145 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30146 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30147 the &%connect%& parameter.
30148
30149
30150 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30151 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30152 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30153 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30154 .code
30155 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30156 .endd
30157 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30158
30159 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30160 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30161 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30162 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30163 updated in this circumstance.
30164
30165 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30166 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30167 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30168 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30169 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30170 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30171
30172
30173 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30174 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30175 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30176 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30177 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30178 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30179 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30180 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30181 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30182 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30183 .code
30184 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30185 .endd
30186 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30187
30188
30189 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30190 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30191 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30192 For example:
30193 .code
30194 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30195 .endd
30196 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30197 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30198 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30199 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30200 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30201
30202
30203 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30204 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30205 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30206 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30207
30208 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30209 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30210 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30211 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30212 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30213 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30214 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30215 made, until the cache record expires.
30216
30217 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30218 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30219 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30220 For example:
30221 .code
30222 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30223 .endd
30224 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30225 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30226 .code
30227 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30228 .endd
30229 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30230 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30231 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30232 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30233
30234
30235 .vitem &*random*&
30236 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30237 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30238 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30239 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30240 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30241 .code
30242 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30243 .endd
30244 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30245 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30246 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30247 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30248 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30249
30250 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30251 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30252 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30253 .code
30254 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30255 .endd
30256 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30257 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30258 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30259 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30260 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30261
30262 .vitem &*use_sender*&
30263 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30264 .code
30265 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30266 .endd
30267 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30268 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30269 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30270 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30271 usefulness of callout caching.
30272 .endlist
30273
30274 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30275 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30276 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30277 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30278 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30279 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30280 these circumstances.
30281
30282 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30283 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30284 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30285 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30286 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30287 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30288 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30289
30290 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30291 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30292 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30293 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30294
30295
30296
30297
30298 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30299 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30300 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30301 .cindex "caching" "callout"
30302 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30303 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30304 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30305 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30306 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30307 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30308
30309 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30310 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30311 is not available.
30312
30313 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30314 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30315 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30316
30317 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30318 commands up to and including
30319 .code
30320 MAIL FROM:<>
30321 .endd
30322 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30323 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30324 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30325 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30326 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30327 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30328 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30329
30330 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30331 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30332 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30333 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30334 will eventually be noticed.
30335
30336 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30337 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30338 behaviour will be the same.
30339
30340
30341
30342 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30343 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30344 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30345 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30346 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30347 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30348 you might see:
30349 .code
30350 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30351 250 OK
30352 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30353 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30354 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30355 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30356 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30357 550 Sender verification failed
30358 .endd
30359 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30360 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30361 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30362 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30363 example:
30364 .code
30365 verify = sender/no_details
30366 .endd
30367
30368 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30369 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30370 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30371 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30372 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30373 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30374 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30375
30376 .ilist
30377 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30378 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30379 verification also fails.
30380 .next
30381 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30382 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30383 .endlist
30384
30385 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30386 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30387 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30388 .code
30389 A.Wol: aw123
30390 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30391 .endd
30392 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30393 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30394 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30395 verification to succeed.
30396
30397 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30398 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30399 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30400 option. For example:
30401 .code
30402 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30403 .endd
30404 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30405 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30406
30407 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30408 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30409 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30410 address and a report is output for each of them.
30411
30412
30413
30414 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30415 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30416 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30417 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30418 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30419 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30420 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30421 .code
30422 verify = csa
30423 .endd
30424 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30425 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30426 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30427 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30428 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30429 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30430
30431 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30432 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30433 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30434 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30435
30436 .ilist
30437 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30438 .next
30439 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30440 .next
30441 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30442 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30443 .next
30444 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30445 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30446 .endlist
30447
30448 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30449 use for the DNS query. The default is:
30450 .code
30451 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30452 .endd
30453 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30454 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30455 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30456 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30457 meaningful to say:
30458 .code
30459 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30460 .endd
30461 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30462 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30463 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30464
30465 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30466 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30467 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30468 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30469 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30470 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30471 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30472 of legitimate HELO domains.
30473
30474 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30475 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30476 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30477 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30478 lookup such as:
30479 .code
30480 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30481 .endd
30482 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30483 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30484 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30485
30486
30487
30488
30489 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30490 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
30491 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30492 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30493 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30494 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30495 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30496 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30497
30498 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30499 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30500 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30501 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30502 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30503 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30504 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30505
30506 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30507 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30508 like this:
30509 .code
30510 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30511 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30512 }{$value}}
30513 .endd
30514 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30515 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30516 use this:
30517 .code
30518 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30519 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30520 senders = :
30521 recipients = +batv_senders
30522
30523 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30524 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30525 senders = :
30526 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30527 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30528 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30529 .endd
30530 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30531 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30532 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30533 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30534 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30535
30536 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30537 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30538 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30539 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30540 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30541 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30542 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30543
30544 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30545 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30546 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30547 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30548 .code
30549 batv_redirect:
30550 driver = redirect
30551 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30552 .endd
30553 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30554 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30555 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30556 local addresses.
30557
30558 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30559 can be used:
30560 .code
30561 external_smtp_batv:
30562 driver = smtp
30563 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30564 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30565 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30566 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30567 {$value}fail}}}
30568 .endd
30569 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30570
30571
30572
30573 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30574 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30575 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30576 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30577 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30578 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30579 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30580 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30581 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30582 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30583
30584 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30585 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30586 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30587 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30588 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30589 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30590 . ///
30591 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30592 . ///
30593 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30594 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30595 system to arbitrary domains.
30596
30597
30598 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30599 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30600 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30601 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30602
30603 .ilist
30604 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30605 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30606 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30607 .next
30608 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30609 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30610 .next
30611 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30612 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30613 .endlist
30614
30615
30616 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30617 .code
30618 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30619 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30620 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30621 .endd
30622 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30623 command:
30624 .code
30625 acl_check_rcpt:
30626 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30627 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30628 .endd
30629 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30630 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30631 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30632 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30633 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30634 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30635 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30636
30637
30638
30639 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30640 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30641 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30642 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30643 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30644
30645 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30646 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30647 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30648 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30649 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30650 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30651 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30652 .ecindex IIDacl
30653
30654
30655
30656 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30657 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30658
30659 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30660 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30661 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30662 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30663 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30664 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30665 specification.
30666
30667 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30668 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30669 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30670 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30671 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30672
30673 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30674 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30675 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30676
30677 .ilist
30678 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30679 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30680 .next
30681 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30682 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30683 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30684 .next
30685 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30686 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30687 .next
30688 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30689 conditions.
30690 .next
30691 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30692 .endlist
30693
30694 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30695 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30696 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30697
30698 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30699 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30700 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30701 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30702 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30703 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30704
30705 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30706 temporarily created in a file called:
30707 .display
30708 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30709 .endd
30710 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30711 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30712 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30713 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30714 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30715 .code
30716 control = no_mbox_unspool
30717 .endd
30718 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30719 same directory by default.
30720
30721
30722
30723 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30724 .cindex "virus scanning"
30725 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30726 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30727 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30728 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30729 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30730 in memory and thus are much faster.
30731
30732 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
30733 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
30734
30735 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30736 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
30737 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30738 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30739 .display
30740 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30741 .endd
30742 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30743 .code
30744 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30745 .endd
30746 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30747 before use.
30748 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30749 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30750
30751 .vlist
30752 .vitem &%avast%&
30753 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
30754 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
30755 Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
30756 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
30757 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
30758 This scanner type takes one option,
30759 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30760 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30761 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30762 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30763 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
30764 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
30765 For example:
30766 .code
30767 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
30768 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
30769 .endd
30770 If you omit the argument, the default path
30771 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
30772 is used.
30773 If you use a remote host,
30774 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
30775 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
30776 For information about available commands and their options you may use
30777 .code
30778 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
30779 FLAGS
30780 SENSITIVITY
30781 PACK
30782 .endd
30783
30784
30785 .vitem &%aveserver%&
30786 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30787 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30788 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30789 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30790 example:
30791 .code
30792 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30793 .endd
30794
30795
30796 .vitem &%clamd%&
30797 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30798 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30799 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30800 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30801 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
30802
30803 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
30804 a UNIX socket specification,
30805 a TCP socket specification,
30806 or a (global) option.
30807
30808 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
30809 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
30810 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
30811 and the second a port number,
30812 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
30813 These per-server options are supported:
30814 .code
30815 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
30816 .endd
30817
30818 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
30819 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
30820
30821 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
30822
30823 Examples:
30824 .code
30825 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30826 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30827 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30828 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
30829 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30830 .endd
30831 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
30832 &`local`&
30833 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30834 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30835 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30836 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30837 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30838 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30839
30840 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30841 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30842 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30843 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30844 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30845 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30846 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30847 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30848 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30849 .code
30850 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30851 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30852 (Connection refused)
30853 .endd
30854
30855 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30856 contributing the code for this scanner.
30857
30858 .vitem &%cmdline%&
30859 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30860 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30861 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30862 type takes 3 mandatory options:
30863
30864 .olist
30865 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30866 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30867
30868 .next
30869 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30870 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30871 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30872 the &"trigger"& expression.
30873
30874 .next
30875 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30876 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30877 &"name"& expression.
30878 .endlist olist
30879
30880 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30881 .code
30882 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30883 .endd
30884 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30885 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30886 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30887 configuration setting:
30888 .code
30889 av_scanner = cmdline:\
30890 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30891 found in file:'(.+)'
30892 .endd
30893 .vitem &%drweb%&
30894 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30895 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
30896 takes one option,
30897 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30898 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30899 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30900 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30901 For example:
30902 .code
30903 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30904 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30905 .endd
30906 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30907 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30908
30909 .vitem &%f-protd%&
30910 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
30911 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
30912 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
30913 (or port-range).
30914 For example:
30915 .code
30916 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
30917 .endd
30918 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
30919
30920 .vitem &%fsecure%&
30921 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30922 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30923 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30924 .code
30925 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30926 .endd
30927 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30928 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30929
30930 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30931 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30932 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30933 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30934 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30935 For example:
30936 .code
30937 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30938 .endd
30939 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30940
30941 .vitem &%mksd%&
30942 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30943 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30944 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30945 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30946 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30947 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30948 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30949 .code
30950 av_scanner = mksd:2
30951 .endd
30952 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30953
30954 .vitem &%sock%&
30955 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30956 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30957 running on the local machine.
30958 There are four options:
30959 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
30960 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
30961 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
30962 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
30963 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
30964 For example:
30965 .code
30966 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
30967 .endd
30968 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
30969 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
30970 Both regular-expressions are required.
30971
30972 .vitem &%sophie%&
30973 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
30974 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
30975 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
30976 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
30977 client communication. For example:
30978 .code
30979 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
30980 .endd
30981 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
30982 the option.
30983 .endlist
30984
30985 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
30986 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
30987 ACL.
30988
30989 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
30990 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
30991 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
30992 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
30993 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
30994 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
30995 message.
30996
30997 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
30998 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
30999 The first element can then be one of
31000
31001 .ilist
31002 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31003 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31004 recommended usage.
31005 .next
31006 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31007 the condition fails immediately.
31008 .next
31009 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31010 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31011 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31012 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31013 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31014 .endlist
31015
31016 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31017 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31018 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31019
31020 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31021 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31022 For example:
31023 .code
31024 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31025 .endd
31026 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31027
31028 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31029 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31030 is set to record the actual address used.
31031
31032 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31033 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31034 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31035 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31036 logging data.
31037
31038 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
31039 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
31040 &%malware%& condition.
31041
31042 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31043 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31044
31045 Here is a very simple scanning example:
31046 .code
31047 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31048 demime = *
31049 malware = *
31050 .endd
31051 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31052 .code
31053 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31054 demime = *
31055 malware = */defer_ok
31056 .endd
31057 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31058 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31059 .code
31060 av_scanner = $acl_m0
31061 .endd
31062 in the main Exim configuration.
31063 .code
31064 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31065 set acl_m0 = sophie
31066 malware = *
31067
31068 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31069 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31070 malware = *
31071 .endd
31072
31073
31074 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31075 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31076 .cindex "spam scanning"
31077 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31078 .cindex "Rspamd"
31079 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31080 score and a report for the message.
31081 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31082
31083 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31084 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31085 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31086
31087 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31088 .code
31089 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31090 .endd
31091 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31092 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31093 nicely, however.
31094
31095 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31096 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31097 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31098 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31099 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31100 configuration as follows (example):
31101 .code
31102 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31103 .endd
31104
31105 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31106 on TCP port 11333)
31107 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31108 .code
31109 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31110 .endd
31111
31112 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31113 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31114 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31115 .code
31116 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31117 .endd
31118 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31119 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31120 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31121 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31122 .code
31123 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31124 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31125 192.168.2.12 783
31126 .endd
31127 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31128 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31129 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31130 condition defers.
31131
31132 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31133 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31134 and changeable in the usual way.
31135
31136 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31137 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31138 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31139 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31140
31141 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31142 are options.
31143 The supported options are:
31144 .code
31145 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31146 weight=<value> Selection bias
31147 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31148 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31149 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31150 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31151 .endd
31152
31153 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31154 higher values being tried first.
31155 The default priority is 1.
31156
31157 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31158 Within a priority set
31159 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31160 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31161
31162 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31163 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31164 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31165 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31166
31167 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31168 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31169
31170 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31171 The default value is two minutes.
31172
31173 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31174 a failed connect is made.
31175 The default is to not retry.
31176
31177 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31178 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31179 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31180 expansion.
31181
31182 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31183 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31184 is set to record the actual address used.
31185
31186 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31187 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31188 .code
31189 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31190 spam = joe
31191 .endd
31192 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31193 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31194 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31195 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31196 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31197 right-hand side.
31198
31199 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31200 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31201 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31202 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31203 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31204 are not set.
31205 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31206 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31207 after the first),
31208 or the use of PRDR,
31209 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31210 are needed to use this feature.
31211
31212 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31213 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31214 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31215
31216
31217 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31218 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31219 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31220 example:
31221 .code
31222 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31223 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31224 spam = nobody
31225 .endd
31226
31227 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31228 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31229 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31230 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31231
31232 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31233 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31234 variables.
31235 Except for &$spam_report$&,
31236 these variables are saved with the received message so are
31237 available for use at delivery time.
31238
31239 .vlist
31240 .vitem &$spam_score$&
31241 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31242 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31243
31244 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31245 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31246 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31247 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31248 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31249
31250 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
31251 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31252 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31253 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31254 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
31255 spam bar is 50 characters.
31256
31257 .vitem &$spam_report$&
31258 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31259 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31260 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31261
31262 .vitem &$spam_action$&
31263 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31264 spam score versus threshold.
31265 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31266
31267 .endlist
31268
31269 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31270 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31271 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31272
31273 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31274 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31275 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31276 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31277 spam condition, like this:
31278 .code
31279 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31280 spam = joe/defer_ok
31281 .endd
31282 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31283
31284 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31285 condition:
31286 .code
31287 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31288 warn spam = nobody:true
31289 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31290 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31291
31292 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31293 # is over threshold
31294 warn spam = nobody
31295 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31296
31297 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31298 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31299 spam = nobody:true
31300 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31301 .endd
31302
31303
31304
31305 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31306 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31307 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31308 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31309 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31310 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31311 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31312 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31313 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31314 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31315 cases.
31316
31317 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31318 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31319 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31320 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31321 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31322 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31323 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31324
31325 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31326 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31327 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31328 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31329 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31330
31331 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31332 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31333 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31334 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31335 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31336 syntax is:
31337 .display
31338 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31339 .endd
31340 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31341 the value can be:
31342
31343 .olist
31344 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31345 .next
31346 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31347 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31348 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31349 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31350 .next
31351 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31352 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31353 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31354 the full path and file name.
31355 .next
31356 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31357 filename, and the default path is then used.
31358 .endlist
31359 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31360 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31361 a file with its original, proposed filename using
31362 .code
31363 decode = $mime_filename
31364 .endd
31365 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31366 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31367 automatically unlinked.
31368
31369 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31370 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31371 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31372 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31373 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31374
31375 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31376 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31377 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31378
31379 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31380 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31381 available in the MIME ACL:
31382
31383 .vlist
31384 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31385 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31386 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31387 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31388 contains the empty string.
31389
31390 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
31391 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31392 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31393 .code
31394 us-ascii
31395 gb2312 (Chinese)
31396 iso-8859-1
31397 .endd
31398 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31399 case-insensitively.
31400
31401 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31402 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31403 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31404 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31405 only used for display purposes.
31406
31407 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31408 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31409 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31410
31411 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31412 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31413 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31414
31415 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31416 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31417 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31418 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31419 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31420
31421 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31422 This variable contains the normalized content of the
31423 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31424 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31425
31426 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31427 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31428 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31429 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31430 .code
31431 text/plain
31432 text/html
31433 application/octet-stream
31434 image/jpeg
31435 audio/midi
31436 .endd
31437 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31438 empty string.
31439
31440 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31441 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31442 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31443 containing the decoded data.
31444 .endlist
31445
31446 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31447 .vlist
31448 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
31449 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31450 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31451 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31452 RFC2047
31453 or RFC2231
31454 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31455 If no filename was
31456 found, this variable contains the empty string.
31457
31458 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31459 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31460 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31461 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31462
31463 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31464 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31465 follows:
31466
31467 .olist
31468 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31469
31470 .next
31471 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31472 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31473
31474 .next
31475 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31476 and the rest are attachments.
31477
31478 .next
31479 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31480 .endlist olist
31481
31482 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31483 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31484 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31485 .code
31486 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31487 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31488 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31489 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31490 .endd
31491 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31492 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31493 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31494 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31495 want to carry out specific actions on them.
31496
31497 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31498 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31499 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31500 decoding is fully recursive.
31501
31502 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31503 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31504 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31505 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31506 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31507 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31508 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31509 .endlist
31510
31511
31512
31513 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31514 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31515 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31516 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31517 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31518
31519 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31520 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31521 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31522 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31523 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31524
31525 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31526 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31527 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31528 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31529 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
31530 32K characters are checked.
31531
31532 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31533 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31534 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31535 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31536 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31537 .code
31538 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31539 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31540 .endd
31541 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31542 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31543 matching regular expression.
31544 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
31545 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
31546
31547 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31548 CPU-intensive.
31549
31550
31551
31552
31553 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31554 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31555 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31556 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31557 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31558 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31559 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31560 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31561 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31562 use the &%demime%& condition.
31563
31564 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31565 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31566 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31567 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31568 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31569 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31570
31571 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31572 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31573 example:
31574 .code
31575 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31576 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31577 .endd
31578 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31579 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31580 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31581 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31582
31583 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31584 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31585 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31586
31587 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31588
31589 .vlist
31590 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31591 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31592 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31593 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31594 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31595 zero, no error occurred.
31596
31597 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
31598 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31599 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31600 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31601 .endlist
31602
31603 .vlist
31604 .vitem &$found_extension$&
31605 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31606 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31607 extension it found.
31608 .endlist
31609
31610 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31611 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31612
31613 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31614 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31615 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31616 facility:
31617 .code
31618 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31619 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31620 demime = *
31621 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31622
31623 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31624 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31625 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31626 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31627
31628 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31629 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
31630 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31631 demime = exe:doc
31632 control = freeze
31633 .endd
31634 .ecindex IIDcosca
31635
31636
31637
31638
31639 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31640 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31641
31642 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31643 "Local scan function"
31644 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31645 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31646 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31647 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31648 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31649
31650 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31651 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31652 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31653 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31654 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31655
31656 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31657 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31658 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31659 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31660
31661 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31662 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31663 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31664 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31665
31666 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31667 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31668 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31669 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31670 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31671 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31672 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31673 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31674 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31675
31676
31677
31678 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31679 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31680 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31681 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31682 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31683 directory, so you might set
31684 .code
31685 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31686 .endd
31687 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31688 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31689 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31690 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31691 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31692 _src/local_scan.c_.
31693
31694 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31695 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31696 .code
31697 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31698 .endd
31699 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31700
31701
31702
31703
31704 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31705 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31706 You must include this line near the start of your code:
31707 .code
31708 #include "local_scan.h"
31709 .endd
31710 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31711 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31712 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31713 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31714 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31715 strings and pointers to character strings:
31716 .code
31717 #define CS (char *)
31718 #define CCS (const char *)
31719 #define CSS (char **)
31720 #define US (unsigned char *)
31721 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31722 #define USS (unsigned char **)
31723 .endd
31724 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31725 .code
31726 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31727 .endd
31728 The arguments are as follows:
31729
31730 .ilist
31731 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31732 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31733 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31734
31735 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31736 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31737 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31738 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31739 case this changes in some future version.
31740 .next
31741 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31742 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31743 .endlist
31744
31745 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31746
31747 .vlist
31748 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31749 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31750 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31751 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31752 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31753 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31754
31755 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31756 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31757 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31758
31759 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31760 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31761 queued without immediate delivery.
31762
31763 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31764 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31765 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31766 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31767 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31768 used.
31769
31770 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31771 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31772 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31773 problem"& is used.
31774
31775 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31776 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31777 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31778 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31779 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31780 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31781 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31782
31783 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31784 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31785 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31786 .endlist
31787
31788 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31789 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31790 &%-oe%& command line options.
31791
31792
31793
31794 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31795 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31796 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31797 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31798 want to do this, you must have the line
31799 .code
31800 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31801 .endd
31802 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31803 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31804 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31805 to define them.
31806
31807 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31808 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31809 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31810 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31811 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31812 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31813 .code
31814 static int my_integer_option = 42;
31815 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31816
31817 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31818 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31819 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31820 };
31821
31822 int local_scan_options_count =
31823 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31824 .endd
31825 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31826 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31827 .code
31828 begin local_scan
31829 my_integer = 99
31830 my_string = some string of text...
31831 .endd
31832 The available types of option data are as follows:
31833
31834 .vlist
31835 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
31836 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31837 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31838 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31839 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31840 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31841 values.)
31842
31843 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31844 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31845 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31846 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31847
31848 .vitem &*opt_int*&
31849 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31850 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31851 Exim.
31852
31853 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31854 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31855 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31856 printed with the suffix K or M.
31857
31858 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
31859 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31860 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31861 always output in octal.
31862
31863 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31864 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31865 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31866
31867 .vitem &*opt_time*&
31868 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31869 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31870 .endlist
31871
31872 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31873 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31874
31875
31876
31877 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31878 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31879 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31880 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31881 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31882 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31883 C variables are as follows:
31884
31885 .vlist
31886 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31887 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31888
31889 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31890 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31891
31892 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31893 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31894 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31895 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31896
31897 .ilist
31898 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31899 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31900 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31901
31902 .next
31903 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31904 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31905 of debugging bits.
31906 .endlist ilist
31907
31908 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31909 selected, you should use code like this:
31910 .code
31911 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31912 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31913 .endd
31914 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31915 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31916 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31917
31918 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31919 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31920 discussed below.
31921
31922 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31923 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31924
31925 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31926 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31927
31928 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31929 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31930 &%-bh%& command line option.
31931
31932 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31933 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31934 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31935
31936 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31937 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31938 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31939 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31940
31941 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31942 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31943 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31944
31945 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31946 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
31947
31948 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
31949 The number of accepted recipients.
31950
31951 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
31952 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
31953 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
31954 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
31955 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
31956 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
31957 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
31958 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
31959 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
31960 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
31961 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
31962 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
31963
31964 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
31965 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
31966
31967 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
31968 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
31969 locally-submitted messages.
31970
31971 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
31972 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
31973 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
31974
31975 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
31976 The name of the sending host, if known.
31977
31978 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
31979 The port on the sending host.
31980
31981 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
31982 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
31983
31984 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
31985 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
31986
31987 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
31988 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
31989 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
31990 .endlist
31991
31992
31993 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
31994 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
31995 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
31996 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
31997 their type to *.
31998
31999
32000 .vlist
32001 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32002 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32003
32004 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32005 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32006 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32007 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32008 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32009 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32010 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32011
32012 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
32013 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32014 internal newlines.
32015
32016 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32017 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32018 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32019 .endlist
32020
32021
32022
32023 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32024 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32025
32026 .vlist
32027 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32028 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32029
32030 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
32031 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32032 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32033 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32034
32035 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32036 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32037 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32038 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32039 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32040 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32041 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32042 is NULL for all recipients.
32043 .endlist
32044
32045
32046
32047 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32048 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32049 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32050 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32051 release:
32052
32053 .vlist
32054 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32055 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32056
32057 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32058 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32059 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32060 for the process in &%newumask%&.
32061
32062 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32063 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32064 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32065 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32066 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32067
32068 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32069
32070 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32071 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32072 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32073 return value is as follows:
32074
32075 .ilist
32076 >= 0
32077
32078 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32079 ending status.
32080
32081 .next
32082 < 0 and > &--256
32083
32084 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32085 signal number.
32086
32087 .next
32088 &--256
32089
32090 The process timed out.
32091 .next
32092 &--257
32093
32094 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32095 .endlist
32096
32097 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32098 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32099 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32100 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32101 forks a subprocess that is running
32102 .code
32103 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32104 .endd
32105 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32106 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32107 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32108 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32109
32110 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32111 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32112 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32113 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32114
32115
32116 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32117 *sender_authentication)*&
32118 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32119 that it runs is:
32120 .display
32121 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32122 .endd
32123 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32124
32125
32126 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32127 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32128 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32129 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32130 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32131 .code
32132 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32133 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32134 .endd
32135
32136 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32137 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32138 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32139 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32140 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32141 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32142 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32143 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32144
32145 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32146 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32147 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32148 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32149 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32150 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32151
32152 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32153 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32154 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32155 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32156
32157 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32158 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32159 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32160 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32161 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32162 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32163 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32164 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32165 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32166 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32167 .code
32168 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32169 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32170 .endd
32171 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32172 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32173
32174
32175 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32176 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32177 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32178 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32179 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32180
32181
32182 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32183 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32184 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32185 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32186 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32187 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32188 .code
32189 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32190 .endd
32191 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32192 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32193 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32194 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32195 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32196 zero-terminated.
32197
32198 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32199 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32200 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32201 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32202 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32203 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32204 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32205 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32206
32207 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32208 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32209 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32210 .display
32211 &`OK `& match succeeded
32212 &`FAIL `& match failed
32213 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32214 .endd
32215 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32216 inability to contact a database.
32217
32218 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32219 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32220 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32221 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32222 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32223
32224 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32225 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32226 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32227 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32228 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32229
32230 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32231 uschar&~*list)*&"
32232 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32233 expected to be
32234 .code
32235 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32236 .endd
32237 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32238 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32239 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32240 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32241 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32242 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32243 failed.
32244
32245 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32246 *format,&~...)*&"
32247 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32248 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32249 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32250 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32251 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32252 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32253
32254
32255 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32256 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32257 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32258 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32259
32260 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32261 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32262 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32263 value afterwards. For example:
32264 .code
32265 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32266 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32267 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32268 .endd
32269
32270 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32271 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32272 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32273 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32274 address.
32275 .endlist
32276
32277
32278 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32279 .vlist
32280 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32281 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32282 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32283 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32284 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32285 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32286 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32287 binary string is returned with an error message.
32288
32289 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32290 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32291 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32292
32293 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32294 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32295 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32296 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32297 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32298
32299 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32300 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32301 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32302
32303 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32304 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32305 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32306 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32307 with translation.
32308
32309
32310 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32311 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32312 below.
32313
32314 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32315 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32316 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32317 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32318 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32319 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32320 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32321 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32322 is involved.
32323
32324 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32325 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32326
32327 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32328 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32329 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32330 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32331 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32332 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32333 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32334 .code
32335 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32336 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32337 .endd
32338 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32339 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32340 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32341 multiple output lines.
32342
32343 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32344 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32345 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32346 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32347 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32348 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32349 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32350 is an error.
32351
32352 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32353 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32354 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32355 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32356
32357 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32358 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32359 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32360
32361 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32362 See below.
32363
32364 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32365 See below.
32366
32367 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32368 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32369 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32370 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32371 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32372 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32373 more discussion.
32374 .endlist
32375
32376
32377
32378 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32379 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32380 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32381 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32382 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32383 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32384 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32385 terminates.
32386
32387 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32388 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32389 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32390 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32391
32392 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32393 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32394 .code
32395 store_pool = POOL_PERM
32396 .endd
32397 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32398 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32399 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32400 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32401
32402 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32403 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32404 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32405 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32406 &%store_pool%&.
32407 .ecindex IIDlosca
32408
32409
32410
32411
32412 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32413 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32414
32415 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32416 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32417 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32418 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32419 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32420 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32421 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32422 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32423
32424 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32425 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32426 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32427 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32428 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32429
32430 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32431 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32432 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32433 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32434 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32435 prevent it happening on retries.
32436
32437 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32438 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32439 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32440 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32441 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32442 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32443 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32444 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32445
32446
32447 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32448 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32449 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32450 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32451 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32452 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32453 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32454 .code
32455 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32456 system_filter_user = exim
32457 .endd
32458 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32459 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32460 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32461 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32462 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32463 by the &%reply%& command.
32464
32465
32466 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32467 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32468 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32469 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32470
32471 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32472 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32473
32474
32475
32476 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32477 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32478 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32479 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32480 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32481 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32482 they cause errors.
32483
32484 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32485 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32486 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32487 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32488 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32489 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32490 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32491
32492 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32493 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32494 succeed, it will not be tried again.
32495 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32496 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32497
32498 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32499 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32500 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32501 to which users' filter files can refer.
32502
32503
32504
32505 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32506 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
32507 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32508 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32509 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32510
32511
32512
32513 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32514 .cindex "freezing messages"
32515 .cindex "message" "freezing"
32516 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
32517 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32518 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32519 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32520 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32521 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32522 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32523 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32524 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32525 .code
32526 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32527 .endd
32528 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32529
32530 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32531 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32532 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32533 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32534 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32535 run.
32536
32537 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32538 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32539 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32540 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32541
32542 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32543 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32544 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32545 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32546 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32547 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32548 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32549 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32550 message. For example:
32551 .code
32552 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32553 because it contains attachments that we are \
32554 not prepared to receive."
32555 .endd
32556
32557 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32558 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32559 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32560 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32561 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32562 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32563 use, for example
32564 .code
32565 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32566 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32567 .endd
32568 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32569 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32570 generated by the filter.
32571
32572 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32573 &%defer%&,
32574 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32575 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32576 as
32577 .code
32578 mail ...
32579 freeze
32580 .endd
32581 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32582 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32583 take place.
32584
32585
32586
32587 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32588 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32589 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32590 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32591 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32592 .code
32593 headers add <string>
32594 headers remove <string>
32595 .endd
32596 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32597 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32598 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32599 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32600 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32601
32602 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32603 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32604 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32605 example:
32606 .code
32607 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32608 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32609 X-header-2: ...."
32610 .endd
32611 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32612 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32613 space after input continuations is ignored.
32614
32615 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32616 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32617 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32618 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32619 header with the same name, they are all removed.
32620
32621 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32622 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32623 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32624 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32625 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32626 used for all recipients of the message.
32627
32628 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32629 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32630 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32631 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32632 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32633 until the message is actually being written (see section
32634 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32635
32636 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32637 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32638 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32639 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32640 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32641 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32642 modified more than once.
32643
32644 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32645 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32646 For example:
32647 .code
32648 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32649 headers remove "Subject"
32650 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32651 headers remove "Old-Subject"
32652 .endd
32653
32654
32655
32656 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32657 .cindex "envelope sender"
32658 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32659 .code
32660 errors_to <some address>
32661 .endd
32662 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32663 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32664 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32665 might use
32666 .code
32667 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32668 .endd
32669 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32670 address if its delivery failed.
32671
32672
32673
32674 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32675 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32676 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32677 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32678 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32679 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32680 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32681 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32682 which implements such a filter:
32683 .code
32684 central_filter:
32685 check_local_user
32686 driver = redirect
32687 domains = +local_domains
32688 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32689 no_verify
32690 allow_filter
32691 allow_freeze
32692 .endd
32693 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32694 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32695 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32696 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32697
32698 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32699 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32700 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32701 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32702 normal way.
32703 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
32704 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
32705 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
32706
32707
32708
32709
32710
32711
32712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32713 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32714
32715 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32716 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32717 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32718 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32719 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32720 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32721 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32722 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32723
32724 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32725 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32726 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32727 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32728 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32729
32730 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32731 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32732 loopback interface specially in any way.
32733
32734 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32735 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32736
32737
32738
32739
32740 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32741 .cindex "message" "submission"
32742 .cindex "submission mode"
32743 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32744 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32745 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32746 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32747 .code
32748 control = submission
32749 .endd
32750 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32751 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32752 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32753 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32754 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32755 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32756 .code
32757 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32758 control = submission
32759 .endd
32760 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32761 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32762 is used to separate options. For example:
32763 .code
32764 control = submission/sender_retain
32765 .endd
32766 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32767 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32768 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32769 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32770 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32771 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32772 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32773
32774 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32775 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32776 example:
32777 .code
32778 control = submission/domain=some.domain
32779 .endd
32780 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32781 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32782 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32783 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32784 .code
32785 accept authenticated = *
32786 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32787 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32788 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32789 .endd
32790 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32791 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32792 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32793 .code
32794 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32795 .endd
32796 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32797 line would be:
32798 .code
32799 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32800 .endd
32801 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32802 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32803 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32804 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32805
32806 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32807 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32808 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32809 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32810 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32811 spoof another's address.
32812
32813 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32814 .cindex "line endings"
32815 .cindex "carriage return"
32816 .cindex "linefeed"
32817 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32818 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32819 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32820 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32821 use CRLF or just CR.
32822
32823 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32824 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32825 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32826 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32827 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32828 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32829 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32830 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32831 follows:
32832
32833 .ilist
32834 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32835 .next
32836 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32837 is ignored.
32838 .next
32839 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32840 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32841 terminator.
32842 .next
32843 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32844 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32845 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32846 people trying to play silly games.
32847 .next
32848 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32849 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32850 line.
32851 .endlist
32852
32853
32854
32855
32856
32857 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32858 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
32859 .cindex "address" "qualification"
32860 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32861 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32862 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32863 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32864 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32865
32866 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32867 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32868 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32869 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32870 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32871
32872 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32873 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32874 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32875 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32876 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32877 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32878 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32879 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32880
32881
32882
32883
32884 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32885 .cindex "&""From""& line"
32886 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32887 .cindex "sender" "address"
32888 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32889 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32890 .cindex "envelope sender"
32891 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32892 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32893 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32894 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32895 .code
32896 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32897 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32898 .endd
32899 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32900 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32901 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32902 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32903 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32904 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32905 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32906 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32907 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32908
32909 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32910 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32911 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32912 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32913 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32914 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32915 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32916
32917 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32918 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32919 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32920
32921 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32922 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32923 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32924 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32925
32926
32927
32928 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32929 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32930 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32931 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32932 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32933 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32934 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32935
32936 .blockquote
32937 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32938 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32939 .endblockquote
32940
32941 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32942 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32943 follows:
32944
32945 .ilist
32946 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
32947 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
32948 .next
32949 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
32950 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
32951 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
32952 .next
32953 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
32954 also removed.
32955 .next
32956 For a locally-submitted message,
32957 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
32958 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
32959 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
32960 included in log lines in this case.
32961 .next
32962 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
32963 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
32964 .endlist
32965
32966
32967
32968
32969 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
32970 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
32971 includes the header line:
32972 .code
32973 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
32974 .endd
32975
32976 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
32977 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
32978 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
32979 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
32980 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
32981 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
32982
32983
32984 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
32985 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
32986 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
32987 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
32988 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
32989
32990 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
32991 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
32992 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
32993 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
32994 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
32995 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
32996 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
32997 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
32998 messages.
32999
33000
33001 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33002 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33003 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33004 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33005 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33006 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33007 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33008 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33009 messages.
33010
33011
33012 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33013 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33014 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33015 .cindex "message" "submission"
33016 .cindex "submission mode"
33017 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33018 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33019
33020 .ilist
33021 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33022 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33023 .next
33024 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33025 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33026 .olist
33027 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33028 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33029 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33030 .next
33031 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33032 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33033 .next
33034 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33035 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33036 .endlist
33037 .endlist
33038
33039 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33040
33041 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33042 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33043 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33044 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33045 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33046 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33047 &%qualify_domain%&.
33048
33049 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33050 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33051 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33052 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33053
33054
33055 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33056 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33057 .cindex "message" "submission"
33058 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33059 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33060 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33061 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33062 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33063 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33064 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33065 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33066 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33067 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33068
33069
33070 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33071 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33072 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33073 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33074 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33075
33076 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33077 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33078 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33079 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33080
33081 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33082 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33083 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33084
33085
33086 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33087 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33088 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33089 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33090 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33091 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33092 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33093 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33094 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33095 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33096 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33097
33098
33099
33100 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33101 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33102 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33103 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33104 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33105 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33106 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33107 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33108
33109
33110
33111 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33112 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33113 .cindex "message" "submission"
33114 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33115 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33116 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33117 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33118 control setting.
33119
33120 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33121 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33122 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33123 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33124 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33125 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33126 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33127 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33128 line is added to the message.
33129
33130 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33131 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33132 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33133 options true at the same time.
33134
33135 .cindex "submission mode"
33136 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33137 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33138 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33139 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33140
33141 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33142 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33143 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33144 created as follows:
33145
33146 .ilist
33147 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33148 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33149 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33150 .next
33151 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33152 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33153 .next
33154 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33155 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33156 .endlist
33157
33158 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33159 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33160 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33161 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33162
33163 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33164 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33165 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33166 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33167
33168
33169
33170 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33171 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33172 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33173 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33174 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33175 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33176 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33177 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33178 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33179
33180 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33181 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33182 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33183 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33184 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33185 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33186
33187 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33188 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33189 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33190
33191 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33192 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33193 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33194 .code
33195 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33196 X-added-second: another added header line
33197 .endd
33198 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33199
33200 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33201 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33202 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33203
33204 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33205 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33206 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33207 not part of the names. For example:
33208 .code
33209 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33210 .endd
33211
33212 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33213 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33214 Each item is separately expanded.
33215 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33216 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33217 will act as list separators.
33218
33219 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33220 items are expanded at routing time,
33221 and then associated with all addresses that are
33222 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33223 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33224 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33225
33226 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33227 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33228 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33229 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33230
33231 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33232 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33233 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33234 requirements.
33235
33236 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33237 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33238 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33239 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33240 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33241 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33242 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33243
33244 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33245 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33246 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33247 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33248
33249 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33250 the following consequences:
33251
33252 .ilist
33253 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33254 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33255 to it, at all times.
33256 .next
33257 Header lines that are added by a router's
33258 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33259 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33260 .next
33261 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33262 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33263 .next
33264 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33265 a later router or by a transport.
33266 .next
33267 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33268 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33269 .code
33270 headers_remove = subject
33271 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33272 .endd
33273 .endlist
33274
33275 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33276 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33277
33278
33279
33280
33281
33282 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33283 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33284 .cindex "constructed address"
33285 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33286 the form
33287 .display
33288 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33289 .endd
33290 For example:
33291 .code
33292 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33293 .endd
33294 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33295 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33296 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33297 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33298 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33299 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33300 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33301 there is no password file entry.
33302
33303 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33304 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33305 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33306 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33307 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33308 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33309 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33310 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33311 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33312
33313
33314
33315 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33316 .cindex "case of local parts"
33317 .cindex "local part" "case of"
33318 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33319 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33320 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33321 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33322 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33323 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33324 router option.
33325
33326 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
33327 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33328 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33329 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33330 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33331 .code
33332 correct_case:
33333 driver = redirect
33334 domains = +local_domains
33335 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33336 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33337 @$domain
33338 .endd
33339 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33340 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33341 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33342 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33343 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33344
33345
33346
33347 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33348 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
33349 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
33350 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33351 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33352 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33353 empty components for compatibility.
33354
33355
33356
33357 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33358 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33359 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33360 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33361 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33362 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33363
33364 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33365 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33366 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33367 example, a header such as
33368 .code
33369 To: hare@teaparty
33370 .endd
33371 might get rewritten as
33372 .code
33373 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33374 .endd
33375 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33376 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33377 been routed.
33378
33379 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33380 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33381 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33382 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33383 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33384 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33385 .ecindex IIDmesproc
33386
33387
33388
33389 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33390 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33391
33392 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33393 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33394 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33395 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33396 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33397 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33398 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33399
33400 .ilist
33401 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33402 .next
33403 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33404 .next
33405 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33406 .endlist
33407
33408 For mail delivery, the following are available:
33409
33410 .ilist
33411 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33412 .next
33413 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33414 &"lmtp"&);
33415 .next
33416 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33417 transport);
33418 .next
33419 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33420 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33421 .endlist
33422
33423 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33424 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33425 used to contain the envelope information.
33426
33427
33428
33429 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33430 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33431 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33432 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33433 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33434 .cindex "EHLO"
33435 .cindex "HELO"
33436 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33437 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33438 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33439 processing is the same in both cases.
33440
33441 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33442 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33443 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33444 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33445 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33446 .cindex "transport" "filter"
33447 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33448 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33449 suppressed.
33450
33451 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33452 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33453 required for the transaction.
33454
33455 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33456 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33457 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33458 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33459 is called for verification.
33460
33461 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33462 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33463 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33464
33465 .cindex "carriage return"
33466 .cindex "linefeed"
33467 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33468 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33469 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33470 line terminator.
33471
33472 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33473 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33474 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33475 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33476 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33477 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33478 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33479 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33480 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33481
33482 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33483 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33484 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33485 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33486
33487 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33488 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33489 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33490 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33491
33492 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33493 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33494 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33495 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33496 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33497 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33498 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33499 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33500 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33501 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33502
33503 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33504 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33505
33506 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33507 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33508 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33509 square bracket of the IP address.
33510
33511
33512
33513
33514 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33515 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33516 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33517 .cindex "host" "error"
33518 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33519 message errors, and recipient errors.
33520
33521 .vlist
33522 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33523 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33524 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33525
33526 .ilist
33527 Connection refused or timed out,
33528 .next
33529 Any error response code on connection,
33530 .next
33531 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33532 .next
33533 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33534 .next
33535 I/O errors at any time,
33536 .next
33537 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33538 the &"."& at the end of the data.
33539 .endlist ilist
33540
33541 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33542 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33543 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33544 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33545 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33546 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33547 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33548 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33549
33550 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33551 .cindex "message" "error"
33552 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33553 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33554 message errors are:
33555
33556 .ilist
33557 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33558 the data,
33559 .next
33560 Timeout after MAIL,
33561 .next
33562 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33563 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33564 connection at any other time.
33565 .endlist ilist
33566
33567 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33568 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33569 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33570 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33571 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33572 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33573 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33574 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33575 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33576 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33577
33578 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33579 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33580 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33581 response to MAIL.
33582
33583 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33584 .cindex "recipient" "error"
33585 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33586 recipient errors are:
33587
33588 .ilist
33589 Any error response to RCPT,
33590 .next
33591 Timeout after RCPT.
33592 .endlist
33593
33594 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33595 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33596 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33597 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33598 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33599 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33600 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33601 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33602 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33603 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33604 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33605 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33606 the retry clock is reset.
33607
33608 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33609 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33610 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33611 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33612 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33613 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33614 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33615 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33616 recipient's retry time.
33617 .endlist
33618
33619 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33620 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33621 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33622 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33623 until the next delivery attempt.
33624
33625 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33626 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33627 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33628 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33629 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33630 is created.
33631
33632 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33633 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33634 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33635 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33636 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33637 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33638 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33639
33640 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33641 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33642 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33643 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33644 then to be treated as a host error.
33645
33646 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33647 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33648 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33649 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33650 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33651
33652
33653
33654
33655 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33656 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33657 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33658 .cindex "inetd"
33659 .cindex "daemon"
33660 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33661 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33662 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33663 .code
33664 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33665 .endd
33666 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33667 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33668 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33669 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33670 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33671 stream and exits with an error code.
33672
33673 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33674 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33675 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33676 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33677
33678 .cindex "carriage return"
33679 .cindex "linefeed"
33680 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33681 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33682 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33683 line terminator.
33684 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33685 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33686 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33687
33688 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33689 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33690 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33691 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33692 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33693 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33694 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33695 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33696
33697 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33698 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33699 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33700 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33701 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33702 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33703 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33704 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33705 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33706
33707 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33708 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33709 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33710
33711 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33712 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33713 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33714 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33715 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33716
33717 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33718 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33719 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33720 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33721 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33722 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33723 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33724
33725 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33726 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33727 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33728 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33729 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33730
33731 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33732 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33733 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33734 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33735 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33736 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33737 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33738 a delivery process.
33739
33740 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33741 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33742 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33743 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33744 however, available with &'inetd'&.
33745
33746 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33747 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33748 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33749 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33750
33751 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33752 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33753 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33754
33755
33756
33757 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33758 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33759 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33760 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33761 the error response to the last command. The default value for
33762 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33763 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33764 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33765
33766
33767 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33768 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33769 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33770 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33771 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33772 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33773 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33774 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33775 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33776 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33777 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33778
33779
33780
33781 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33782 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33783 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33784 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33785 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33786 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33787 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33788 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33789
33790 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33791 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33792 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33793 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33794 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33795 counted.
33796
33797 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33798 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33799 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33800
33801 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33802 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33803 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33804 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33805 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33806
33807
33808
33809
33810 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33811 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33812 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33813 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33814 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33815
33816 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33817 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33818 called with the &%-bv%& option.
33819
33820 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33821 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33822 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33823 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33824 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33825 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33826 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33827 RCPT failures.
33828
33829
33830
33831 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33832 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33833 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33834 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33835 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33836 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33837 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33838
33839 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33840 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33841 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33842 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33843 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33844 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33845 argument. For example,
33846 .code
33847 ETRN #brigadoon
33848 .endd
33849 runs the command
33850 .code
33851 exim -R brigadoon
33852 .endd
33853 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33854 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33855 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33856 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33857 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33858
33859 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33860 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33861 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33862 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33863 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33864 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33865 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33866 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33867
33868 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33869 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33870 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33871 whatever the form of its argument. For
33872 example:
33873 .code
33874 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33875 $sender_host_address
33876 .endd
33877 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33878 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33879 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33880 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33881 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33882 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33883 for it to change them before running the command.
33884
33885
33886
33887 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33888 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33889 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33890 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33891 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33892 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33893 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33894 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33895 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33896 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33897 runs for RCPT commands:
33898 .code
33899 accept hosts = :
33900 .endd
33901 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33902
33903
33904
33905 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33906 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33907 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
33908 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33909 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33910 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33911 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33912 envelope along with the message.
33913
33914 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33915 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33916 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33917 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33918 can be used to specify it.
33919
33920 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33921 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33922 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33923 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33924 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33925
33926 .vindex "&$host$&"
33927 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33928 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33929 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33930 router:
33931 .code
33932 begin routers
33933 route_append:
33934 driver = manualroute
33935 transport = smtp_appendfile
33936 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33937
33938 begin transports
33939 smtp_appendfile:
33940 driver = appendfile
33941 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33942 batch_max = 1000
33943 use_bsmtp
33944 user = exim
33945 .endd
33946 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
33947 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
33948 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
33949
33950
33951
33952 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
33953 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
33954 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
33955 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
33956 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
33957 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
33958 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
33959 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
33960 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
33961 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
33962
33963 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
33964 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
33965
33966 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
33967 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
33968 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
33969 make some use of automatically, for example:
33970 .code
33971 554 Unexpected end of file
33972 Transaction started in line 10
33973 Error detected in line 14
33974 .endd
33975 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
33976 file, for example:
33977 .code
33978 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
33979 The error message was:
33980
33981 501 '>' missing at end of address
33982
33983 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
33984 The error was detected in line 12.
33985 The SMTP command at fault was:
33986
33987 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
33988
33989 1 previous message was successfully processed.
33990 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
33991 .endd
33992 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
33993 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
33994 accepted.
33995 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
33996 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
33997
33998
33999
34000 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34001 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34002
34003 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34004 "Customizing messages"
34005 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34006 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34007 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34008 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34009 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34010
34011 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34012 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34013 option. Exim also adds the line
34014 .code
34015 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34016 .endd
34017 to all warning and bounce messages,
34018
34019
34020 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34021 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34022 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34023 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34024 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34025 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34026 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34027
34028 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34029 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34030 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34031 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34032 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34033 item.
34034
34035 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34036 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34037 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34038 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34039 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34040 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34041 option, rounded to a whole number.
34042
34043 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34044
34045 .ilist
34046 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34047 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34048 .next
34049 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34050 failing addresses with their error messages.
34051 .next
34052 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34053 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34054 .next
34055 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34056 The fields exist for back-compatibility
34057 .endlist
34058
34059 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34060 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34061 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34062 .code
34063 Subject: Mail delivery failed
34064 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34065 {: returning message to sender}}
34066 ****
34067 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34068
34069 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34070 {that you sent }{sent by
34071
34072 <$sender_address>
34073
34074 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34075 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34076 ****
34077 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34078 ****
34079 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34080 ------
34081 ****
34082 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34083 only the first
34084 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34085 ****
34086 .endd
34087 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34088 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34089 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34090 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34091 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34092 text sections:
34093
34094 .ilist
34095 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34096 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34097 .next
34098 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34099 the delayed addresses.
34100 .next
34101 The third item then ends the message.
34102 .endlist
34103
34104 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34105 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34106 .code
34107 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34108 $warn_message_delay
34109 ****
34110 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34111
34112 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34113 {that you sent }{sent by
34114
34115 <$sender_address>
34116
34117 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34118 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34119
34120 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34121 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34122 The date of the message is: $h_date
34123
34124 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34125 ****
34126 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34127 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34128 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34129 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34130 the message will be returned to you.
34131 .endd
34132 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34133 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34134 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34135 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34136 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34137 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34138 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34139 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34140 handled them.
34141
34142
34143
34144
34145 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34146 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34147
34148 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34149 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34150 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34151
34152
34153
34154 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34155 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34156 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34157 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34158 routing explicitly:
34159 .code
34160 send_to_smart_host:
34161 driver = manualroute
34162 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34163 transport = remote_smtp
34164 .endd
34165 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34166 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34167 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34168 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34169 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34170
34171
34172
34173
34174 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34175 .cindex "mailing lists"
34176 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34177 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34178 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34179
34180 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34181 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34182 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34183 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34184 .code
34185 lists:
34186 driver = redirect
34187 domains = lists.example
34188 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34189 forbid_pipe
34190 forbid_file
34191 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34192 no_more
34193 .endd
34194 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34195 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34196 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34197 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34198
34199 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34200 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34201 a mailing list.
34202
34203 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34204 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34205 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34206 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34207 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34208
34209 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34210 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34211 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34212 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34213 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34214 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34215 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34216 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34217 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34218
34219
34220
34221 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34222 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34223 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34224 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34225 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34226 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34227 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34228
34229 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34230 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34231 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34232 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34233 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34234
34235
34236
34237 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34238 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34239 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34240 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34241 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34242 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34243 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34244 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34245 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34246 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34247
34248 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34249 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34250 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34251 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34252 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34253 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34254 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34255 pre-existing messages.
34256
34257 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34258 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34259 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34260 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34261 one level of expansion anyway.
34262
34263
34264
34265 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34266 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34267 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34268 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34269 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34270 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34271
34272 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34273 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34274 .code
34275 lists_request:
34276 driver = redirect
34277 domains = lists.example
34278 local_part_suffix = -request
34279 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34280 no_more
34281
34282 lists_post:
34283 driver = redirect
34284 domains = lists.example
34285 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34286 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34287 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34288 forbid_pipe
34289 forbid_file
34290 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34291 no_more
34292
34293 lists_closed:
34294 driver = redirect
34295 domains = lists.example
34296 allow_fail
34297 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34298 .endd
34299 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34300 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34301 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34302 mailing list.
34303
34304 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34305 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34306 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34307 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34308 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34309 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34310 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34311 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34312 &"unrouteable address"& error.
34313
34314 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34315 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34316 the address, giving a suitable error message.
34317
34318
34319
34320
34321 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34322 .cindex "VERP"
34323 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34324 .cindex "envelope sender"
34325 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34326 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34327 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34328 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34329 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34330 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34331
34332 .oindex &%errors_to%&
34333 .oindex &%return_path%&
34334 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34335 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34336 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34337 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34338 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34339 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34340 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34341 .code
34342 verp_smtp:
34343 driver = smtp
34344 max_rcpt = 1
34345 return_path = \
34346 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34347 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34348 .endd
34349 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34350 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34351 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34352 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34353 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34354 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34355 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34356 rewritten as
34357 .code
34358 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34359 .endd
34360 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34361 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34362 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34363 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34364 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34365 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34366
34367 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34368 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34369 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34370 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34371 .code
34372 dnslookup:
34373 driver = dnslookup
34374 domains = ! +local_domains
34375 transport = \
34376 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34377 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34378 no_more
34379 .endd
34380 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34381 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34382 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34383 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34384 address.
34385
34386 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34387 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34388 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34389 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34390 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34391 .code
34392 verp_dnslookup:
34393 driver = dnslookup
34394 domains = ! +local_domains
34395 transport = remote_smtp
34396 errors_to = \
34397 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34398 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34399 no_more
34400 .endd
34401 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34402 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34403 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34404 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34405 them.
34406
34407 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34408 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34409 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34410 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34411 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34412 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34413 used).
34414
34415
34416
34417
34418
34419
34420 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34421 .cindex "virtual domains"
34422 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
34423 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34424 meanings:
34425
34426 .ilist
34427 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34428 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34429 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34430 .next
34431 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34432 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34433 have login accounts on that host.
34434 .endlist
34435
34436 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34437 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34438 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34439 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34440 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34441 to a router of this form:
34442 .code
34443 virtual:
34444 driver = redirect
34445 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34446 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34447 no_more
34448 .endd
34449 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34450 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34451 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34452 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34453 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34454 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34455
34456 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34457 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34458 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34459 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34460
34461 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34462 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34463 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34464 .code
34465 my_domains:
34466 driver = accept
34467 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34468 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34469 transport = my_mailboxes
34470 .endd
34471 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34472 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34473 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34474 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34475 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34476 follows:
34477 .code
34478 my_mailboxes:
34479 driver = appendfile
34480 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34481 user = mail
34482 .endd
34483 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34484 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34485
34486 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34487 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34488 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34489 information about the domains.
34490
34491
34492
34493 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34494 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34495 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34496 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
34497 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
34498 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34499 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34500 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34501 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34502 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34503 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34504 example, consider this router:
34505 .code
34506 userforward:
34507 driver = redirect
34508 check_local_user
34509 file = $home/.forward
34510 local_part_suffix = -*
34511 local_part_suffix_optional
34512 allow_filter
34513 .endd
34514 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34515 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34516 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34517 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34518 .code
34519 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34520 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34521 endif
34522 .endd
34523 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34524 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34525 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34526 control over which suffixes are valid.
34527
34528 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34529 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34530 another MTA:
34531 .code
34532 userforward:
34533 driver = redirect
34534 check_local_user
34535 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34536 local_part_suffix = -*
34537 local_part_suffix_optional
34538 allow_filter
34539 .endd
34540 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34541 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34542 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34543 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34544 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34545
34546
34547
34548 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34549 .cindex "vacation processing"
34550 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34551 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34552 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34553 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34554 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34555
34556 .ilist
34557 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34558 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34559 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34560 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34561 .code
34562 spqr, vacation-spqr
34563 .endd
34564 .next
34565 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34566 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34567 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34568 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34569 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34570 message.
34571 .endlist
34572
34573 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34574 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34575
34576
34577
34578 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34579 .cindex "message" "copying every"
34580 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34581 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34582 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34583 each day's messages.
34584
34585 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34586 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34587 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34588 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34589
34590
34591
34592 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34593 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34594 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34595 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34596 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34597 permanently connected.
34598
34599 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34600 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34601 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34602
34603
34604 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34605 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34606 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34607 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34608 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34609 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34610 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34611 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34612
34613 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34614 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34615 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34616 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34617 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34618 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34619 if required.
34620
34621 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34622 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34623 intermittent host. For example:
34624 .code
34625 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34626 .endd
34627 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34628 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34629 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34630 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34631 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34632 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34633 immediately.
34634
34635 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34636 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34637 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34638 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34639 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34640 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34641 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34642
34643
34644
34645 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34646 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34647 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34648 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34649 delivered immediately.
34650
34651 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34652 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34653 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34654 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34655 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34656 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34657 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34658 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34659 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34660 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34661 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34662 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34663 single SMTP connection.
34664
34665
34666
34667 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34668 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34669
34670 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34671 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34672 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
34673 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34674 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34675 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34676 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34677 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34678 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34679 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34680 messages this way.
34681
34682 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34683 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34684 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34685 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34686 email is not desirable.
34687
34688 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34689 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34690 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34691 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34692 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34693 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34694 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34695
34696 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34697 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34698 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34699 before sending a message to the smart host.
34700
34701 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34702 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34703 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34704
34705 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34706 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34707 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34708 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34709 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34710 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34711 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34712
34713 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34714 following ways:
34715
34716 .ilist
34717 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34718 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34719 .next
34720 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34721 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34722 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34723 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34724 successful, a zero return code is given.
34725 .next
34726 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34727 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34728 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34729 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34730 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34731 are.
34732 .next
34733 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34734 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34735 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34736 .next
34737 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34738 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34739 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34740 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34741 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34742 .next
34743 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34744 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34745 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34746 .next
34747 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34748 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34749 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34750 are ever generated.
34751 .next
34752 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34753 .next
34754 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34755 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34756 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34757 .endlist
34758
34759 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34760 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34761 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34762 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34763 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34764 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34765
34766
34767
34768
34769 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34770 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34771
34772 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34773 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34774 .cindex "log" "types of"
34775 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34776 and the panic log:
34777
34778 .ilist
34779 .cindex "main log"
34780 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34781 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34782 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34783 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34784 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34785 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34786 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34787 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34788 .next
34789 .cindex "reject log"
34790 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34791 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34792 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34793 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34794 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34795 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34796 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34797 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34798 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34799 false.
34800 .next
34801 .cindex "panic log"
34802 .cindex "system log"
34803 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34804 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34805 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34806 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34807 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34808 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34809 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34810 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34811 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34812 .endlist
34813
34814 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34815 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34816 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34817 .code
34818 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34819 by QUIT
34820 .endd
34821 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34822 ways of changing this:
34823
34824 .ilist
34825 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34826 you set
34827 .code
34828 timezone = UTC
34829 .endd
34830 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34831 .next
34832 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34833 example:
34834 .code
34835 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34836 .endd
34837 .endlist
34838
34839 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34840 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34841 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34842 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34843 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34844 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34845
34846
34847
34848
34849 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34850 .cindex "log" "destination"
34851 .cindex "log" "to file"
34852 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
34853 .cindex "syslog"
34854 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34855 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34856 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34857 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34858 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34859 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34860 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34861
34862 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34863 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34864 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34865 references to the host name:
34866 .code
34867 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34868 .endd
34869 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34870 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34871 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34872 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34873 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34874 log at all.
34875
34876 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34877 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34878 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34879 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34880 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34881 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34882 implying the use of a default path.
34883
34884 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34885 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34886 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34887 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34888 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34889 equivalent to the setting:
34890 .code
34891 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34892 .endd
34893 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
34894 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
34895 that is where the logs are written.
34896
34897 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34898 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34899
34900 Here are some examples of possible settings:
34901 .display
34902 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34903 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34904 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34905 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34906 .endd
34907 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34908 error is logged.
34909
34910
34911
34912 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34913 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34914 .cindex "cycling logs"
34915 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34916 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34917 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34918 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34919 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34920 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34921 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34922
34923 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34924 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34925 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34926 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34927 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34928 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34929 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34930 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34931 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34932 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34933 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34934 renamed.
34935
34936
34937
34938 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34939 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34940 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34941 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34942 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34943 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34944 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
34945 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
34946 .code
34947 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
34948 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
34949 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
34950 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
34951 .endd
34952 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
34953 examples of names generated by the above examples:
34954 .code
34955 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
34956 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
34957 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
34958 /var/log/exim/main.200212
34959 .endd
34960 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
34961 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
34962 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
34963 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
34964
34965 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
34966 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
34967 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
34968 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
34969 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
34970 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
34971 log names:
34972 .code
34973 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34974 /var/log/exim-panic.log
34975 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34976 /var/log/exim/panic
34977 .endd
34978
34979
34980 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
34981 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
34982 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
34983 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
34984 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
34985 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
34986 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
34987 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
34988 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
34989 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
34990 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
34991 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
34992 the time and host name to each line.
34993 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
34994
34995 .ilist
34996 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
34997 .next
34998 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
34999 .next
35000 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35001 .endlist
35002
35003 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35004 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35005 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35006 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35007
35008 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35009 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35010 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35011 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35012 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35013 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35014 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35015 RFC 3164, you should set
35016 .code
35017 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35018 .endd
35019 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35020 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35021
35022 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35023 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35024 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35025 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35026 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35027 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35028 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35029 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35030 name, and pid as added by syslog:
35031 .code
35032 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35033 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35034 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35035 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35036 [5/5] mple>)
35037 .endd
35038 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35039 (LOG_NOTICE):
35040 .code
35041 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35042 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35043 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35044 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35045 [5\18] .example>)
35046 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35047 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35048 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35049 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35050 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35051 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
35052 [12\18] F From: <>
35053 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35054 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
35055 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35056 [16\18] le>
35057 [17\18] B Bcc:
35058 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35059 .endd
35060 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35061 without modification.
35062
35063 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35064 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35065 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35066 where it is.
35067
35068
35069
35070 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35071 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35072 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35073 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35074 timestamp. The flags are:
35075 .display
35076 &`<=`& message arrival
35077 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35078 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35079 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35080 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35081 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35082 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35083 .endd
35084
35085
35086 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35087 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35088 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35089 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35090 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35091 .code
35092 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35093 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35094 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35095 .endd
35096 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35097 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35098 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35099 .code
35100 R=<message id>
35101 .endd
35102 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35103
35104 .cindex "HELO"
35105 .cindex "EHLO"
35106 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35107 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35108 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35109 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35110 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35111 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35112 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35113 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35114 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35115 name in parentheses.
35116
35117 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35118 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35119 the log containing text like these examples:
35120 .code
35121 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35122 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35123 .endd
35124 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35125 on.
35126
35127 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35128 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35129 of Exim.
35130
35131 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35132 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35133 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35134 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35135 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35136 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35137 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35138 suite that was used.
35139
35140 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35141 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35142 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35143 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35144 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35145 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35146 authenticator name.
35147
35148 .cindex "size" "of message"
35149 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35150 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35151 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35152 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35153 other).
35154
35155 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35156 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35157
35158
35159
35160 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35161 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35162 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35163 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35164 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
35165 to fit it on the page:
35166 .code
35167 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35168 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35169 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35170 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35171 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35172 .endd
35173 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35174 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35175 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35176 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35177 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35178
35179 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35180 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35181 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35182 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35183
35184 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35185 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35186 .display
35187 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35188 .endd
35189 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35190 parentheses afterwards.
35191
35192 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35193 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35194 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35195 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35196 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35197 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35198
35199 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35200 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35201 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35202 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35203 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35204
35205 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35206 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35207
35208 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35209 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35210
35211
35212 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35213 .cindex "discarded messages"
35214 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35215 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35216 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35217 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35218 .code
35219 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35220 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35221 .endd
35222 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35223 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35224 .code
35225 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35226 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35227 .endd
35228
35229
35230 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35231 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35232 .code
35233 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35234 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35235 .endd
35236 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35237 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35238 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35239 .code
35240 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35241 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35242 .endd
35243 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35244 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35245 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35246
35247
35248
35249 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35250 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35251 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35252 following form is logged:
35253 .code
35254 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35255 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35256 .endd
35257 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35258 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35259 .code
35260 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35261 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35262 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35263 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35264 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35265 .endd
35266 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35267 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35268 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35269 flagged with &`**`&.
35270
35271
35272
35273 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35274 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35275 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35276 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35277 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35278
35279
35280
35281 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
35282 A line of the form
35283 .code
35284 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35285 .endd
35286 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35287 at the end of its processing.
35288
35289
35290
35291
35292 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35293 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35294 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35295 the following table:
35296 .display
35297 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35298 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35299 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35300 &`CV `& certificate verification status
35301 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35302 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35303 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35304 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35305 &`H `& host name and IP address
35306 &`I `& local interface used
35307 &`id `& message id for incoming message
35308 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35309 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35310 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35311 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35312 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35313 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35314 &`S `& size of message
35315 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35316 &`ST `& shadow transport name
35317 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35318 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35319 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35320 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
35321 .endd
35322
35323
35324 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35325 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35326 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35327
35328 .ilist
35329 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35330 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35331 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35332 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35333 during the first delivery attempt.
35334 .next
35335 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35336 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35337 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35338 .next
35339 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35340 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35341 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35342 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35343 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35344 doing.
35345 .next
35346 .cindex "error" "ignored"
35347 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35348 message:
35349 .olist
35350 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35351 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35352 .next
35353 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35354 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35355 .next
35356 A delivery set up by a router configured with
35357 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35358 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35359 .code
35360 errors_to = <>
35361 .endd
35362 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35363 .endlist olist
35364 .endlist ilist
35365
35366
35367
35368
35369
35370 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35371 .cindex "log" "selectors"
35372 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35373 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35374 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35375 example:
35376 .code
35377 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35378 .endd
35379 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35380 selection marked by asterisks:
35381 .display
35382 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35383 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35384 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35385 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35386 &` arguments `& command line arguments
35387 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35388 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35389 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35390 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35391 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35392 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35393 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35394 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35395 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35396 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35397 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35398 .new
35399 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
35400 .wen
35401 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35402 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35403 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35404 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35405 &` pid `& Exim process id
35406 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35407 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35408 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35409 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35410 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35411 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35412 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35413 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35414 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35415 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35416 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
35417 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35418 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35419 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35420 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35421 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35422 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35423 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35424 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35425 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35426 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35427 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35428
35429 &` all `& all of the above
35430 .endd
35431 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
35432 section &<<SECID99>>&
35433
35434 More details on each of these items follows:
35435
35436 .ilist
35437 .cindex "8BITMIME"
35438 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35439 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35440 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35441 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35442 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35443 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35444 .next
35445 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35446 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35447 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35448 this log selector is set.
35449 .next
35450 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
35451 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35452 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35453 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35454 such users cannot access the log).
35455 .next
35456 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
35457 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35458 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35459 parentheses between them.
35460 .next
35461 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35462 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35463 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35464 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35465 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35466 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35467 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35468 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35469 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35470 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35471 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35472 between the caller and Exim.
35473 .next
35474 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35475 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35476 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35477 .next
35478 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35479 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35480 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35481 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35482 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35483 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35484 .next
35485 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35486 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35487 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35488 .next
35489 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35490 .cindex "size" "of message"
35491 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35492 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35493 .next
35494 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35495 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35496 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
35497 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35498 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35499 .next
35500 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35501 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35502 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35503 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35504 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35505 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35506 .next
35507 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35508 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35509 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35510 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35511 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35512 .next
35513 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35514 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35515 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35516 client's ident port times out.
35517 .next
35518 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35519 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35520 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35521 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35522 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35523 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35524 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35525 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35526 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
35527 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
35528 .new
35529 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35530 .wen
35531 .next
35532 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35533 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
35534 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35535 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35536 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35537 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35538 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35539 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35540 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35541 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35542 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35543 .next
35544 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35545 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35546 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35547 .next
35548 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
35549 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35550 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35551 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35552 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35553 .new
35554 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
35555 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
35556 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
35557 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35558 .wen
35559 .next
35560 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35561 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35562 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35563 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35564 containing => tags) following the IP address.
35565 .new
35566 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
35567 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
35568 .wen
35569 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
35570 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
35571 local port is a random ephemeral port.
35572 .next
35573 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35574 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35575 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35576 immediately after the time and date.
35577 .next
35578 .cindex "log" "queue run"
35579 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35580 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35581 .next
35582 .cindex "log" "queue time"
35583 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35584 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35585 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35586 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35587 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35588 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35589 message has been successfully received.
35590 .next
35591 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35592 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35593 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35594 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35595 .next
35596 .cindex "log" "recipients"
35597 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35598 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35599 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35600 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35601 has taken place.
35602 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35603 in the list.
35604 .next
35605 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
35606 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35607 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35608 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35609 .next
35610 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35611 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35612 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35613 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35614 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35615 .next
35616 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
35617 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35618 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35619 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35620 attempt.
35621 .next
35622 .cindex "log" "return path"
35623 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35624 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35625 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35626 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35627 .next
35628 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35629 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35630 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35631 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35632 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35633 .next
35634 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35635 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35636 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35637 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35638 detail is lost.
35639 .next
35640 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
35641 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35642 it is too big.
35643 .next
35644 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35645 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35646 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35647 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35648 it.
35649 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35650 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35651 .next
35652 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35653 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35654 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35655 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35656 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35657 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35658 response.
35659 .next
35660 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35661 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35662 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
35663 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35664 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35665 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35666 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35667 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35668 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
35669 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
35670
35671 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
35672 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35673 reset if the daemon is restarted.
35674 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35675 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35676 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35677 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35678 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35679 .next
35680 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35681 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35682 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35683 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35684 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35685 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35686 .next
35687 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35688 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35689 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35690 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35691 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35692 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35693 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35694 already have their own log lines.
35695
35696 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35697 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35698 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35699 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35700 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35701 the same logging options.
35702
35703 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35704 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35705 .code
35706 C=EHLO,QUIT
35707 .endd
35708 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35709 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35710 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35711 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35712 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35713 .next
35714 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35715 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35716 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35717 was accepted or used.
35718 .next
35719 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35720 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35721 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35722 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35723 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35724 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35725 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35726 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35727 .next
35728 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35729 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35730 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35731 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35732 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35733 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35734 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35735 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35736 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35737 .next
35738 .cindex "log" "subject"
35739 .cindex "subject, logging"
35740 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35741 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35742 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35743 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35744 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35745 .next
35746 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35747 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35748 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35749 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35750 .next
35751 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35752 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35753 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35754 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35755 .next
35756 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35757 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35758 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35759 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35760 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35761 .next
35762 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35763 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35764 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35765 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35766 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35767 .next
35768 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35769 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35770 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35771 .endlist
35772
35773
35774 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
35775 .cindex "message" "log file for"
35776 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35777 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35778 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35779 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35780 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35781 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35782 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35783 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35784 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35785 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35786 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35787
35788 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35789 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35790 &%message_logs%& option false.
35791 .ecindex IIDloggen
35792
35793
35794
35795
35796 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35797 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35798
35799 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35800 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35801 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35802 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35803 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35804
35805 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35806 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35807 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35808 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35809 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35810 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35811 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35812 various criteria"
35813 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35814 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35815 "extract statistics from the log"
35816 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35817 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35818 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35819 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35820 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35821 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35822 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35823 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35824 .endtable
35825
35826 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35827 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35828 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35829
35830
35831
35832
35833 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35834 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35835 .cindex "process, querying"
35836 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
35837 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35838 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35839 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35840 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35841 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35842 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35843 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35844 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35845
35846 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35847 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35848 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35849
35850
35851 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35852 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35853 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35854 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35855 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35856 options:
35857 .display
35858 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35859 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35860 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35861 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35862 .endd
35863 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35864 .code
35865 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
35866 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
35867 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35868 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
35869 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
35870 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35871 .endd
35872 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35873 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35874
35875
35876
35877 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35878 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35879 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
35880 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35881 .code
35882 exim -bpu
35883 .endd
35884 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35885 .code
35886 exim -bp
35887 .endd
35888 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35889 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35890
35891 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35892 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35893
35894 .vlist
35895 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35896 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35897 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35898 .code
35899 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
35900 .endd
35901 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35902 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35903 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35904
35905 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35906 Match against the size field.
35907
35908 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35909 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35910
35911 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35912 Match messages that are older than the given time.
35913
35914 .vitem &*-z*&
35915 Match only frozen messages.
35916
35917 .vitem &*-x*&
35918 Match only non-frozen messages.
35919 .endlist
35920
35921 The following options control the format of the output:
35922
35923 .vlist
35924 .vitem &*-c*&
35925 Display only the count of matching messages.
35926
35927 .vitem &*-l*&
35928 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35929 the default.
35930
35931 .vitem &*-i*&
35932 Display message ids only.
35933
35934 .vitem &*-b*&
35935 Brief format &-- one line per message.
35936
35937 .vitem &*-R*&
35938 Display messages in reverse order.
35939
35940 .vitem &*-a*&
35941 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35942 .endlist
35943
35944 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35945
35946
35947
35948 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35949 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35950 .cindex "queue" "summary"
35951 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35952 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35953 running a command such as
35954 .code
35955 exim -bp | exiqsumm
35956 .endd
35957 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35958 it, as in the following example:
35959 .code
35960 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
35961 .endd
35962 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
35963 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
35964 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
35965 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
35966
35967 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
35968 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
35969 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
35970 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
35971 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
35972 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
35973 sender.
35974
35975 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
35976 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
35977 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
35978 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
35979 level"& addresses).
35980
35981
35982
35983
35984 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
35985 "SECTextspeinf"
35986 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
35987 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
35988 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
35989 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
35990 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
35991 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
35992 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
35993 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
35994 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
35995 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
35996 .display
35997 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
35998 .endd
35999 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36000
36001 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36002 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36003 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36004
36005 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36006 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36007 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36008 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36009 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36010
36011 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36012 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36013 regular expression.
36014
36015 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36016 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36017
36018 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36019 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36020 normally.
36021
36022 Example of &%-M%&:
36023 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36024 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36025 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36026 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36027 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36028 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36029 search term.
36030
36031 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36032 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36033 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36034 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36035 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36036
36037
36038 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36039 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
36040 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36041 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36042 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
36043 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
36044 the &%--help%& option.
36045
36046
36047 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36048 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36049 .cindex "cycling logs"
36050 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36051 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36052 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36053 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36054 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36055 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36056 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36057 .ilist
36058 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36059 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36060 .next
36061 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36062 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36063 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36064 configuration.
36065 .endlist
36066
36067 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36068 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36069 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36070 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36071 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36072 logs are handled similarly.
36073
36074 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36075 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36076 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36077 any existing log files.
36078
36079 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36080 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36081 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36082 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36083 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36084 .code
36085 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36086 .endd
36087 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36088 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36089
36090
36091
36092 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36093 .cindex "statistics"
36094 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36095 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36096 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36097 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36098 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36099
36100 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36101 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36102 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36103 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36104 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36105 .code
36106 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36107 .endd
36108 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36109 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36110 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36111 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36112 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36113 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36114 also produced per user.
36115
36116 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36117 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36118 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36119 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36120 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36121
36122 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36123 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36124 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36125 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36126 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36127 an entirely separate message.
36128
36129 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36130 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36131 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36132 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36133 least one address that failed.
36134
36135 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36136 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36137 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36138 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36139 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36140 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36141 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36142
36143 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36144 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36145 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36146
36147 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36148 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36149 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36150 .code
36151 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36152 .endd
36153
36154 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36155 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36156 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36157 .cindex "checking access"
36158 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36159 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36160 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36161 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36162 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36163 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36164
36165 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36166 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36167 .code
36168 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36169 .endd
36170 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36171 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36172 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36173 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36174 .code
36175 Rejected:
36176 550 Relay not permitted
36177 .endd
36178 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36179 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36180 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36181 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36182 you can use:
36183 .code
36184 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36185 -f himself@there.example
36186 .endd
36187 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36188 mandatory arguments.
36189
36190 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36191 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36192 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36193
36194
36195
36196 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36197 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36198 .cindex "building DBM files"
36199 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36200 .cindex "lower casing"
36201 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36202 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36203 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36204 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36205 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36206 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36207
36208 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36209 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36210 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36211 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36212 files.
36213
36214 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36215 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36216 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36217 well.
36218
36219 .cindex "USE_DB"
36220 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36221 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36222 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36223 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36224 .code
36225 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36226 .endd
36227 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36228 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36229
36230 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36231 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36232 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36233 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36234 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36235 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36236
36237 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36238 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36239 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36240 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36241 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36242 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36243 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36244 return code is 2.
36245
36246
36247
36248
36249 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36250 .cindex "retry" "times"
36251 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
36252 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36253 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36254 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36255 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36256 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36257 output. For example:
36258 .code
36259 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36260 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36261 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36262 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36263 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36264 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36265 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36266 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36267 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36268 past final cutoff time
36269 .endd
36270 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36271 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36272 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36273 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36274 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36275 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36276 run very often.
36277
36278 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36279 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36280 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36281 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36282 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36283 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36284
36285
36286
36287 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36288 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36289 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36290 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36291 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36292 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36293 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36294
36295 .ilist
36296 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
36297 .next
36298 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36299 for remote hosts
36300 .next
36301 &'callout'&: the callout cache
36302 .next
36303 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36304 .next
36305 &'misc'&: other hints data
36306 .endlist
36307
36308 The &'misc'& database is used for
36309
36310 .ilist
36311 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36312 .next
36313 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36314 &(smtp)& transport)
36315 .next
36316 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
36317 in a transport)
36318 .endlist
36319
36320
36321
36322 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36323 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36324 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36325 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36326 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36327 .code
36328 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36329 .endd
36330 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36331 .code
36332 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
36333 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36334 .endd
36335 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36336 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36337 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36338 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36339 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36340 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36341 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36342 and a textual description of the error.
36343
36344 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36345 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36346 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36347 exceeded.
36348
36349 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36350 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36351 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36352 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36353 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36354 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36355 cross-references.
36356
36357
36358
36359 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36360 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36361 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36362 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36363 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36364 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36365 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36366 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36367 updated sufficiently often.
36368
36369 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36370 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36371 the retry database:
36372 .code
36373 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36374 .endd
36375 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36376 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36377 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36378 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36379 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36380 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36381 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36382 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36383 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36384 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36385 whenever it removes information from the database.
36386
36387 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36388 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36389 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36390 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36391 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36392
36393 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36394 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36395 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36396 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36397 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36398 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36399 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36400 tidied.
36401
36402 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36403 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36404
36405
36406
36407
36408 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36409 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36410 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36411 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36412 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36413 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36414 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36415 displayed.
36416
36417 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36418 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36419 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36420 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36421 by new data, for example:
36422 .code
36423 > 4 951102:1000
36424 .endd
36425 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36426 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36427 used as optional separators.
36428
36429
36430
36431
36432 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36433 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36434 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36435 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
36436 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36437 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36438 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36439 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36440 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36441 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36442 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36443 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36444 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36445
36446 .vlist
36447 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
36448 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36449
36450 .vitem &%-flock%&
36451 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36452 supports it.
36453
36454 .vitem &%-interval%&
36455 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36456 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36457
36458 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
36459 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36460
36461 .vitem &%-mbx%&
36462 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36463
36464 .vitem &%-q%&
36465 Suppress verification output.
36466
36467 .vitem &%-retries%&
36468 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36469 the lock (default 10).
36470
36471 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
36472 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36473 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36474 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36475 subsequently sees.
36476
36477 .vitem &%-timeout%&
36478 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36479 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36480 default), a non-blocking call is used.
36481
36482 .vitem &%-v%&
36483 Generate verbose output.
36484 .endlist
36485
36486 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36487 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36488 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36489 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36490 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36491 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36492 more than 30 minutes old.
36493
36494 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36495 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36496 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36497 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36498 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36499 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36500
36501 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36502 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36503 suppresses all output except error messages.
36504
36505 A command such as
36506 .code
36507 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36508 .endd
36509 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36510 .display
36511 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36512 <&'some commands'&>
36513 &`End`&
36514 .endd
36515 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36516 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36517 such as
36518 .code
36519 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36520 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36521 .endd
36522 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36523 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36524 .ecindex IIDutils
36525
36526
36527 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36528 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36529
36530 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36531 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36532 .cindex "X-windows"
36533 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
36534 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36535 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36536 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36537 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36538 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36539 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36540 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36541
36542
36543
36544 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36545 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36546 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36547 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36548 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36549 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36550 parameters are for.
36551
36552 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36553 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36554 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36555 .code
36556 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36557 .endd
36558 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36559 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36560 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36561 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36562 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36563
36564 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36565 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36566 .code
36567 Eximon*background: gray94
36568 .endd
36569 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36570 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36571 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36572 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36573 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36574 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36575 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36576 .code
36577 xrdb -merge <<End
36578 Eximon*highlight: gray
36579 End
36580 .endd
36581 .cindex "admin user"
36582 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36583 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36584
36585 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36586 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36587 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36588 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36589 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36590
36591 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36592 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36593 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36594 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36595 different parts of the display.
36596
36597
36598
36599
36600 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36601 .cindex "stripchart"
36602 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36603 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36604 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36605 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36606 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36607 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36608 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36609 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36610 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36611
36612 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36613 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36614 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36615 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36616
36617 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36618 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36619 to a single partition.
36620
36621 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36622 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36623 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36624 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36625 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36626 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36627 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36628
36629
36630
36631
36632 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36633 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36634 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36635 .cindex "window size"
36636 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36637 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36638 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36639 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36640 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36641 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36642
36643 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36644 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36645 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36646 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36647
36648 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36649 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36650 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36651 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36652 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36653 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36654
36655 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36656 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36657 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36658
36659
36660
36661 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
36662 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36663 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36664 the main log is maintained.
36665 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36666 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36667 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36668 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
36669 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
36670
36671 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
36672 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
36673 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36674 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36675 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36676 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36677 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36678 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36679 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36680 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36681 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36682
36683 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36684 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36685 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36686 It cannot go further back up the log.
36687
36688 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36689 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36690 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36691 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36692 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36693 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36694
36695 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36696 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36697 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36698 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36699 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36700 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36701
36702 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36703 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36704 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36705 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36706 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36707 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36708 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36709 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36710 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36711 window.
36712
36713
36714
36715 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36716 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36717 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36718 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36719 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36720 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36721 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36722 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36723 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36724 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36725
36726 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36727 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36728 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36729 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36730 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36731 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36732 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36733
36734 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36735 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36736 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36737 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36738 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36739 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36740 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36741
36742 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36743 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36744 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36745 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36746
36747 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36748 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36749 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36750 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36751 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36752 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36753 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36754 not shown.
36755
36756 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36757 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36758
36759 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36760 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36761 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36762 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36763 display is updated.
36764
36765
36766
36767 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36768 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36769 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36770 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36771 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36772 any selected text.
36773
36774 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36775 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36776 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36777 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36778 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36779 .code
36780 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36781 .endd
36782 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36783 follows:
36784
36785 .ilist
36786 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36787 in a new text window.
36788 .next
36789 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36790 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36791 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36792 .next
36793 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36794 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36795 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36796 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36797 .next
36798 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36799 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36800 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36801 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36802 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36803 .next
36804 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36805 that the message be frozen.
36806 .next
36807 .cindex "thawing messages"
36808 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
36809 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36810 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36811 that the message be thawed.
36812 .next
36813 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36814 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36815 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36816 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36817 .next
36818 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36819 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36820 message.
36821 .next
36822 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36823 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36824 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36825 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36826 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36827 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36828 which case no action is taken.
36829 .next
36830 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36831 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36832 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36833 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36834 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36835 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36836 case no action is taken.
36837 .next
36838 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36839 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36840 .next
36841 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36842 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36843 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36844 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36845 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36846 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36847 the address is qualified with that domain.
36848 .endlist
36849
36850 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36851 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36852 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36853 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36854 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36855 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36856 if no output is generated.
36857
36858 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36859 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36860 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36861 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36862
36863 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36864 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36865 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36866 .ecindex IIDeximon
36867
36868
36869
36870
36871
36872 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36873 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36874
36875 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36876 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36877 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36878 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36879
36880 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36881 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36882 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36883 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36884 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36885 its security as compared with other MTAs.
36886
36887 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36888 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36889 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36890 as soon as possible.
36891
36892
36893 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36894 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
36895 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36896 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36897 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36898 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36899
36900 .ilist
36901 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36902 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36903 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36904 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36905 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36906 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36907
36908 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36909 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36910 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36911 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36912 .next
36913
36914 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36915 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36916 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36917 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36918 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36919 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36920 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36921 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36922 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36923 separate commands.
36924
36925 .next
36926 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36927 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36928 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36929 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36930 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36931 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36932 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36933 .next
36934 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36935 is disabled.
36936 .next
36937 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36938 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36939 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36940 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36941 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36942 .endlist
36943
36944
36945
36946 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36947 .cindex "setuid"
36948 .cindex "root privilege"
36949 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36950 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36951 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36952 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36953 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36954 is required for two things:
36955
36956 .ilist
36957 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36958 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36959 not required.
36960 .next
36961 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
36962 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
36963 configuration.
36964 .endlist
36965
36966 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
36967 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
36968 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
36969 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
36970 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
36971 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
36972 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
36973 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
36974
36975 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
36976 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
36977 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
36978
36979 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
36980 uid and gid in the following cases:
36981
36982 .ilist
36983 .oindex "&%-C%&"
36984 .oindex "&%-D%&"
36985 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
36986 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
36987 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
36988 the calling process.
36989 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
36990 option may not be used at all.
36991 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
36992 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
36993 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
36994 .next
36995 .oindex "&%-be%&"
36996 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
36997 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
36998 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
36999 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37000 calling process.
37001 .next
37002 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37003 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37004 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37005 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37006 testing address verification
37007 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
37008 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
37009 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37010 option).
37011 .next
37012 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37013 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37014 .endlist
37015
37016 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37017
37018 .ilist
37019 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37020 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37021 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37022 will be used during message reception.
37023 .next
37024 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37025 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37026 .next
37027 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37028 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37029 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37030 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37031 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37032 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37033 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37034 generating bounce and warning messages.
37035
37036 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37037 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37038 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37039 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37040 .next
37041 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37042 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37043 .endlist
37044
37045
37046
37047
37048 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37049 .cindex "privilege, running without"
37050 .cindex "unprivileged running"
37051 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37052 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37053 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37054 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37055 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37056 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37057 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37058 to any other uid.
37059
37060 .cindex SIGHUP
37061 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37062 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37063 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37064 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37065
37066 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37067 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37068 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37069 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37070 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37071
37072 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37073 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37074 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37075 effect.
37076
37077 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37078 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37079 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37080
37081 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37082 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37083 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37084 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37085 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37086 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37087 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37088 address this problem at this time.
37089
37090 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37091 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37092 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37093 be used in the most straightforward way.
37094
37095 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37096 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37097
37098 .ilist
37099 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37100 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37101 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37102 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37103 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37104 .next
37105 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37106 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37107 .next
37108 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37109 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37110 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37111 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37112 .next
37113 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37114 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37115
37116 .olist
37117 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37118 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37119 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37120 .next
37121 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37122 owned by the Exim user.
37123 .next
37124 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37125 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37126 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37127 .endlist olist
37128 .endlist ilist
37129
37130
37131 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37132 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37133 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37134 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37135
37136 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37137 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37138
37139
37140
37141
37142 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37143 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37144 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37145
37146
37147
37148 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37149 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37150 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37151 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37152 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37153 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37154 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37155
37156 .ilist
37157 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37158 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37159 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37160 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37161 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37162 .next
37163 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37164 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37165 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37166 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37167 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37168 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37169 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37170 .next
37171 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37172 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37173 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37174 .next
37175 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37176 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37177 .next
37178 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37179 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37180 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37181 .next
37182 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37183 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37184 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37185 of opaque strings.
37186 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37187 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37188 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37189 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37190 .endlist
37191
37192
37193
37194
37195 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37196 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37197 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37198 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37199 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37200 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37201 are some issues to be aware of:
37202
37203 .ilist
37204 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37205 .next
37206 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37207 .next
37208 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37209 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37210 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37211 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37212 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37213 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37214 data.
37215 .next
37216 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37217 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37218 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37219 .next
37220 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37221 expected to yield one result.
37222 .endlist
37223
37224
37225
37226
37227 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37228 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37229 .cindex "IP source routing"
37230 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37231 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37232 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37233 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37234
37235
37236
37237 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37238 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37239 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37240
37241
37242
37243
37244 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37245 .cindex "trusted users"
37246 .cindex "admin user"
37247 .cindex "privileged user"
37248 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37249 .cindex "user" "admin"
37250 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37251 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37252 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37253 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37254 permit a remote host to be specified.
37255
37256 .oindex "&%-f%&"
37257 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37258 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37259 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37260 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37261 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37262 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37263
37264 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37265 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37266 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37267 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37268 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37269
37270 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37271 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37272 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37273 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37274 includes the contents of files on the spool.
37275
37276 .oindex "&%-M%&"
37277 .oindex "&%-q%&"
37278 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37279 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37280 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37281 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37282 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37283 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37284
37285 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37286 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37287 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37288 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37289 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37290 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37291 files.
37292
37293
37294
37295 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37296 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
37297 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37298 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37299 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37300 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37301
37302
37303
37304 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37305 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37306 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37307 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37308 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37309 this.
37310
37311
37312
37313 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37314 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37315 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37316 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37317 converted output.
37318
37319
37320
37321 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37322 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37323 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37324 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37325 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37326
37327
37328
37329 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37330 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37331 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37332 loading it.
37333
37334
37335 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37336 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37337 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37338 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37339 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37340 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37341 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37342
37343 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37344 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37345 string.
37346
37347
37348
37349 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37350 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37351 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37352 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37353
37354
37355
37356 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37357 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37358 enough to hold the result.
37359 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
37360
37361
37362
37363
37364 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37365 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37366
37367 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37368 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37369 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37370 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37371 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
37372 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37373 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37374 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37375 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37376 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37377 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37378 themselves are recoverable.
37379
37380 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37381 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37382 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37383
37384 .ilist
37385 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37386 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37387 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37388 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37389 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37390 .next
37391 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37392 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37393 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37394 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37395 will always be the case.
37396 .next
37397 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37398 .next
37399 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37400 signature.
37401 .endlist
37402 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37403
37404 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37405 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37406 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37407 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37408 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37409 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37410 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37411 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37412 attempt.
37413
37414 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37415 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37416 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37417 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37418 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37419 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37420 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37421 normally the Exim user.
37422
37423 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37424 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37425 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37426 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37427 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37428 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37429 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37430 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37431
37432 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37433 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37434 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37435 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37436
37437 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37438 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37439
37440 .vlist
37441 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37442 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37443 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37444 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37445 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37446 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37447 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37448 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37449 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37450 newlines.
37451
37452 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37453 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37454 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37455 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37456 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37457 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37458
37459 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37460 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37461 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37462 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37463 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37464 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37465
37466 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37467 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37468 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37469
37470 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37471 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37472 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37473 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37474 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37475
37476 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37477 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37478 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37479 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37480 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37481
37482 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37483 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37484 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37485
37486 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37487 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37488 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37489
37490 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37491 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37492 present.
37493
37494 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37495 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37496 present if the number is greater than zero.
37497
37498 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37499 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37500 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37501
37502 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37503 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37504 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37505
37506 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37507 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37508 command.
37509
37510 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37511 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37512 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37513 messages.
37514
37515 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37516 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37517 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37518 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37519
37520 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37521 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37522 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37523
37524 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37525 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37526 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37527 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37528 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37529 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37530
37531 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37532 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37533 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37534 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37535 supplied by the remote host, if any.
37536
37537 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37538 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37539 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37540 generated messages.
37541
37542 .vitem &%-local%&
37543 The message is from a local sender.
37544
37545 .vitem &%-localerror%&
37546 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37547
37548 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37549 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37550 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37551 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37552
37553 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37554 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37555 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37556
37557 .vitem &%-N%&
37558 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37559 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37560 &%-N%& is assumed.
37561
37562 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37563 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37564 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37565
37566 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37567 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37568 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37569
37570 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37571 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37572 of &$spam_score_int$&.
37573
37574 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37575 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37576 certificate was verified by the server.
37577
37578 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37579 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37580 name of the cipher suite that was used.
37581
37582 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37583 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37584 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37585 certificate.
37586 .endlist
37587
37588 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37589 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37590 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37591 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37592 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37593 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37594 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37595 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37596 addresses are complete.
37597
37598 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37599 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37600 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37601 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37602 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37603 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37604 .code
37605 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37606 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37607 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37608 .endd
37609 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37610 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37611 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37612 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37613 example:
37614 .code
37615 4
37616 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37617 darcy@austen.fict.example
37618 rdo@foundation
37619 alice@wonderland.fict.example
37620 .endd
37621 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37622 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37623 line is of the following form:
37624 .display
37625 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37626 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37627 .endd
37628 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37629 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37630 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37631 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37632 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37633 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37634 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37635 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37636
37637
37638 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37639 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37640 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37641 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37642 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37643 following:
37644
37645 .table2 50pt
37646 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37647 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37648 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37649 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37650 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37651 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37652 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37653 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37654 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37655 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37656 .endtable
37657
37658 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37659 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37660 typical set of headers:
37661 .code
37662 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37663 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37664 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37665 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37666 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37667 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37668 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
37669 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37670 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
37671 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37672 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37673 .endd
37674 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37675 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37676 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37677 .ecindex IIDforspo1
37678 .ecindex IIDforspo2
37679 .ecindex IIDforspo3
37680
37681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37682 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37683
37684 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37685 "DKIM Support"
37686 .cindex "DKIM"
37687
37688 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37689 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37690 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37691 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37692
37693 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
37694 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
37695
37696 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37697 .olist
37698 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37699 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37700 (including transport filters)
37701 except cutthrough delivery.
37702 .next
37703 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37704 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37705 different signature contexts.
37706 .endlist
37707
37708 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37709 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37710 Exim's standard controls.
37711
37712 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37713 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37714 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37715 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37716 .code
37717 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37718 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37719 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37720 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37721 .endd
37722 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37723 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37724 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37725 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37726 senders).
37727
37728
37729 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37730 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37731
37732 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37733 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37734
37735 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37736 MANDATORY:
37737 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37738 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37739
37740 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37741 MANDATORY:
37742 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37743 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37744 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37745 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37746
37747 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37748 MANDATORY:
37749 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37750 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37751 The result can either
37752 .ilist
37753 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37754 .next
37755 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37756 the private key.
37757 .next
37758 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37759 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37760 is set.
37761 .endlist
37762
37763 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37764 OPTIONAL:
37765 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37766 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37767 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37768 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37769
37770 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37771 OPTIONAL:
37772 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37773 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37774 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37775 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37776 variables here.
37777
37778 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37779 OPTIONAL:
37780 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37781 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37782 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37783 used.
37784
37785
37786 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37787 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37788
37789 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37790 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37791 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37792 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37793 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
37794 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37795 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37796
37797 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37798 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37799 runtime of the ACL.
37800
37801 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37802 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37803 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37804 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37805
37806 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37807 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37808 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37809 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37810 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37811 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37812 it defaults as:
37813 .code
37814 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37815 .endd
37816 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37817 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37818 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37819 .code
37820 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37821 .endd
37822 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37823 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37824 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37825 .code
37826 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37827 .endd
37828
37829 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37830 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37831
37832
37833 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37834 available (from most to least important):
37835
37836
37837 .vlist
37838 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37839 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37840 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37841 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37842 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37843 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37844 .ilist
37845 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37846 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37847 .next
37848 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37849 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37850 .next
37851 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37852 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37853 .next
37854 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37855 .endlist
37856 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37857 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37858 "fail" or "invalid". One of
37859 .ilist
37860 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37861 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37862 .next
37863 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37864 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37865 .next
37866 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37867 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37868 means that the message body was modified in transit.
37869 .next
37870 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37871 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37872 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37873 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37874 .endlist
37875 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37876 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37877 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37878 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37879 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37880 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37881 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37882 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37883 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37884 The key record selector string.
37885 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37886 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37887 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37888 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37889 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37890 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37891 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37892 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37893 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37894 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37895 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37896 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37897 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37898 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37899 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37900 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37901 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37902 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37903 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37904 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37905 integer size comparisons against this value.
37906 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37907 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37908 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37909 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37910 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37911 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37912 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37913 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37914 in the key record.
37915 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37916 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37917 in the key record.
37918 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37919 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37920 .endlist
37921
37922 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37923
37924 .vlist
37925 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37926 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37927 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37928 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37929 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37930
37931 .code
37932 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37933 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37934 sender_domains = gmail.com
37935 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37936 dkim_status = none
37937 .endd
37938
37939 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
37940 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37941 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37942 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37943
37944 .code
37945 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37946 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37947 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37948 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37949 .endd
37950
37951 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37952 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37953 for more information of what they mean.
37954 .endlist
37955
37956 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37957 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37958
37959 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37960 "Adding drivers or lookups"
37961 .cindex "adding drivers"
37962 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
37963 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
37964 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
37965 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
37966
37967 .olist
37968 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
37969 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
37970 .next
37971 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
37972 .display
37973 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
37974 .endd
37975 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
37976 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
37977 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
37978 .next
37979 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
37980 .code
37981 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
37982 .endd
37983 .next
37984 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
37985 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
37986 .next
37987 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
37988 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
37989 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
37990 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
37991 simple form that most lookups have.
37992 .next
37993 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
37994 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
37995 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
37996 .next
37997 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
37998 &_src_&.
37999 .next
38000 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
38001 as for other drivers and lookups.
38002 .endlist
38003
38004 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
38005 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
38006 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
38007 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
38008 searched using a binary chop procedure.
38009
38010 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
38011 the interface that is expected.
38012
38013
38014
38015
38016 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38017 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38018
38019 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38020 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
38021 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
38022 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
38023 . processors.
38024 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38025
38026 .literal xml
38027 <?sdop
38028 format="newpage"
38029 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
38030 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
38031 ?>
38032 .literal off
38033
38034 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
38035 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
38036 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
38037
38038
38039 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38040 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////